Add support for enabling/disabling individual pretty-printers.
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
167 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
168 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
169 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
170 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
171 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
172 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
173 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
174 @value{GDBN}
175 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
176 the operating system
177 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
178 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
179 how you can copy and share GDB
180 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
181 * Index:: Index
182 @end menu
183
184 @end ifnottex
185
186 @contents
187
188 @node Summary
189 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
190
191 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
192 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
193 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
194
195 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
196 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
197
198 @itemize @bullet
199 @item
200 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
201
202 @item
203 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
204
205 @item
206 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
207
208 @item
209 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
210 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
211 @end itemize
212
213 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
214 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
215 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
216
217 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
218 @ref{D,,D}.
219
220 @cindex Modula-2
221 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
222 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
223
224 @cindex Pascal
225 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
226 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
227 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
228 syntax.
229
230 @cindex Fortran
231 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
232 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
233 underscore.
234
235 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
236 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
237
238 @menu
239 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
240 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
241 @end menu
242
243 @node Free Software
244 @unnumberedsec Free Software
245
246 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
247 General Public License
248 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
249 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
250 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
251 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
252 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
253 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
254
255 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
256 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
257 from anyone else.
258
259 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
260
261 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
262 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
263 include with the free software. Many of our most important
264 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
265 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
266 when an important free software package does not come with a free
267 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
268 gaps today.
269
270 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
271 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
272 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
273 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
274 them from the free software world.
275
276 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
277 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
278 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
279 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
280 contract to make it non-free.
281
282 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
283 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
284 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
285 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
286 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
287 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
288 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
289
290 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
291 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
292 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
293 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
294
295 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
296 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
297 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
298 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
299 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
300 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
301 community.
302
303 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
304 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
305 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
306 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
307 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
308 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
309 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
310 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
311 of the manual.
312
313 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
314 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
315 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
316 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
317 manual to replace it.
318
319 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
320 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
321 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
322 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
323 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
324 the free software community.
325
326 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
327 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
328 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
329 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
330 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
331 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
332 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
333 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
334 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
335
336 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
337 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
338 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
339 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
340 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
341 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
342 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
343 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
344
345 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
346 published by other publishers, at
347 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
348
349 @node Contributors
350 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
351
352 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
353 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
354 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
355 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
356 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
357 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
358 blow-by-blow account.
359
360 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
361
362 @quotation
363 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
364 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
365 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
366 @end quotation
367
368 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
369 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
370 releases:
371 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
372 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
373 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
374 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
375 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
376 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
377 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
378 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
379 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
380
381 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
382 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
383
384 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
385 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
386 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
387 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
388 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
389
390 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
391 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
392 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
393
394 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
395 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
396
397 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
398
399 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
400 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
401 support.
402 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
403 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
404 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
405 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
406 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
407 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
408 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
409 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
410 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
411 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
412 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
413 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
414 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
415 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
416 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
417 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
418
419 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
420
421 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
422 libraries.
423
424 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
425 about several machine instruction sets.
426
427 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
428 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
429 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
430 and RDI targets, respectively.
431
432 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
433 command-line editing and command history.
434
435 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
436 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
437
438 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
439 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
440 symbols.
441
442 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
443 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
444
445 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
446
447 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
448 processors.
449
450 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
451
452 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
453
454 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
455
456 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
457 watchpoints.
458
459 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
460
461 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
462
463 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
464 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
465
466 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
467 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
468 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
469 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
470 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
471 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
472 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
473
474 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
475 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
476
477 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
478 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
479 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
480 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
481 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
482 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
483 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
484 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
485 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
486 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
487 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
488 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
489 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
490 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
491 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
492
493 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
494 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
495
496 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
497 Hat.
498
499 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
500 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
501 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
502 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
503 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
504 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
505
506 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
507 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
508 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
509 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
510 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
511 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
512 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
513 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
514 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
515 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
516 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
517 Weigand.
518
519 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
520 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
521 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
522 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
523
524 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
525 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
526
527 @node Sample Session
528 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
529
530 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
531 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
532 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
533
534 @iftex
535 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
536 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
537 @end iftex
538
539 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
540 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
541
542 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
543 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
544 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
545 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
546 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
547 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
548 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
549 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
550 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
551
552 @smallexample
553 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
554 $ @b{./m4}
555 @b{define(foo,0000)}
556
557 @b{foo}
558 0000
559 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
560
561 @b{bar}
562 0000
563 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
564
565 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
566 @b{baz}
567 @b{Ctrl-d}
568 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
569 @end smallexample
570
571 @noindent
572 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
576 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
577 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
578 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
579 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
580 the conditions.
581 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
582 for details.
583
584 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
585 (@value{GDBP})
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
590 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
591 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
592 that examples fit in this manual.
593
594 @smallexample
595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
600 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
601 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
602 @code{break} command.
603
604 @smallexample
605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
606 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
611 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
612 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
613
614 @smallexample
615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
616 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
617 @b{define(foo,0000)}
618
619 @b{foo}
620 0000
621 @end smallexample
622
623 @noindent
624 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
625 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
626 context where it stops.
627
628 @smallexample
629 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
630
631 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
632 at builtin.c:879
633 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
638 the next line of the current function.
639
640 @smallexample
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
643 : nil,
644 @end smallexample
645
646 @noindent
647 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
648 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
649 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
650 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
651
652 @smallexample
653 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
654 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
655 at input.c:530
656 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
657 @end smallexample
658
659 @noindent
660 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
661 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
662 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
663 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
664 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
665 stack frame for each active subroutine.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
669 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
670 at input.c:530
671 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
672 at builtin.c:882
673 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
674 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
675 at macro.c:71
676 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
677 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
678 @end smallexample
679
680 @noindent
681 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
682 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
683 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
689 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
690 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
692 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
693 : xstrdup(rq);
694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
695 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
696 @end smallexample
697
698 @noindent
699 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
700 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
701 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
702 (@code{print}) to see their values.
703
704 @smallexample
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
706 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
708 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
709 @end smallexample
710
711 @noindent
712 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
713 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
714 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
715
716 @smallexample
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
718 533 xfree(rquote);
719 534
720 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
721 : xstrdup (lq);
722 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
723 : xstrdup (rq);
724 537
725 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
726 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
727 540 @}
728 541
729 542 void
730 @end smallexample
731
732 @noindent
733 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
734 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
735
736 @smallexample
737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
738 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
740 540 @}
741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
742 $3 = 9
743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
744 $4 = 7
745 @end smallexample
746
747 @noindent
748 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
749 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
750 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
751 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
752 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
753 assignments.
754
755 @smallexample
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
757 $5 = 7
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
759 $6 = 9
760 @end smallexample
761
762 @noindent
763 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
764 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
765 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
766 example that caused trouble initially:
767
768 @smallexample
769 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
770 Continuing.
771
772 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
773
774 baz
775 0000
776 @end smallexample
777
778 @noindent
779 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
780 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
781 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
782
783 @smallexample
784 @b{Ctrl-d}
785 Program exited normally.
786 @end smallexample
787
788 @noindent
789 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
790 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
791 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
792
793 @smallexample
794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
795 @end smallexample
796
797 @node Invocation
798 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
799
800 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
801 The essentials are:
802 @itemize @bullet
803 @item
804 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
805 @item
806 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
807 @end itemize
808
809 @menu
810 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
811 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
812 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
813 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
814 @end menu
815
816 @node Invoking GDB
817 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
818
819 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
820 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
821
822 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
823 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
824
825 The command-line options described here are designed
826 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
827 options may effectively be unavailable.
828
829 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
830 specifying an executable program:
831
832 @smallexample
833 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
834 @end smallexample
835
836 @noindent
837 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
838 specified:
839
840 @smallexample
841 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
842 @end smallexample
843
844 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
845 to debug a running process:
846
847 @smallexample
848 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
849 @end smallexample
850
851 @noindent
852 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
853 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
854
855 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
856 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
857 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
858 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
859 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
860
861 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
862 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
863 option processing.
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
866 @end smallexample
867 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
868 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
869
870 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
871 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} -silent
875 @end smallexample
876
877 @noindent
878 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
879 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
880
881 @noindent
882 Type
883
884 @smallexample
885 @value{GDBP} -help
886 @end smallexample
887
888 @noindent
889 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
890 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
891
892 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
893 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
894 @samp{-x} option is used.
895
896
897 @menu
898 * File Options:: Choosing files
899 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
900 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
901 @end menu
902
903 @node File Options
904 @subsection Choosing Files
905
906 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
907 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
908 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
909 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
910 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
911 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
912 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
913 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
914 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
915 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
916 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
917 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
918 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
919
920 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
921 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
922 argument and ignore it.
923
924 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
925 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
926 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
927 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
928 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
929
930 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
931 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
932 @c it.
933
934 @table @code
935 @item -symbols @var{file}
936 @itemx -s @var{file}
937 @cindex @code{--symbols}
938 @cindex @code{-s}
939 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
940
941 @item -exec @var{file}
942 @itemx -e @var{file}
943 @cindex @code{--exec}
944 @cindex @code{-e}
945 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
946 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
947
948 @item -se @var{file}
949 @cindex @code{--se}
950 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
951 file.
952
953 @item -core @var{file}
954 @itemx -c @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--core}
956 @cindex @code{-c}
957 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
958
959 @item -pid @var{number}
960 @itemx -p @var{number}
961 @cindex @code{--pid}
962 @cindex @code{-p}
963 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
964
965 @item -command @var{file}
966 @itemx -x @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--command}
968 @cindex @code{-x}
969 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
970 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
971 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
972
973 @item -eval-command @var{command}
974 @itemx -ex @var{command}
975 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
976 @cindex @code{-ex}
977 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
978
979 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
980 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
981
982 @smallexample
983 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
984 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
985 @end smallexample
986
987 @item -directory @var{directory}
988 @itemx -d @var{directory}
989 @cindex @code{--directory}
990 @cindex @code{-d}
991 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
992
993 @item -r
994 @itemx -readnow
995 @cindex @code{--readnow}
996 @cindex @code{-r}
997 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
998 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
999 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1000
1001 @end table
1002
1003 @node Mode Options
1004 @subsection Choosing Modes
1005
1006 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1007 batch mode or quiet mode.
1008
1009 @table @code
1010 @item -nx
1011 @itemx -n
1012 @cindex @code{--nx}
1013 @cindex @code{-n}
1014 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1015 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1016 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1017 Files}.
1018
1019 @item -quiet
1020 @itemx -silent
1021 @itemx -q
1022 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1023 @cindex @code{--silent}
1024 @cindex @code{-q}
1025 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1026 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1027
1028 @item -batch
1029 @cindex @code{--batch}
1030 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1031 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1032 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1033 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1034 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination;
1035 @pxref{Screen Size} and acts as if @kbd{set confirm off} were in
1036 effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1037
1038 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1039 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1040 make this more useful, the message
1041
1042 @smallexample
1043 Program exited normally.
1044 @end smallexample
1045
1046 @noindent
1047 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1048 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1049 mode.
1050
1051 @item -batch-silent
1052 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1053 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1054 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1055 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1056 for an interactive session.
1057
1058 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1059 messages, for example.
1060
1061 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1062 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1063
1064 @item -return-child-result
1065 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1066 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1067 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1068
1069 @itemize @bullet
1070 @item
1071 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1072 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1073 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1074 @item
1075 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1076 @item
1077 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1078 the exit code will be -1.
1079 @end itemize
1080
1081 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1082 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1083 interface.
1084
1085 @item -nowindows
1086 @itemx -nw
1087 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1088 @cindex @code{-nw}
1089 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1090 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1091 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1092
1093 @item -windows
1094 @itemx -w
1095 @cindex @code{--windows}
1096 @cindex @code{-w}
1097 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1098 used if possible.
1099
1100 @item -cd @var{directory}
1101 @cindex @code{--cd}
1102 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1103 instead of the current directory.
1104
1105 @item -fullname
1106 @itemx -f
1107 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1108 @cindex @code{-f}
1109 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1110 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1111 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1112 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1113 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1114 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1115 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1116 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1117 frame.
1118
1119 @item -epoch
1120 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1121 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1122 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1123 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1124 separate window.
1125
1126 @item -annotate @var{level}
1127 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1128 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1129 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1130 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1131 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1132 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1133 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1134 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1135 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1136
1137 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1138 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1139
1140 @item --args
1141 @cindex @code{--args}
1142 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1143 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1144 This option stops option processing.
1145
1146 @item -baud @var{bps}
1147 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1148 @cindex @code{--baud}
1149 @cindex @code{-b}
1150 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1151 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1152
1153 @item -l @var{timeout}
1154 @cindex @code{-l}
1155 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1156 for remote debugging.
1157
1158 @item -tty @var{device}
1159 @itemx -t @var{device}
1160 @cindex @code{--tty}
1161 @cindex @code{-t}
1162 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1163 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1164
1165 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1166 @item -tui
1167 @cindex @code{--tui}
1168 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1169 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1170 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1171 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1172 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1173 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1174 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1175
1176 @c @item -xdb
1177 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1178 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1179 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1180 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1181 @c systems.
1182
1183 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1184 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1185 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1186 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1187 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1188 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1189
1190 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1191 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1192 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1193 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1194 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1195 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1196
1197 @item -write
1198 @cindex @code{--write}
1199 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1200 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1201 (@pxref{Patching}).
1202
1203 @item -statistics
1204 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1205 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1206 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1207
1208 @item -version
1209 @cindex @code{--version}
1210 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1211 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1212
1213 @end table
1214
1215 @node Startup
1216 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1217 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1218
1219 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1220
1221 @enumerate
1222 @item
1223 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1224 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1225
1226 @item
1227 @cindex init file
1228 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1229 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1230 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1231 that file.
1232
1233 @item
1234 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1235 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1236 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1237 that file.
1238
1239 @item
1240 Processes command line options and operands.
1241
1242 @item
1243 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1244 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1245 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1246 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1247 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1248 @value{GDBN}.
1249
1250 @item
1251 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1252 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1253
1254 @item
1255 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1256 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1257 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1258 @end enumerate
1259
1260 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1261 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1262 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1263 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1264 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1265 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1266
1267 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1268 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1269
1270 @cindex init file name
1271 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1272 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1273 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1274 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1275 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1276 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1277 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1278 the file to the standard name.
1279
1280
1281 @node Quitting GDB
1282 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1283 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1284 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1285
1286 @table @code
1287 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1288 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1289 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1290 @itemx q
1291 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1292 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1293 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1294 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1295 error code.
1296 @end table
1297
1298 @cindex interrupt
1299 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1300 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1301 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1302 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1303 until a time when it is safe.
1304
1305 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1306 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1307 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1308
1309 @node Shell Commands
1310 @section Shell Commands
1311
1312 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1313 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1314 just use the @code{shell} command.
1315
1316 @table @code
1317 @kindex shell
1318 @cindex shell escape
1319 @item shell @var{command string}
1320 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1321 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1322 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1323 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1324 @end table
1325
1326 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1327 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1328 @value{GDBN}:
1329
1330 @table @code
1331 @kindex make
1332 @cindex calling make
1333 @item make @var{make-args}
1334 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1335 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1336 @end table
1337
1338 @node Logging Output
1339 @section Logging Output
1340 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1341 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1342
1343 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1344 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1345
1346 @table @code
1347 @kindex set logging
1348 @item set logging on
1349 Enable logging.
1350 @item set logging off
1351 Disable logging.
1352 @cindex logging file name
1353 @item set logging file @var{file}
1354 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1355 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1356 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1357 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1358 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1359 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1360 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1361 @kindex show logging
1362 @item show logging
1363 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1364 @end table
1365
1366 @node Commands
1367 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1368
1369 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1370 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1371 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1372 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1373 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1374
1375 @menu
1376 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1377 * Completion:: Command completion
1378 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1379 @end menu
1380
1381 @node Command Syntax
1382 @section Command Syntax
1383
1384 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1385 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1386 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1387 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1388 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1389 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1390
1391 @cindex abbreviation
1392 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1393 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1394 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1395 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1396 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1397 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1398 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1399
1400 @cindex repeating commands
1401 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1402 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1403 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1404 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1405 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1406 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1407 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1408
1409 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1410 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1411 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1412
1413 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1414 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1415 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1416 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1417 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1418
1419 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1420 @cindex comment
1421 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1422 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1423 Files,,Command Files}).
1424
1425 @cindex repeating command sequences
1426 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1427 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1428 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1429 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1430 for editing.
1431
1432 @node Completion
1433 @section Command Completion
1434
1435 @cindex completion
1436 @cindex word completion
1437 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1438 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1439 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1440 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1441
1442 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1443 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1444 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1445 enter it). For example, if you type
1446
1447 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1448 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1449 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1450 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1451 @smallexample
1452 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1453 @end smallexample
1454
1455 @noindent
1456 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1457 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1458
1459 @smallexample
1460 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1461 @end smallexample
1462
1463 @noindent
1464 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1465 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1466 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1467 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1468 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1469 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1470
1471 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1472 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1473 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1474 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1475 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1476 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1477 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1478 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1479 example:
1480
1481 @smallexample
1482 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1483 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1484 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1485 make_abs_section make_function_type
1486 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1487 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1488 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1489 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1490 @end smallexample
1491
1492 @noindent
1493 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1494 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1495 command.
1496
1497 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1498 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1499 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1500 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1501 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1502
1503 @cindex quotes in commands
1504 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1505 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1506 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1507 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1508 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1509 @value{GDBN} commands.
1510
1511 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1512 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1513 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1514 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1515 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1516 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1517 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1518 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1519 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1520 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1521 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1522
1523 @smallexample
1524 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1525 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1526 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1527 @end smallexample
1528
1529 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1530 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1531 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1532 place:
1533
1534 @smallexample
1535 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1536 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1537 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1538 @end smallexample
1539
1540 @noindent
1541 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1542 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1543 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1544
1545 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1546 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1547 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1548 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1549
1550 @cindex completion of structure field names
1551 @cindex structure field name completion
1552 @cindex completion of union field names
1553 @cindex union field name completion
1554 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1555 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1556 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1557 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1558 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1559 left-hand-side:
1560
1561 @smallexample
1562 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1563 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1564 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1565 @end smallexample
1566
1567 @noindent
1568 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1569 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1570 follows:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 struct ui_file
1574 @{
1575 int *magic;
1576 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1577 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1578 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1579 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1580 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1581 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1582 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1583 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1584 void *to_data;
1585 @}
1586 @end smallexample
1587
1588
1589 @node Help
1590 @section Getting Help
1591 @cindex online documentation
1592 @kindex help
1593
1594 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1595 using the command @code{help}.
1596
1597 @table @code
1598 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1599 @item help
1600 @itemx h
1601 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1602 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1603
1604 @smallexample
1605 (@value{GDBP}) help
1606 List of classes of commands:
1607
1608 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1609 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1610 data -- Examining data
1611 files -- Specifying and examining files
1612 internals -- Maintenance commands
1613 obscure -- Obscure features
1614 running -- Running the program
1615 stack -- Examining the stack
1616 status -- Status inquiries
1617 support -- Support facilities
1618 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1619 stopping the program
1620 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1621
1622 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1623 commands in that class.
1624 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1625 documentation.
1626 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1627 (@value{GDBP})
1628 @end smallexample
1629 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1630
1631 @item help @var{class}
1632 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1633 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1634 help display for the class @code{status}:
1635
1636 @smallexample
1637 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1638 Status inquiries.
1639
1640 List of commands:
1641
1642 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1643 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1644 info -- Generic command for showing things
1645 about the program being debugged
1646 show -- Generic command for showing things
1647 about the debugger
1648
1649 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1650 documentation.
1651 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1652 (@value{GDBP})
1653 @end smallexample
1654
1655 @item help @var{command}
1656 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1657 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1658
1659 @kindex apropos
1660 @item apropos @var{args}
1661 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1662 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1663 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1664
1665 @smallexample
1666 apropos reload
1667 @end smallexample
1668
1669 @noindent
1670 results in:
1671
1672 @smallexample
1673 @c @group
1674 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1675 multiple times in one run
1676 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1677 multiple times in one run
1678 @c @end group
1679 @end smallexample
1680
1681 @kindex complete
1682 @item complete @var{args}
1683 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1684 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1685 command you want completed. For example:
1686
1687 @smallexample
1688 complete i
1689 @end smallexample
1690
1691 @noindent results in:
1692
1693 @smallexample
1694 @group
1695 if
1696 ignore
1697 info
1698 inspect
1699 @end group
1700 @end smallexample
1701
1702 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1703 @end table
1704
1705 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1706 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1707 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1708 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1709 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1710 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1711
1712 @c @group
1713 @table @code
1714 @kindex info
1715 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1716 @item info
1717 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1718 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1719 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1720 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1721 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1722 @w{@code{help info}}.
1723
1724 @kindex set
1725 @item set
1726 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1727 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1728 @code{set prompt $}.
1729
1730 @kindex show
1731 @item show
1732 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1733 @value{GDBN} itself.
1734 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1735 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1736 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1737 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1738
1739 @kindex info set
1740 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1741 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1742 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1743 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1744 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1745 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1746 @end table
1747 @c @end group
1748
1749 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1750 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1751
1752 @table @code
1753 @kindex show version
1754 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1755 @item show version
1756 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1757 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1758 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1759 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1760 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1761 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1762 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1763 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1764 @value{GDBN}.
1765
1766 @kindex show copying
1767 @kindex info copying
1768 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1769 @item show copying
1770 @itemx info copying
1771 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1772
1773 @kindex show warranty
1774 @kindex info warranty
1775 @item show warranty
1776 @itemx info warranty
1777 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1778 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1779
1780 @end table
1781
1782 @node Running
1783 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1784
1785 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1786 debugging information when you compile it.
1787
1788 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1789 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1790 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1791 kill a child process.
1792
1793 @menu
1794 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1795 * Starting:: Starting your program
1796 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1797 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1798
1799 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1800 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1801 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1802 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1803
1804 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1805 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1806 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1807 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1808 @end menu
1809
1810 @node Compilation
1811 @section Compiling for Debugging
1812
1813 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1814 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1815 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1816 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1817 and addresses in the executable code.
1818
1819 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1820 the compiler.
1821
1822 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1823 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1824 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1825 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1826 executables containing debugging information.
1827
1828 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1829 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1830 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1831 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1832 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1833
1834 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1835 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1836 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1837
1838 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1839 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1840 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1841 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1842 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1843 provides macro information if you specify the options
1844 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1845 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1846 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1847 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1848 @option{-g} alone.
1849
1850 @need 2000
1851 @node Starting
1852 @section Starting your Program
1853 @cindex starting
1854 @cindex running
1855
1856 @table @code
1857 @kindex run
1858 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1859 @item run
1860 @itemx r
1861 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1862 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1863 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1864 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1865 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1866
1867 @end table
1868
1869 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1870 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1871 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1872 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1873 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1874 message like this one:
1875
1876 @smallexample
1877 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1878 Try "help target" or "continue".
1879 @end smallexample
1880
1881 @noindent
1882 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1883 first (@pxref{load}).
1884
1885 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1886 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1887 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1888 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1889 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1890 divided into four categories:
1891
1892 @table @asis
1893 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1894 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1895 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1896 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1897 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1898 the arguments.
1899 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1900 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1901 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1902
1903 @item The @emph{environment.}
1904 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1905 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1906 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1907 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1908
1909 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1910 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1911 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1912 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1913
1914 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1915 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1916 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1917 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1918 set a different device for your program.
1919 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1920
1921 @cindex pipes
1922 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1923 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1924 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1925 wrong program.
1926 @end table
1927
1928 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1929 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1930 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1931 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1932 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1933
1934 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1935 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1936 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1937 your current breakpoints.
1938
1939 @table @code
1940 @kindex start
1941 @item start
1942 @cindex run to main procedure
1943 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1944 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1945 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1946 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1947 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1948 procedure, depending on the language used.
1949
1950 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1951 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1952 the @samp{run} command.
1953
1954 @cindex elaboration phase
1955 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1956 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1957 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1958 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1959 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1960 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1961 will remain to halt execution.
1962
1963 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1964 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1965 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1966 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1967 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1968
1969 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1970 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1971 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1972 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1973 elaboration code before running your program.
1974
1975 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1976 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1977 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1978 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1979 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1980 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1981 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1982 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1983 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1984 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1985 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1986
1987 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1988 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1989 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1990 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1991
1992 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1993 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1994 environment:
1995
1996 @smallexample
1997 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1998 (@value{GDBP}) run
1999 @end smallexample
2000
2001 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2002 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2003
2004 @kindex set disable-randomization
2005 @item set disable-randomization
2006 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2007 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2008 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2009 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2010 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2011
2012 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2013 behavior using
2014
2015 @smallexample
2016 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2017 @end smallexample
2018
2019 @item set disable-randomization off
2020 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2021 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2022 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2023 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2024 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2025 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2026
2027 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2028 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2029 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2030 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2031 a code at its expected addresses.
2032
2033 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2034 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2035 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2036 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2037 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2038 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2039 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2040 a randomly chosen address.
2041
2042 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2043 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2044 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2045 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2046 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2047
2048 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2049 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2050
2051 @item show disable-randomization
2052 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2053 the virtual address space of the started program.
2054
2055 @end table
2056
2057 @node Arguments
2058 @section Your Program's Arguments
2059
2060 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2061 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2062 @code{run} command.
2063 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2064 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2065 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2066 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2067 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2068
2069 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2070 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2071 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2072 the program, not by the shell.
2073
2074 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2075 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2076
2077 @table @code
2078 @kindex set args
2079 @item set args
2080 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2081 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2082 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2083 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2084 it again without arguments.
2085
2086 @kindex show args
2087 @item show args
2088 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2089 @end table
2090
2091 @node Environment
2092 @section Your Program's Environment
2093
2094 @cindex environment (of your program)
2095 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2096 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2097 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2098 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2099 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2100 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2101 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2102
2103 @table @code
2104 @kindex path
2105 @item path @var{directory}
2106 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2107 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2108 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2109 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2110 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2111 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2112 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2113
2114 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2115 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2116 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2117 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2118 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2119 @var{directory} to the search path.
2120 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2121 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2122
2123 @kindex show paths
2124 @item show paths
2125 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2126 environment variable).
2127
2128 @kindex show environment
2129 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2130 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2131 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2132 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2133 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2134
2135 @kindex set environment
2136 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2137 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2138 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2139 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2140 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2141 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2142 null value.
2143 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2144 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2145
2146 For example, this command:
2147
2148 @smallexample
2149 set env USER = foo
2150 @end smallexample
2151
2152 @noindent
2153 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2154 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2155 are not actually required.)
2156
2157 @kindex unset environment
2158 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2159 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2160 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2161 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2162 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2163 @end table
2164
2165 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2166 the shell indicated
2167 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2168 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2169 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2170 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2171 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2172 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2173 @file{.profile}.
2174
2175 @node Working Directory
2176 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2177
2178 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2179 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2180 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2181 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2182 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2183 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2184
2185 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2186 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2187 Specify Files}.
2188
2189 @table @code
2190 @kindex cd
2191 @cindex change working directory
2192 @item cd @var{directory}
2193 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2194
2195 @kindex pwd
2196 @item pwd
2197 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2198 @end table
2199
2200 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2201 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2202 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2203 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2204 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2205 current working directory of the debuggee.
2206
2207 @node Input/Output
2208 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2209
2210 @cindex redirection
2211 @cindex i/o
2212 @cindex terminal
2213 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2214 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2215 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2216 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2217 running your program.
2218
2219 @table @code
2220 @kindex info terminal
2221 @item info terminal
2222 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2223 program is using.
2224 @end table
2225
2226 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2227 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2228
2229 @smallexample
2230 run > outfile
2231 @end smallexample
2232
2233 @noindent
2234 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2235
2236 @kindex tty
2237 @cindex controlling terminal
2238 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2239 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2240 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2241 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2242 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 tty /dev/ttyb
2246 @end smallexample
2247
2248 @noindent
2249 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2250 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2251 that as their controlling terminal.
2252
2253 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2254 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2255 terminal.
2256
2257 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2258 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2259 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2260 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2261
2262 @cindex inferior tty
2263 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2264 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2265 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2266 program.
2267
2268 @table @code
2269 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2270 @kindex set inferior-tty
2271 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2272
2273 @item show inferior-tty
2274 @kindex show inferior-tty
2275 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2276 @end table
2277
2278 @node Attach
2279 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2280 @kindex attach
2281 @cindex attach
2282
2283 @table @code
2284 @item attach @var{process-id}
2285 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2286 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2287 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2288 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2289 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2290
2291 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2292 executing the command.
2293 @end table
2294
2295 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2296 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2297 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2298 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2299
2300 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2301 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2302 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2303 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2304 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2305 Specify Files}.
2306
2307 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2308 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2309 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2310 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2311 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2312 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2313 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2314
2315 @table @code
2316 @kindex detach
2317 @item detach
2318 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2319 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2320 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2321 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2322 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2323 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2324 executing the command.
2325 @end table
2326
2327 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2328 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2329 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2330 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2331 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2332 Messages}).
2333
2334 @node Kill Process
2335 @section Killing the Child Process
2336
2337 @table @code
2338 @kindex kill
2339 @item kill
2340 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2341 @end table
2342
2343 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2344 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2345 is running.
2346
2347 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2348 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2349 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2350 outside the debugger.
2351
2352 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2353 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2354 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2355 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2356 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2357 breakpoint settings).
2358
2359 @node Inferiors and Programs
2360 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2361
2362 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2363 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2364 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2365 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2366 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2367 from multiple executables.
2368
2369 @cindex inferior
2370 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2371 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2372 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2373 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2374 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2375 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2376 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2377 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2378 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2379 threads running in it.
2380
2381 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2382 inferiors}}:
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex info inferiors
2386 @item info inferiors
2387 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2388
2389 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2390
2391 @enumerate
2392 @item
2393 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2394
2395 @item
2396 the target system's inferior identifier
2397
2398 @item
2399 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2400
2401 @end enumerate
2402
2403 @noindent
2404 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2405 indicates the current inferior.
2406
2407 For example,
2408 @end table
2409 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2410
2411 @smallexample
2412 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2413 Num Description Executable
2414 2 process 2307 hello
2415 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2416 @end smallexample
2417
2418 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2419
2420 @table @code
2421 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2422 @item inferior @var{infno}
2423 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2424 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2425 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2426 @end table
2427
2428
2429 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2430 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2431 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2432 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2433 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2434 @w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2435
2436 @table @code
2437 @kindex add-inferior
2438 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2439 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2440 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2441 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2442 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2443 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2444
2445 @kindex clone-inferior
2446 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2447 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2448 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2449 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2450 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2451
2452 @smallexample
2453 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2454 Num Description Executable
2455 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2456 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2457 Added inferior 2.
2458 1 inferiors added.
2459 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2460 Num Description Executable
2461 2 <null> helloworld
2462 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2463 @end smallexample
2464
2465 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2466
2467 @kindex remove-inferior
2468 @item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2469 Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2470 inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2471 @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2472
2473 @end table
2474
2475 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2476 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2477 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2478 using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2482 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2483 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2484 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2485
2486 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2487 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2488 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2489 @var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2490 @end table
2491
2492 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2493 @code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2494 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2495 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2496
2497
2498 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2499 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @kindex set print inferior-events
2503 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2504 @item set print inferior-events
2505 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2506 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2507 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2508 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2509 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2510 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2511
2512 @kindex show print inferior-events
2513 @item show print inferior-events
2514 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2515 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2516 @end table
2517
2518 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2519 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2520 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2521
2522
2523 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2524 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2525 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2526 info program-spaces}} command.
2527
2528 @table @code
2529 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2530 @item maint info program-spaces
2531 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2532 @value{GDBN}.
2533
2534 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2535
2536 @enumerate
2537 @item
2538 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2539
2540 @item
2541 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2542 the @code{file} command.
2543
2544 @end enumerate
2545
2546 @noindent
2547 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2548 indicates the current program space.
2549
2550 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2551 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2552 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2553
2554 @smallexample
2555 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2556 Id Executable
2557 2 goodbye
2558 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2559 * 1 hello
2560 @end smallexample
2561
2562 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2563 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2564 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2565 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2566 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2570 Id Executable
2571 * 1 vfork-test
2572 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2573 @end smallexample
2574
2575 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2576 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2577 @end table
2578
2579 @node Threads
2580 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2581
2582 @cindex threads of execution
2583 @cindex multiple threads
2584 @cindex switching threads
2585 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2586 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2587 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2588 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2589 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2590 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2591 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2592
2593 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2594 programs:
2595
2596 @itemize @bullet
2597 @item automatic notification of new threads
2598 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2599 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2600 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2601 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2602 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2603 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2604 messages on thread start and exit.
2605 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2606 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2607 isn't compatible with the program.
2608 @end itemize
2609
2610 @quotation
2611 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2612 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2613 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2614 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2615 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2616 like this:
2617
2618 @smallexample
2619 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2620 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2621 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2622 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2623 @end smallexample
2624 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2625 @c doesn't support threads"?
2626 @end quotation
2627
2628 @cindex focus of debugging
2629 @cindex current thread
2630 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2631 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2632 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2633 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2634 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2635
2636 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2637 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2638 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2639 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2640 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2641 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2642 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2643 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2644 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2645 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2646
2647 @smallexample
2648 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 @noindent
2652 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2653 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2654 further qualifier.
2655
2656 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2657 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2658 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2659 @c program?
2660 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2661 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2662 @c threads ab initio?
2663
2664 @cindex thread number
2665 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2666 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2667 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex info threads
2671 @item info threads
2672 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2673 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2674
2675 @enumerate
2676 @item
2677 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2678
2679 @item
2680 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2681
2682 @item
2683 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2684 @end enumerate
2685
2686 @noindent
2687 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2688 indicates the current thread.
2689
2690 For example,
2691 @end table
2692 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2693
2694 @smallexample
2695 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2696 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2697 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2698 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2699 at threadtest.c:68
2700 @end smallexample
2701
2702 On HP-UX systems:
2703
2704 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2705 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2706 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2707 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2708 thread in your program.
2709
2710 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2711 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2712 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2713 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2714 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2715 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2716 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2717 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2718 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2719 HP-UX, you see
2720
2721 @smallexample
2722 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2723 @end smallexample
2724
2725 @noindent
2726 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2727
2728 @table @code
2729 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2730 @item info threads
2731 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2732 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2733
2734 @enumerate
2735 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2736
2737 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2738
2739 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2740 @end enumerate
2741
2742 @noindent
2743 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2744 indicates the current thread.
2745
2746 For example,
2747 @end table
2748 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2749
2750 @smallexample
2751 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2752 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2753 at quicksort.c:137
2754 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2755 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2756 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2757 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2758 @end smallexample
2759
2760 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2761 Solaris-specific command:
2762
2763 @table @code
2764 @item maint info sol-threads
2765 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2766 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2767 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2768 @end table
2769
2770 @table @code
2771 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2772 @item thread @var{threadno}
2773 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2774 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2775 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2776 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2777 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2778
2779 @smallexample
2780 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2781 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2782 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2783 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2784 @end smallexample
2785
2786 @noindent
2787 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2788 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2789 threads.
2790
2791 @kindex thread apply
2792 @cindex apply command to several threads
2793 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2794 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2795 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2796 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2797 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2798 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2799 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2800 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2801
2802 @kindex set print thread-events
2803 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2804 @item set print thread-events
2805 @itemx set print thread-events on
2806 @itemx set print thread-events off
2807 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2808 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2809 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2810 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2811 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2812
2813 @kindex show print thread-events
2814 @item show print thread-events
2815 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2816 have started and exited.
2817 @end table
2818
2819 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2820 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2821 programs with multiple threads.
2822
2823 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2824 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2825
2826 @table @code
2827 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2828 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2829 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2830 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2831 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2832 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2833 an empty list.
2834
2835 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2836 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2837 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2838 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2839 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2840 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2841
2842 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2843 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2844 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2845 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2846 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2847 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2848 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2849
2850 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2851 only on some platforms.
2852
2853 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2854 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2855 Display current libthread_db search path.
2856 @end table
2857
2858 @node Forks
2859 @section Debugging Forks
2860
2861 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2862 @cindex multiple processes
2863 @cindex processes, multiple
2864 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2865 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2866 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2867 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2868 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2869 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2870 will cause it to terminate.
2871
2872 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2873 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2874 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2875 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2876 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2877 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2878 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2879 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2880 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2881 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2882
2883 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2884 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2885 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2886 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2887
2888 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2889 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2890
2891 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2892 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2893
2894 @table @code
2895 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2896 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2897 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2898 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2899 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2900
2901 @table @code
2902 @item parent
2903 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2904 unimpeded. This is the default.
2905
2906 @item child
2907 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2908 unimpeded.
2909
2910 @end table
2911
2912 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2913 @item show follow-fork-mode
2914 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2915 @end table
2916
2917 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2918 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2919 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2920
2921 @table @code
2922 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2923 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2924 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2925 retain debugger control over them both.
2926
2927 @table @code
2928 @item on
2929 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2930 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2931 independently. This is the default.
2932
2933 @item off
2934 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2935 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2936 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2937 is held suspended.
2938
2939 @end table
2940
2941 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2942 @item show detach-on-fork
2943 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2944 @end table
2945
2946 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2947 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2948 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2949 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2950 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2951 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2952
2953 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2954 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2955 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2956 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2957 and Programs}.
2958
2959 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2960 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2961 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2962 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2963 the child process's @code{main}.
2964
2965 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2966 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2967
2968 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2969 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
2970 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
2971 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
2972 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
2973 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
2974 command.
2975
2976 @table @code
2977 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
2978 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
2979
2980 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
2981 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
2982
2983 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
2984
2985 @table @code
2986 @item new
2987 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
2988 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
2989 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
2990 original inferior.
2991
2992 For example:
2993
2994 @smallexample
2995 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2996 (gdb) info inferior
2997 Id Description Executable
2998 * 1 <null> prog1
2999 (@value{GDBP}) run
3000 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3001 Program exited normally.
3002 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3003 Id Description Executable
3004 * 2 <null> prog2
3005 1 <null> prog1
3006 @end smallexample
3007
3008 @item same
3009 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3010 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3011 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3012 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3013 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3014
3015 For example:
3016
3017 @smallexample
3018 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3019 Id Description Executable
3020 * 1 <null> prog1
3021 (@value{GDBP}) run
3022 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3023 Program exited normally.
3024 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3025 Id Description Executable
3026 * 1 <null> prog2
3027 @end smallexample
3028
3029 @end table
3030 @end table
3031
3032 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3033 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3034 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3035
3036 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3037 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3038
3039 @cindex checkpoint
3040 @cindex restart
3041 @cindex bookmark
3042 @cindex snapshot of a process
3043 @cindex rewind program state
3044
3045 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3046 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3047 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3048 later.
3049
3050 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3051 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3052 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3053 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3054 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3055
3056 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3057 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3058 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3059 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3060 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3061 start again from there.
3062
3063 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3064 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3065
3066 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3067
3068 @table @code
3069 @kindex checkpoint
3070 @item checkpoint
3071 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3072 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3073 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3074
3075 @kindex info checkpoints
3076 @item info checkpoints
3077 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3078 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3079 listed:
3080
3081 @table @code
3082 @item Checkpoint ID
3083 @item Process ID
3084 @item Code Address
3085 @item Source line, or label
3086 @end table
3087
3088 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3089 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3090 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3091 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3092 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3093 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3094 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3095
3096 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3097 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3098 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3099 the debugger.
3100
3101 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3102 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3103 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3104
3105 @end table
3106
3107 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3108 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3109 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3110 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3111 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3112 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3113 previously read data can be read again.
3114
3115 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3116 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3117 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3118 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3119 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3120 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3121
3122 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3123 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3124 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3125 different execution path this time.
3126
3127 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3128 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3129 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3130 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3131 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3132 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3133 potentially pose a problem.
3134
3135 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3136
3137 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3138 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3139 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3140 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3141 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3142 next.
3143
3144 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3145 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3146 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3147 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3148 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3149
3150 @node Stopping
3151 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3152
3153 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3154 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3155 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3156
3157 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3158 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3159 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3160 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3161 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3162 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3163 explicitly request this information at any time.
3164
3165 @table @code
3166 @kindex info program
3167 @item info program
3168 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3169 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3170 @end table
3171
3172 @menu
3173 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3174 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3175 * Signals:: Signals
3176 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3177 @end menu
3178
3179 @node Breakpoints
3180 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3181
3182 @cindex breakpoints
3183 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3184 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3185 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3186 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3187 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3188 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3189 program.
3190
3191 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3192 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3193 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3194 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3195 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3196 call).
3197
3198 @cindex watchpoints
3199 @cindex data breakpoints
3200 @cindex memory tracing
3201 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3202 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3203 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3204 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3205 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3206 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3207 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3208 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3209 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3210 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3211 same commands.
3212
3213 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3214 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3215 Automatic Display}.
3216
3217 @cindex catchpoints
3218 @cindex breakpoint on events
3219 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3220 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3221 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3222 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3223 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3224 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3225 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3226
3227 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3228 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3229 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3230 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3231 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3232 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3233 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3234 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3235 enable it again.
3236
3237 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3238 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3239 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3240 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3241 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3242 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3243 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3244
3245 @menu
3246 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3247 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3248 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3249 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3250 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3251 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3252 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3253 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3254 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3255 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3256 @end menu
3257
3258 @node Set Breaks
3259 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3260
3261 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3262 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3263 @c
3264 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3265
3266 @kindex break
3267 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3268 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3269 @cindex latest breakpoint
3270 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3271 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3272 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3273 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3274 convenience variables.
3275
3276 @table @code
3277 @item break @var{location}
3278 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3279 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3280 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3281 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3282 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3283
3284 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3285 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3286 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3287 that situation.
3288
3289 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3290 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3291 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3292
3293 @item break
3294 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3295 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3296 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3297 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3298 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3299 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3300 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3301 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3302 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3303 inside loops.
3304
3305 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3306 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3307 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3308 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3309 existed when your program stopped.
3310
3311 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3312 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3313 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3314 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3315 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3316 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3317 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3318
3319 @kindex tbreak
3320 @item tbreak @var{args}
3321 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3322 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3323 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3324 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3325
3326 @kindex hbreak
3327 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3328 @item hbreak @var{args}
3329 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3330 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3331 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3332 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3333 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3334 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3335 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3336 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3337 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3338 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3339 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3340 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3341 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3342 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3343 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3344 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3345 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3346 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3347
3348 @kindex thbreak
3349 @item thbreak @var{args}
3350 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3351 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3352 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3353 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3354 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3355 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3356 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3357 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3358
3359 @kindex rbreak
3360 @cindex regular expression
3361 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3362 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3363 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3364 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3365 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3366 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3367 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3368 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3369 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3370
3371 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3372 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3373 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3374 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3375 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3376 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3377
3378 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3379 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3380 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3381 classes.
3382
3383 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3384 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3385 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3386
3387 @smallexample
3388 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3389 @end smallexample
3390
3391 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3392 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3393 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3394 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3395 every function in a given file:
3396
3397 @smallexample
3398 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3399 @end smallexample
3400
3401 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3402 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3403
3404 @kindex info breakpoints
3405 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3406 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3407 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3408 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3409 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3410 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3411 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3412
3413 @table @emph
3414 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3415 @item Type
3416 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3417 @item Disposition
3418 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3419 @item Enabled or Disabled
3420 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3421 that are not enabled.
3422 @item Address
3423 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3424 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3425 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3426 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3427 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3428 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3429 @item What
3430 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3431 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3432 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3433 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @noindent
3437 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3438 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3439 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3440 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3441 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3442 valid location.
3443
3444 @noindent
3445 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3446 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3447 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3448 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3449 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3450
3451 @noindent
3452 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3453 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3454 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3455 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3456 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3457 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3458 @end table
3459
3460 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3461 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3462 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3463 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3464
3465 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3466 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3467 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3468 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3469
3470 @itemize @bullet
3471 @item
3472 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3473 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3474
3475 @item
3476 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3477 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3478
3479 @item
3480 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3481 several places where that function is inlined.
3482 @end itemize
3483
3484 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3485 the relevant locations@footnote{
3486 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3487 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3488 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3489 info with line numbers for them.}.
3490
3491 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3492 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3493 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3494 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3495 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3496 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3497 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3498
3499 For example:
3500
3501 @smallexample
3502 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3503 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3504 stop only if i==1
3505 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3506 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3507 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3508 @end smallexample
3509
3510 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3511 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3512 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3513 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3514 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3515 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3516 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3517 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3518 that belong to that breakpoint.
3519
3520 @cindex pending breakpoints
3521 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3522 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3523 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3524 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3525 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3526 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3527 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3528 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3529 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3530 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3531 is not yet resolved.
3532
3533 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3534 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3535 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3536 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3537 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3538 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3539
3540 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3541 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3542 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3543 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3544
3545 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3546 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3547 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3548
3549 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3550 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3551 address specification to an address:
3552
3553 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3554 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3555 @table @code
3556 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3557 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3558 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3559
3560 @item set breakpoint pending on
3561 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3562 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3563
3564 @item set breakpoint pending off
3565 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3566 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3567 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3568
3569 @item show breakpoint pending
3570 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3571 @end table
3572
3573 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3574 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3575 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3576
3577 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3578 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3579 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3580 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3581 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3582 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3583 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3584 breakpoints.
3585
3586 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3587
3588 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3589 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3590 @table @code
3591 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3592 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3593 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3594 breakpoint must be used.
3595
3596 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3597 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3598 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3599 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3600 @end table
3601
3602 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3603 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3604 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3605 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3606 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3607 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3608 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3609 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3610 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3611
3612 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3613 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3614 @table @code
3615 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3616 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3617 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3618 removed from the target when it stops.
3619
3620 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3621 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3622 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3623 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3624 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3625
3626 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3627 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3628 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3629 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3630 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3631 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3632 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3633 @end table
3634
3635 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3636 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3637 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3638 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3639 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3640 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3641 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3642 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3643
3644
3645 @node Set Watchpoints
3646 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3647
3648 @cindex setting watchpoints
3649 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3650 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3651 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3652 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3653 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3654
3655 @itemize @bullet
3656 @item
3657 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3658
3659 @item
3660 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3661 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3662 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3663
3664 @item
3665 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3666 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3667 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3668 @end itemize
3669
3670 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3671 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3672 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3673 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3674 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3675 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3676 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3677 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3678 the expression changes.
3679
3680 @cindex software watchpoints
3681 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3682 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3683 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3684 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3685 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3686 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3687 culprit.)
3688
3689 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3690 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3691 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3692
3693 @table @code
3694 @kindex watch
3695 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3696 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3697 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3698 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3699 to watch the value of a single variable:
3700
3701 @smallexample
3702 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3703 @end smallexample
3704
3705 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3706 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3707 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3708 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3709 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3710 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3711
3712 @kindex rwatch
3713 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3714 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3715 by the program.
3716
3717 @kindex awatch
3718 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3719 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3720 or written into by the program.
3721
3722 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3723 @item info watchpoints
3724 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3725 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3726 @end table
3727
3728 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3729 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3730 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3731 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3732 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3733 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3734
3735 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3736 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3737 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3738 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3739 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3740 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3741 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3742 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3743
3744 @table @code
3745 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3746 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3747 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3748
3749 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3750 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3751 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3752 @end table
3753
3754 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3755 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3756 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3757
3758 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3759
3760 @smallexample
3761 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3762 @end smallexample
3763
3764 @noindent
3765 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3766
3767 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3768 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3769 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3770 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3771 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3772 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3773 will print a message like this:
3774
3775 @smallexample
3776 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3777 @end smallexample
3778
3779 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3780 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3781 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3782 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3783 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3784 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3785 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3786 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3787
3788 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3789 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3790 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3791 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3792 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3793 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3794
3795 @smallexample
3796 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3797 @end smallexample
3798
3799 @noindent
3800 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3801
3802 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3803 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3804 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3805 expression with separately allocated resources.
3806
3807 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3808 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3809 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3810
3811 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3812 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3813 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3814 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3815 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3816 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3817 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3818 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3819 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3820
3821 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3822 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3823 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3824 watched expression from every thread.
3825
3826 @quotation
3827 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3828 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3829 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3830 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3831 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3832 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3833 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3834 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3835 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3836 @end quotation
3837
3838 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3839
3840 @node Set Catchpoints
3841 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3842 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3843 @cindex exception handlers
3844 @cindex event handling
3845
3846 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3847 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3848 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3849
3850 @table @code
3851 @kindex catch
3852 @item catch @var{event}
3853 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3854 @table @code
3855 @item throw
3856 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3857 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3858
3859 @item catch
3860 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3861
3862 @item exception
3863 @cindex Ada exception catching
3864 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3865 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3866 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3867 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3868 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3869
3870 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3871 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3872 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3873 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3874 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3875 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3876 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3877 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3878
3879 @item exception unhandled
3880 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3881
3882 @item assert
3883 A failed Ada assertion.
3884
3885 @item exec
3886 @cindex break on fork/exec
3887 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3888 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3889
3890 @item syscall
3891 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3892 @cindex break on a system call.
3893 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3894 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3895 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3896 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3897 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3898 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3899 will be caught.
3900
3901 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3902 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3903 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3904 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3905
3906 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3907 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3908 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3909 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3910
3911 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3912 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3913 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3914 available choices.
3915
3916 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3917 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3918 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3919 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3920 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3921 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3922 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3923 behind the OS upgrades).
3924
3925 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3926 arguments to it:
3927
3928 @smallexample
3929 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3930 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3931 (@value{GDBP}) r
3932 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3933
3934 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3935 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3936 (@value{GDBP}) c
3937 Continuing.
3938
3939 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3940 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3941 (@value{GDBP})
3942 @end smallexample
3943
3944 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
3945
3946 @smallexample
3947 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
3948 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
3949 (@value{GDBP}) r
3950 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3951
3952 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
3953 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3954 (@value{GDBP}) c
3955 Continuing.
3956
3957 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
3958 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3959 (@value{GDBP})
3960 @end smallexample
3961
3962 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
3963 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
3964 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
3965
3966 @smallexample
3967 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
3968 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
3969 (@value{GDBP}) r
3970 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3971
3972 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
3973 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3974 (@value{GDBP}) c
3975 Continuing.
3976
3977 Program exited normally.
3978 (@value{GDBP})
3979 @end smallexample
3980
3981 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
3982 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
3983 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
3984 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
3985
3986 @smallexample
3987 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
3988 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
3989 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
3990 (@value{GDBP})
3991 @end smallexample
3992
3993 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
3994 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
3995 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
3996 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
3997 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
3998 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
3999
4000 @smallexample
4001 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4002 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4003 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4004 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4005 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4006 (@value{GDBP})
4007 @end smallexample
4008
4009 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4010
4011 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4012 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4013
4014 @smallexample
4015 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4016 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4017 @end smallexample
4018
4019 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4020
4021 @item fork
4022 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4023 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4024
4025 @item vfork
4026 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4027 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4028
4029 @end table
4030
4031 @item tcatch @var{event}
4032 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4033 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4034
4035 @end table
4036
4037 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4038
4039 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4040 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4041
4042 @itemize @bullet
4043 @item
4044 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4045 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4046 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4047 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4048 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4049 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4050 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4051 disabled within interactive calls.
4052
4053 @item
4054 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4055
4056 @item
4057 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4058 @end itemize
4059
4060 @cindex raise exceptions
4061 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4062 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4063 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4064 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4065 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4066 out where the exception was raised.
4067
4068 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4069 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4070 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4071 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4072
4073 @smallexample
4074 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4075 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4076 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4077 @end smallexample
4078
4079 @noindent
4080 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4081 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4082 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4083
4084 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4085 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4086 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4087 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4088 raised.
4089
4090
4091 @node Delete Breaks
4092 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4093
4094 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4095 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4096 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4097 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4098 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4099 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4100
4101 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4102 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4103 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4104 their breakpoint numbers.
4105
4106 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4107 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4108 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4109
4110 @table @code
4111 @kindex clear
4112 @item clear
4113 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4114 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4115 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4116 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4117
4118 @item clear @var{location}
4119 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4120 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4121 most useful ones are listed below:
4122
4123 @table @code
4124 @item clear @var{function}
4125 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4126 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4127
4128 @item clear @var{linenum}
4129 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4130 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4131 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4132 @end table
4133
4134 @cindex delete breakpoints
4135 @kindex delete
4136 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4137 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4138 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4139 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4140 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4141 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4142 @end table
4143
4144 @node Disabling
4145 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4146
4147 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4148 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4149 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4150 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4151 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4152
4153 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4154 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4155 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4156 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4157 do not know which numbers to use.
4158
4159 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4160 affects all of its locations.
4161
4162 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4163 states of enablement:
4164
4165 @itemize @bullet
4166 @item
4167 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4168 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4169 @item
4170 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4171 @item
4172 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4173 disabled.
4174 @item
4175 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4176 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4177 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4178 @end itemize
4179
4180 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4181 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4182
4183 @table @code
4184 @kindex disable
4185 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4186 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4187 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4188 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4189 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4190 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4191 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4192
4193 @kindex enable
4194 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4195 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4196 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4197
4198 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4199 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4200 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4201
4202 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4203 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4204 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4205 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4206 @end table
4207
4208 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4209 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4210 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4211 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4212 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4213 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4214 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4215 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4216 Stepping}.)
4217
4218 @node Conditions
4219 @subsection Break Conditions
4220 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4221 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4222
4223 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4224 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4225 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4226 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4227 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4228 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4229 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4230 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4231
4232 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4233 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4234 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4235 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4236 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4237
4238 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4239 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4240 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4241 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4242 one.
4243
4244 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4245 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4246 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4247 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4248 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4249 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4250 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4251 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4252 conditions for the
4253 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4254 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4255
4256 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4257 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4258 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4259 with the @code{condition} command.
4260
4261 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4262 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4263 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4264 catchpoint.
4265
4266 @table @code
4267 @kindex condition
4268 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4269 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4270 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4271 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4272 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4273 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4274 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4275 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4276 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4277 prints an error message:
4278
4279 @smallexample
4280 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4281 @end smallexample
4282
4283 @noindent
4284 @value{GDBN} does
4285 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4286 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4287 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4288
4289 @item condition @var{bnum}
4290 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4291 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4292 @end table
4293
4294 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4295 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4296 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4297 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4298 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4299 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4300 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4301 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4302 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4303 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4304 your program reaches it.
4305
4306 @table @code
4307 @kindex ignore
4308 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4309 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4310 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4311 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4312 takes no action.
4313
4314 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4315 a count of zero.
4316
4317 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4318 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4319 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4320 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4321
4322 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4323 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4324 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4325
4326 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4327 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4328 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4329 Variables}.
4330 @end table
4331
4332 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4333
4334
4335 @node Break Commands
4336 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4337
4338 @cindex breakpoint commands
4339 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4340 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4341 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4342 enable other breakpoints.
4343
4344 @table @code
4345 @kindex commands
4346 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4347 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4348 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4349 @itemx end
4350 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4351 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4352 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4353
4354 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4355 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4356
4357 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4358 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4359 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4360 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4361 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4362 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4363 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4364 Expressions}).
4365 @end table
4366
4367 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4368 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4369
4370 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4371 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4372 that resumes execution.
4373
4374 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4375 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4376 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4377 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4378 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4379
4380 @kindex silent
4381 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4382 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4383 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4384 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4385 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4386 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4387
4388 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4389 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4390 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4391
4392 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4393 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4394
4395 @smallexample
4396 break foo if x>0
4397 commands
4398 silent
4399 printf "x is %d\n",x
4400 cont
4401 end
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4405 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4406 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4407 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4408 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4409 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4410 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4411
4412 @smallexample
4413 break 403
4414 commands
4415 silent
4416 set x = y + 4
4417 cont
4418 end
4419 @end smallexample
4420
4421 @node Save Breakpoints
4422 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4423
4424 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4425 breakpoints}} command.
4426
4427 @table @code
4428 @kindex save breakpoints
4429 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4430 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4431 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4432 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4433 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4434 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4435 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4436 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4437 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4438 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4439 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4440 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4441 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4442 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4443 that can no longer be recreated.
4444 @end table
4445
4446 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4447 @node Error in Breakpoints
4448 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4449
4450 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4451 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4452
4453 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4454 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4455 @smallexample
4456 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4457 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4458 @end smallexample
4459
4460 @noindent
4461 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4462 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4463 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4464
4465 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4466 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4467
4468 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4469 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4470 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4471
4472 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4473 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4474 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4475 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4476
4477 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4478 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4479 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4480 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4481 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4482 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4483 first in the bundle.
4484
4485 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4486 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4487 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4488 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4489 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4490 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4491 is hit.
4492
4493 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4494 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4495
4496 @smallexample
4497 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4498 @end smallexample
4499
4500 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4501 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4502 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4503 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4504 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4505 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4506 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4507 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4508
4509 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4510 adjusted breakpoints:
4511
4512 @smallexample
4513 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4514 to 0x00010410.
4515 @end smallexample
4516
4517 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4518 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4519 frequently than expected.
4520
4521 @node Continuing and Stepping
4522 @section Continuing and Stepping
4523
4524 @cindex stepping
4525 @cindex continuing
4526 @cindex resuming execution
4527 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4528 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4529 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4530 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4531 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4532 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4533 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4534 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4535
4536 @table @code
4537 @kindex continue
4538 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4539 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4540 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4541 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4542 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4543 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4544 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4545 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4546 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4547 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4548
4549 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4550 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4551 @code{continue} is ignored.
4552
4553 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4554 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4555 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4556 @code{continue}.
4557 @end table
4558
4559 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4560 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4561 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4562 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4563
4564 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4565 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4566 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4567 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4568 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4569 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4570
4571 @table @code
4572 @kindex step
4573 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4574 @item step
4575 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4576 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4577 abbreviated @code{s}.
4578
4579 @quotation
4580 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4581 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4582 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4583 @c distinction here.
4584 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4585 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4586 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4587 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4588 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4589 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4590 below.
4591 @end quotation
4592
4593 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4594 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4595 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4596 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4597 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4598 called within the line.
4599
4600 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4601 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4602 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4603 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4604 was any debugging information about the routine.
4605
4606 @item step @var{count}
4607 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4608 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4609 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4610
4611 @kindex next
4612 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4613 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4614 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4615 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4616 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4617 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4618 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4619 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4620
4621 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4622
4623
4624 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4625 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4626 @c
4627 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4628 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4629 @c function are executed without stopping.
4630
4631 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4632 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4633 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4634
4635 @kindex set step-mode
4636 @item set step-mode
4637 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4638 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4639 @itemx set step-mode on
4640 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4641 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4642 information rather than stepping over it.
4643
4644 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4645 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4646 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4647
4648 @item set step-mode off
4649 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4650 debug information. This is the default.
4651
4652 @item show step-mode
4653 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4654 source line debug information.
4655
4656 @kindex finish
4657 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4658 @item finish
4659 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4660 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4661 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4662
4663 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4664 ,Returning from a Function}).
4665
4666 @kindex until
4667 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4668 @cindex run until specified location
4669 @item until
4670 @itemx u
4671 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4672 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4673 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4674 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4675 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4676 than the address of the jump.
4677
4678 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4679 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4680 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4681 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4682 through the next iteration.
4683
4684 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4685 stack frame.
4686
4687 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4688 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4689 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4690 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4691 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4692
4693 @smallexample
4694 (@value{GDBP}) f
4695 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4696 206 expand_input();
4697 (@value{GDBP}) until
4698 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4699 @end smallexample
4700
4701 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4702 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4703 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4704 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4705 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4706 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4707 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4708
4709 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4710 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4711 argument.
4712
4713 @item until @var{location}
4714 @itemx u @var{location}
4715 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4716 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4717 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4718 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4719 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4720 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4721 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4722 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4723 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4724 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4725 invocations have returned.
4726
4727 @smallexample
4728 94 int factorial (int value)
4729 95 @{
4730 96 if (value > 1) @{
4731 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4732 98 @}
4733 99 return (value);
4734 100 @}
4735 @end smallexample
4736
4737
4738 @kindex advance @var{location}
4739 @itemx advance @var{location}
4740 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4741 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4742 @ref{Specify Location}.
4743 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4744 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4745 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4746 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4747
4748
4749 @kindex stepi
4750 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4751 @item stepi
4752 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4753 @itemx si
4754 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4755
4756 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4757 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4758 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4759 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4760
4761 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4762
4763 @need 750
4764 @kindex nexti
4765 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4766 @item nexti
4767 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4768 @itemx ni
4769 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4770 proceed until the function returns.
4771
4772 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4773 @end table
4774
4775 @node Signals
4776 @section Signals
4777 @cindex signals
4778
4779 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4780 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4781 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4782 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4783 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4784 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4785 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4786 requested an alarm).
4787
4788 @cindex fatal signals
4789 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4790 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4791 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4792 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4793 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4794 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4795
4796 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4797 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4798 signal.
4799
4800 @cindex handling signals
4801 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4802 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4803 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4804 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4805 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4806
4807 @table @code
4808 @kindex info signals
4809 @kindex info handle
4810 @item info signals
4811 @itemx info handle
4812 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4813 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4814 the defined types of signals.
4815
4816 @item info signals @var{sig}
4817 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4818
4819 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4820
4821 @kindex handle
4822 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4823 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4824 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4825 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4826 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4827 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4828 say what change to make.
4829 @end table
4830
4831 @c @group
4832 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4833 Their full names are:
4834
4835 @table @code
4836 @item nostop
4837 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4838 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4839
4840 @item stop
4841 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4842 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4843
4844 @item print
4845 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4846
4847 @item noprint
4848 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4849 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4850
4851 @item pass
4852 @itemx noignore
4853 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4854 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4855 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4856
4857 @item nopass
4858 @itemx ignore
4859 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4860 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4861 @end table
4862 @c @end group
4863
4864 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4865 program until you
4866 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4867 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4868 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4869 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4870 program sees that signal when you continue.
4871
4872 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4873 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4874 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4875 erroneous signals.
4876
4877 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4878 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4879 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4880 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4881 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4882 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4883 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4884 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4885 Program a Signal}.
4886
4887 @cindex extra signal information
4888 @anchor{extra signal information}
4889
4890 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4891 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4892 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4893 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4894 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4895 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4896 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4897 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4898 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4899 system header.
4900
4901 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4902 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4903
4904 @smallexample
4905 @group
4906 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4907 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4908 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4909 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4910 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4911 type = struct @{
4912 int si_signo;
4913 int si_errno;
4914 int si_code;
4915 union @{
4916 int _pad[28];
4917 struct @{...@} _kill;
4918 struct @{...@} _timer;
4919 struct @{...@} _rt;
4920 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4921 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4922 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4923 @} _sifields;
4924 @}
4925 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4926 type = struct @{
4927 void *si_addr;
4928 @}
4929 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4930 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4931 @end group
4932 @end smallexample
4933
4934 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4935
4936 @node Thread Stops
4937 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4938
4939 @cindex stopped threads
4940 @cindex threads, stopped
4941
4942 @cindex continuing threads
4943 @cindex threads, continuing
4944
4945 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4946 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4947 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4948 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4949 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4950 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4951 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4952 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4953 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4954
4955 @menu
4956 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4957 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4958 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4959 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4960 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4961 @end menu
4962
4963 @node All-Stop Mode
4964 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4965
4966 @cindex all-stop mode
4967
4968 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4969 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4970 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4971 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4972 underfoot.
4973
4974 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4975 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4976 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4977
4978 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4979 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4980 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4981 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4982 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4983 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4984 stops.
4985
4986 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4987 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4988 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4989 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4990
4991 @cindex automatic thread selection
4992 @cindex switching threads automatically
4993 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4994 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4995 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4996 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4997 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4998 thread.
4999
5000 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5001 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5005 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5006 @cindex lock scheduler
5007 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5008 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5009 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5010 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5011 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5012 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5013 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5014 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5015 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5016 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5017 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5018 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5019
5020 @item show scheduler-locking
5021 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5022 @end table
5023
5024 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5025 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5026 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5027 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5028 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5029 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5030 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5031 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5032 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5033 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5034 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5035 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5036 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5037 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5038
5039 @table @code
5040 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5041 @item set schedule-multiple
5042 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5043 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5044 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5045 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5046 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5047 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5048
5049 @item show schedule-multiple
5050 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5051 multiple processes.
5052 @end table
5053
5054 @node Non-Stop Mode
5055 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5056
5057 @cindex non-stop mode
5058
5059 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5060 @c with more details.
5061
5062 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5063 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5064 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5065 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5066 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5067 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5068
5069 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5070 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5071 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5072 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5073 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5074 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5075 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5076 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5077 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5078 independently and simultaneously.
5079
5080 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5081 or attach to your program:
5082
5083 @smallexample
5084 # Enable the async interface.
5085 set target-async 1
5086
5087 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5088 set pagination off
5089
5090 # Finally, turn it on!
5091 set non-stop on
5092 @end smallexample
5093
5094 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5095
5096 @table @code
5097 @kindex set non-stop
5098 @item set non-stop on
5099 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5100 @item set non-stop off
5101 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5102 @kindex show non-stop
5103 @item show non-stop
5104 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5105 @end table
5106
5107 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5108 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5109 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5110 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5111 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5112 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5113 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5114 default.
5115
5116 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5117 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5118 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5119
5120 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5121 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5122 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5123 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5124 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5125
5126 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5127 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5128 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5129 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5130 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5131
5132 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5133
5134 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5135 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5136 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5137 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5138 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5139 previously current thread.
5140
5141 @node Background Execution
5142 @subsection Background Execution
5143
5144 @cindex foreground execution
5145 @cindex background execution
5146 @cindex asynchronous execution
5147 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5148
5149 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5150 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5151 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5152 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5153 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5154 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5155
5156 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5157 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5158 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5159
5160 @table @code
5161 @kindex set target-async
5162 @item set target-async on
5163 Enable asynchronous mode.
5164 @item set target-async off
5165 Disable asynchronous mode.
5166 @kindex show target-async
5167 @item show target-async
5168 Show the current target-async setting.
5169 @end table
5170
5171 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5172 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5173
5174 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5175 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5176 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5177 are:
5178
5179 @table @code
5180 @kindex run&
5181 @item run
5182 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5183
5184 @item attach
5185 @kindex attach&
5186 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5187
5188 @item step
5189 @kindex step&
5190 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5191
5192 @item stepi
5193 @kindex stepi&
5194 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5195
5196 @item next
5197 @kindex next&
5198 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5199
5200 @item nexti
5201 @kindex nexti&
5202 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5203
5204 @item continue
5205 @kindex continue&
5206 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5207
5208 @item finish
5209 @kindex finish&
5210 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5211
5212 @item until
5213 @kindex until&
5214 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5215
5216 @end table
5217
5218 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5219 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5220 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5221 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5222 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5223 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5224
5225 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5226 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5227
5228 @table @code
5229 @kindex interrupt
5230 @item interrupt
5231 @itemx interrupt -a
5232
5233 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5234 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5235 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5236 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5237 @end table
5238
5239 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5240 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5241
5242 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5243 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5244 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5248 @cindex thread breakpoints
5249 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5250 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5251 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5252 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5253 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5254 specify some source line.
5255
5256 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5257 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5258 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5259 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5260 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5261
5262 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5263 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5264 program.
5265
5266 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5267 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5268 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5269
5270 @smallexample
5271 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5272 @end smallexample
5273
5274 @end table
5275
5276 @node Interrupted System Calls
5277 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5278
5279 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5280 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5281 @cindex premature return from system calls
5282 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5283 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5284 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5285 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5286 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5287 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5288 stop execution.
5289
5290 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5291 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5292 style anyways.
5293
5294 For example, do not write code like this:
5295
5296 @smallexample
5297 sleep (10);
5298 @end smallexample
5299
5300 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5301 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5302
5303 Instead, write this:
5304
5305 @smallexample
5306 int unslept = 10;
5307 while (unslept > 0)
5308 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5309 @end smallexample
5310
5311 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5312 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5313 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5314 @value{GDBN}.
5315
5316 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5317 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5318 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5319 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5320
5321
5322 @node Reverse Execution
5323 @chapter Running programs backward
5324 @cindex reverse execution
5325 @cindex running programs backward
5326
5327 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5328 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5329 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5330 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5331
5332 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5333 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5334 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5335 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5336 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5337 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5338
5339 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5340 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5341 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5342 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5343 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5344 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5345 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5346 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5347 prior values@footnote{
5348 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5349 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5350 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5351
5352 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5353 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5354 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5355 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5356 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5357 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5358 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5359 }.
5360
5361 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5362 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5363
5364 @table @code
5365 @kindex reverse-continue
5366 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5367 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5368 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5369 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5370 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5371 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5372 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5373
5374 @kindex reverse-step
5375 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5376 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5377 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5378 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5379
5380 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5381 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5382 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5383 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5384 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5385 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5386
5387 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5388 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5389
5390 @kindex reverse-stepi
5391 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5392 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5393 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5394 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5395 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5396 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5397 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5398
5399 @kindex reverse-next
5400 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5401 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5402 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5403 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5404 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5405 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5406 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5407 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5408 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5409 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5410
5411 @kindex reverse-nexti
5412 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5413 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5414 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5415 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5416 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5417 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5418 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5419 frame) is reached.
5420
5421 @kindex reverse-finish
5422 @item reverse-finish
5423 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5424 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5425 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5426 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5427
5428 @kindex set exec-direction
5429 @item set exec-direction
5430 Set the direction of target execution.
5431 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5432 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5433 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5434 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5435 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5436 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5437 @item set exec-direction forward
5438 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5439 This is the default.
5440 @end table
5441
5442
5443 @node Process Record and Replay
5444 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5445 @cindex process record and replay
5446 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5447
5448 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5449 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5450 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5451
5452 @cindex replay mode
5453 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5454 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5455 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5456 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5457 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5458 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5459 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5460 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5461 execution log.
5462
5463 @cindex record mode
5464 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5465 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5466 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5467 for future replay.
5468
5469 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5470 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5471 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5472 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5473 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5474 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5475
5476 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5477 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5478 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5479 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5480
5481 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5482 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5483
5484 @table @code
5485 @kindex target record
5486 @kindex record
5487 @kindex rec
5488 @item target record
5489 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5490 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5491 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5492 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5493 the @kbd{target record} command.
5494
5495 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5496
5497 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5498 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5499 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5500 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5501 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5502
5503 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5504 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5505 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5506 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5507 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5508 support these two modes.
5509
5510 @kindex record stop
5511 @kindex rec s
5512 @item record stop
5513 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5514 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5515 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5516
5517 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5518 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5519 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5520 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5521 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5522
5523 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5524 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5525 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5526 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5527 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5528
5529 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5530 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5531
5532 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5533 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5534 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5535
5536 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5537 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5538 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5539 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5540 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5541 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5542 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5543 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5544
5545 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5546 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5547 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5548
5549 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5550 @item show record insn-number-max
5551 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5552
5553 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5554 @item set record stop-at-limit
5555 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5556 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5557 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5558 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5559 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5560 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5561
5562 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5563 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5564
5565 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5566 @item show record stop-at-limit
5567 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5568
5569 @kindex info record
5570 @item info record
5571 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5572 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5573
5574 @itemize @bullet
5575 @item
5576 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5577 @item
5578 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5579 @item
5580 Highest recorded instruction number.
5581 @item
5582 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5583 @item
5584 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5585 @item
5586 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5587 @end itemize
5588
5589 @kindex record delete
5590 @kindex rec del
5591 @item record delete
5592 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5593 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5594 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5595 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5596 @end table
5597
5598
5599 @node Stack
5600 @chapter Examining the Stack
5601
5602 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5603 stopped and how it got there.
5604
5605 @cindex call stack
5606 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5607 is generated.
5608 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5609 the arguments of the call,
5610 and the local variables of the function being called.
5611 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5612 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5613 stack}.
5614
5615 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5616 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5617
5618 @cindex selected frame
5619 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5620 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5621 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5622 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5623 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5624 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5625
5626 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5627 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5628 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5629
5630 @menu
5631 * Frames:: Stack frames
5632 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5633 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5634 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5635
5636 @end menu
5637
5638 @node Frames
5639 @section Stack Frames
5640
5641 @cindex frame, definition
5642 @cindex stack frame
5643 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5644 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5645 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5646 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5647 which the function is executing.
5648
5649 @cindex initial frame
5650 @cindex outermost frame
5651 @cindex innermost frame
5652 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5653 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5654 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5655 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5656 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5657 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5658 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5659 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5660
5661 @cindex frame pointer
5662 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5663 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5664 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5665 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5666 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5667 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5668
5669 @cindex frame number
5670 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5671 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5672 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5673 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5674 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5675
5676 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5677 @c underflow problems.
5678 @cindex frameless execution
5679 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5680 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5681 @smallexample
5682 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5683 @end smallexample
5684 generates functions without a frame.)
5685 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5686 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5687 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5688 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5689 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5690 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5691 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5692
5693 @table @code
5694 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5695 @cindex current stack frame
5696 @item frame @var{args}
5697 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5698 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5699 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5700 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5701
5702 @kindex select-frame
5703 @cindex selecting frame silently
5704 @item select-frame
5705 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5706 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5707 @code{frame}.
5708 @end table
5709
5710 @node Backtrace
5711 @section Backtraces
5712
5713 @cindex traceback
5714 @cindex call stack traces
5715 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5716 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5717 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5718 stack.
5719
5720 @table @code
5721 @kindex backtrace
5722 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5723 @item backtrace
5724 @itemx bt
5725 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5726 frames in the stack.
5727
5728 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5729 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5730
5731 @item backtrace @var{n}
5732 @itemx bt @var{n}
5733 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5734
5735 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5736 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5737 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5738
5739 @item backtrace full
5740 @itemx bt full
5741 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5742 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5743 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5744 number of frames to print, as described above.
5745 @end table
5746
5747 @kindex where
5748 @kindex info stack
5749 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5750 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5751
5752 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5753 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5754 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5755 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5756 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5757 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5758 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5759 multi-threaded program.
5760
5761 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5762 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5763 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5764 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5765 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5766 line number.
5767
5768 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5769 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5770
5771 @smallexample
5772 @group
5773 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5774 at builtin.c:993
5775 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5776 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5777 at macro.c:71
5778 (More stack frames follow...)
5779 @end group
5780 @end smallexample
5781
5782 @noindent
5783 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5784 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5785 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5786
5787 @noindent
5788 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5789 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5790 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5791 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5792 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5793
5794 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5795 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5796 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5797 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5798 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5799 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5800 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5801 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5802 such a backtrace might look like:
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 @group
5806 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5807 at builtin.c:993
5808 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5809 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5810 at macro.c:71
5811 (More stack frames follow...)
5812 @end group
5813 @end smallexample
5814
5815 @noindent
5816 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5817 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5818
5819 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5820 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5821 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5822
5823 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5824 @cindex program entry point
5825 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5826 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5827 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5828 @code{main}@footnote{
5829 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5830 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5831 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5832 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5833 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5834 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5835
5836 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5837 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5838
5839 @table @code
5840 @item set backtrace past-main
5841 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5842 @kindex set backtrace
5843 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5844
5845 @item set backtrace past-main off
5846 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5847 default.
5848
5849 @item show backtrace past-main
5850 @kindex show backtrace
5851 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5852
5853 @item set backtrace past-entry
5854 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5855 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5856 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5857 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5858
5859 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5860 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5861 application. This is the default.
5862
5863 @item show backtrace past-entry
5864 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5865
5866 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5867 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5868 @cindex backtrace limit
5869 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5870 unlimited.
5871
5872 @item show backtrace limit
5873 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5874 @end table
5875
5876 @node Selection
5877 @section Selecting a Frame
5878
5879 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5880 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5881 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5882 of the stack frame just selected.
5883
5884 @table @code
5885 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5886 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5887 @item frame @var{n}
5888 @itemx f @var{n}
5889 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5890 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5891 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5892 @code{main}.
5893
5894 @item frame @var{addr}
5895 @itemx f @var{addr}
5896 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5897 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5898 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5899 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5900 switches between them.
5901
5902 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5903 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5904
5905 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5906 pointer and a program counter.
5907
5908 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5909 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5910
5911 @kindex up
5912 @item up @var{n}
5913 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5914 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5915 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5916
5917 @kindex down
5918 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5919 @item down @var{n}
5920 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5921 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5922 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5923 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5924 @end table
5925
5926 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5927 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5928 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5929 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5930
5931 @need 1000
5932 For example:
5933
5934 @smallexample
5935 @group
5936 (@value{GDBP}) up
5937 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5938 at env.c:10
5939 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5940 @end group
5941 @end smallexample
5942
5943 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5944 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5945 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5946 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5947 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5948 for details.
5949
5950 @table @code
5951 @kindex down-silently
5952 @kindex up-silently
5953 @item up-silently @var{n}
5954 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5955 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5956 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5957 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5958 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5959 distracting.
5960 @end table
5961
5962 @node Frame Info
5963 @section Information About a Frame
5964
5965 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5966 stack frame.
5967
5968 @table @code
5969 @item frame
5970 @itemx f
5971 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5972 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5973 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5974 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5975 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5976
5977 @kindex info frame
5978 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5979 @item info frame
5980 @itemx info f
5981 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5982 including:
5983
5984 @itemize @bullet
5985 @item
5986 the address of the frame
5987 @item
5988 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5989 @item
5990 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5991 @item
5992 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5993 @item
5994 the address of the frame's arguments
5995 @item
5996 the address of the frame's local variables
5997 @item
5998 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5999 @item
6000 which registers were saved in the frame
6001 @end itemize
6002
6003 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6004 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6005 the usual conventions.
6006
6007 @item info frame @var{addr}
6008 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6009 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6010 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6011 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6012 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6013 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6014
6015 @kindex info args
6016 @item info args
6017 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6018
6019 @item info locals
6020 @kindex info locals
6021 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6022 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6023 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6024
6025 @kindex info catch
6026 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6027 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6028 @item info catch
6029 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6030 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6031 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6032 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6033 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6034
6035 @end table
6036
6037
6038 @node Source
6039 @chapter Examining Source Files
6040
6041 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6042 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6043 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6044 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6045 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6046 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6047 source files by explicit command.
6048
6049 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6050 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6051 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6052
6053 @menu
6054 * List:: Printing source lines
6055 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6056 * Edit:: Editing source files
6057 * Search:: Searching source files
6058 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6059 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6060 @end menu
6061
6062 @node List
6063 @section Printing Source Lines
6064
6065 @kindex list
6066 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6067 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6068 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6069 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6070 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6071
6072 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6073
6074 @table @code
6075 @item list @var{linenum}
6076 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6077 current source file.
6078
6079 @item list @var{function}
6080 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6081 @var{function}.
6082
6083 @item list
6084 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6085 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6086 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6087 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6088 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6089
6090 @item list -
6091 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6092 @end table
6093
6094 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6095 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6096 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6097
6098 @table @code
6099 @kindex set listsize
6100 @item set listsize @var{count}
6101 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6102 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6103
6104 @kindex show listsize
6105 @item show listsize
6106 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6107 @end table
6108
6109 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6110 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6111 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6112 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6113 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6114
6115 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6116 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6117 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6118 to specify some source line.
6119
6120 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6121
6122 @table @code
6123 @item list @var{linespec}
6124 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6125
6126 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6127 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6128 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6129 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6130 the same source file as the first linespec.
6131
6132 @item list ,@var{last}
6133 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6134
6135 @item list @var{first},
6136 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6137
6138 @item list +
6139 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6140
6141 @item list -
6142 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6143
6144 @item list
6145 As described in the preceding table.
6146 @end table
6147
6148 @node Specify Location
6149 @section Specifying a Location
6150 @cindex specifying location
6151 @cindex linespec
6152
6153 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6154 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6155 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6156 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6157
6158 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6159 @value{GDBN} understands:
6160
6161 @table @code
6162 @item @var{linenum}
6163 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6164
6165 @item -@var{offset}
6166 @itemx +@var{offset}
6167 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6168 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6169 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6170 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6171 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6172 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6173 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6174 linespec.
6175
6176 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6177 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6178
6179 @item @var{function}
6180 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6181 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6182
6183 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6184 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6185 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6186 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6187 functions in different source files.
6188
6189 @item *@var{address}
6190 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6191 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6192 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6193 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6194 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6195 source files.
6196
6197 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6198 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6199 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6200 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6201 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6202 of @var{address}:
6203
6204 @table @code
6205 @item @var{expression}
6206 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6207
6208 @item @var{funcaddr}
6209 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6210 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6211 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6212 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6213 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6214 (although the Pascal form also works).
6215
6216 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6217 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6218
6219 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6220 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6221 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6222 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6223 functions with identical names in different source files.
6224 @end table
6225
6226 @end table
6227
6228
6229 @node Edit
6230 @section Editing Source Files
6231 @cindex editing source files
6232
6233 @kindex edit
6234 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6235 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6236 The editing program of your choice
6237 is invoked with the current line set to
6238 the active line in the program.
6239 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6240 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @item edit @var{location}
6244 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6245 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6246 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6247 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6248 command most commonly used:
6249
6250 @table @code
6251 @item edit @var{number}
6252 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6253
6254 @item edit @var{function}
6255 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6256 @end table
6257
6258 @end table
6259
6260 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6261 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6262 @footnote{
6263 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6264 following command-line syntax:
6265 @smallexample
6266 ex +@var{number} file
6267 @end smallexample
6268 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6269 the file where to start editing.}.
6270 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6271 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6272 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6273 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6274 @smallexample
6275 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6276 export EDITOR
6277 gdb @dots{}
6278 @end smallexample
6279 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6280 @smallexample
6281 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6282 gdb @dots{}
6283 @end smallexample
6284
6285 @node Search
6286 @section Searching Source Files
6287 @cindex searching source files
6288
6289 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6290 regular expression.
6291
6292 @table @code
6293 @kindex search
6294 @kindex forward-search
6295 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6296 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6297 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6298 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6299 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6300 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6301 @code{fo}.
6302
6303 @kindex reverse-search
6304 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6305 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6306 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6307 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6308 this command as @code{rev}.
6309 @end table
6310
6311 @node Source Path
6312 @section Specifying Source Directories
6313
6314 @cindex source path
6315 @cindex directories for source files
6316 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6317 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6318 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6319 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6320 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6321 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6322 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6323
6324 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6325 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6326 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6327 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6328 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6329 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6330 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6331 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6332 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6333 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6334 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6335
6336 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6337 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6338 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6339 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6340 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6341 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6342
6343 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6344 source files.
6345
6346 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6347 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6348 each line is in the file.
6349
6350 @kindex directory
6351 @kindex dir
6352 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6353 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6354 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6355
6356 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6357 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6358
6359 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6360 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6361 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6362 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6363 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6364 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6365 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6366 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6367 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6368 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6369 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6370 name to look up the sources.
6371
6372 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6373 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6374 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6375 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6376 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6377 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6378 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6379 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6380
6381 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6382 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6383 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6384 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6385 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6386 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6387 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6388
6389 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6390 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6391 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6392 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6393 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6394 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6395 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6396 command.
6397
6398 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6399 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6400 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6401 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6402 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6403 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6404 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6405
6406 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6407 @cindex default source path substitution
6408 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6409 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6410 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6411 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6412 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6413 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6414 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6415 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6416 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6417 together.
6418
6419 @table @code
6420 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6421 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6422 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6423 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6424 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6425 part of absolute file names) or
6426 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6427 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6428
6429 @kindex cdir
6430 @kindex cwd
6431 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6432 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6433 @cindex compilation directory
6434 @cindex current directory
6435 @cindex working directory
6436 @cindex directory, current
6437 @cindex directory, compilation
6438 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6439 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6440 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6441 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6442 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6443 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6444
6445 @item directory
6446 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6447
6448 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6449 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6450
6451 @item show directories
6452 @kindex show directories
6453 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6454
6455 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6456 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6457 @kindex set substitute-path
6458 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6459 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6460 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6461
6462 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6463 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6464
6465 @smallexample
6466 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6467 @end smallexample
6468
6469 @noindent
6470 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6471 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6472 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6473
6474 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6475 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6476 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6477 the substitution.
6478
6479 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6480
6481 @smallexample
6482 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6483 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6484 @end smallexample
6485
6486 @noindent
6487 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6488 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6489 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6490 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6491
6492
6493 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6494 @kindex unset substitute-path
6495 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6496 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6497 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6498
6499 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6500
6501 @item show substitute-path [path]
6502 @kindex show substitute-path
6503 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6504 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6505
6506 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6507 rules.
6508
6509 @end table
6510
6511 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6512 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6513 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6514
6515 @enumerate
6516 @item
6517 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6518
6519 @item
6520 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6521 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6522 directories in one command.
6523 @end enumerate
6524
6525 @node Machine Code
6526 @section Source and Machine Code
6527 @cindex source line and its code address
6528
6529 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6530 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6531 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6532 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6533 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6534 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6535 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6536 well as hex.
6537
6538 @table @code
6539 @kindex info line
6540 @item info line @var{linespec}
6541 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6542 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6543 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6544 @end table
6545
6546 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6547 the object code for the first line of function
6548 @code{m4_changequote}:
6549
6550 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6551 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6552 @smallexample
6553 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6554 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6555 @end smallexample
6556
6557 @noindent
6558 @cindex code address and its source line
6559 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6560 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6561 @smallexample
6562 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6563 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6564 @end smallexample
6565
6566 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6567 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6568 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6569 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6570 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6571 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6572 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6573 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6574 Variables}).
6575
6576 @table @code
6577 @kindex disassemble
6578 @cindex assembly instructions
6579 @cindex instructions, assembly
6580 @cindex machine instructions
6581 @cindex listing machine instructions
6582 @item disassemble
6583 @itemx disassemble /m
6584 @itemx disassemble /r
6585 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6586 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6587 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6588 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6589 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6590 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6591 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6592 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6593 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6594 arguments specify a range of addresses (first inclusive, second exclusive)
6595 to dump. In that case, the name of the function is also printed (since
6596 there could be several functions in the given range).
6597
6598 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6599 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6600
6601 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6602 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6603 @end table
6604
6605 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6606 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6607
6608 @smallexample
6609 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6610 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6611 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6612 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6613 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6614 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6615 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6616 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6617 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6618 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6619 End of assembler dump.
6620 @end smallexample
6621
6622 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6623 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6624
6625 @smallexample
6626 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6627 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6628 5 @{
6629 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6630 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6631 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6632 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6633 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6634
6635 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6636 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6637 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6638
6639 7 return 0;
6640 8 @}
6641 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6642 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6643 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6644
6645 End of assembler dump.
6646 @end smallexample
6647
6648 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6649 mnemonics or other syntax.
6650
6651 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6652 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6653 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6654 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6655 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6656
6657 @table @code
6658 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6659 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6660 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6661 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6662 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6663 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6664
6665 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6666 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6667 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6668 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6669
6670 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6671 @item show disassembly-flavor
6672 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6673 @end table
6674
6675 @table @code
6676 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6677 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6678 @item set disassemble-next-line
6679 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6680 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6681 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6682 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6683 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6684 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6685 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6686 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6687 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6688 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6689 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6690 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6691 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6692 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6693 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6694 instruction.
6695 @end table
6696
6697
6698 @node Data
6699 @chapter Examining Data
6700
6701 @cindex printing data
6702 @cindex examining data
6703 @kindex print
6704 @kindex inspect
6705 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6706 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6707 @c different window or something like that.
6708 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6709 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6710 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6711 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6712 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
6713 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
6714
6715 @table @code
6716 @item print @var{expr}
6717 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6718 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6719 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6720 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6721 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6722 Formats}.
6723
6724 @item print
6725 @itemx print /@var{f}
6726 @cindex reprint the last value
6727 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6728 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6729 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6730 @end table
6731
6732 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6733 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6734 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6735
6736 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6737 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6738 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6739 Table}.
6740
6741 @menu
6742 * Expressions:: Expressions
6743 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6744 * Variables:: Program variables
6745 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6746 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6747 * Memory:: Examining memory
6748 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6749 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6750 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
6751 * Value History:: Value history
6752 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6753 * Registers:: Registers
6754 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6755 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6756 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6757 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6758 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6759 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6760 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6761 character set than GDB does
6762 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6763 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6764 @end menu
6765
6766 @node Expressions
6767 @section Expressions
6768
6769 @cindex expressions
6770 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6771 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6772 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6773 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6774 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6775 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6776 @ref{Compilation}.
6777
6778 @cindex arrays in expressions
6779 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6780 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6781 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6782 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6783 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6784 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6785
6786 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6787 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6788 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6789 languages.
6790
6791 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6792 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6793
6794 @cindex casts, in expressions
6795 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6796 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6797 at that address in memory.
6798 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6799
6800 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6801 to programming languages:
6802
6803 @table @code
6804 @item @@
6805 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6806 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6807
6808 @item ::
6809 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6810 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6811
6812 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6813 @cindex type casting memory
6814 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6815 @cindex casts, to view memory
6816 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6817 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6818 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6819 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6820 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6821 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6822 @end table
6823
6824 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6825 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6826 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6827
6828 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6829 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6830 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6831 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6832 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6833 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6834 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6835
6836 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6837 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6838 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6839 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6840 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6841 as well.
6842
6843 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6844 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6845 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6846 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6847 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6848 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6849 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6850 choices.
6851
6852 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6853 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6854 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6855
6856 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6857 @smallexample
6858 @group
6859 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6860 [0] cancel
6861 [1] all
6862 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6863 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6864 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6865 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6866 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6867 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6868 > 2 4 6
6869 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6870 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6871 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6872 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6873 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6874 breakpoints.
6875 (@value{GDBP})
6876 @end group
6877 @end smallexample
6878
6879 @table @code
6880 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6881 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6882 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6883
6884 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6885 is ambiguous.
6886
6887 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6888 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6889 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6890 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6891 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6892 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6893 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6894 in the use of the menu.
6895
6896 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6897 when an ambiguity is detected.
6898
6899 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6900 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6901
6902 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6903 @item show multiple-symbols
6904 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6905 @end table
6906
6907 @node Variables
6908 @section Program Variables
6909
6910 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6911 in your program.
6912
6913 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6914 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6915
6916 @itemize @bullet
6917 @item
6918 global (or file-static)
6919 @end itemize
6920
6921 @noindent or
6922
6923 @itemize @bullet
6924 @item
6925 visible according to the scope rules of the
6926 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6927 @end itemize
6928
6929 @noindent This means that in the function
6930
6931 @smallexample
6932 foo (a)
6933 int a;
6934 @{
6935 bar (a);
6936 @{
6937 int b = test ();
6938 bar (b);
6939 @}
6940 @}
6941 @end smallexample
6942
6943 @noindent
6944 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6945 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6946 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6947 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6948
6949 @cindex variable name conflict
6950 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6951 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6952 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6953 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6954 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6955 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6956 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6957
6958 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6959 @ifnotinfo
6960 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6961 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6962 @end ifnotinfo
6963 @smallexample
6964 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6965 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6966 @end smallexample
6967
6968 @noindent
6969 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6970 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6971 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6972 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6973
6974 @smallexample
6975 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6976 @end smallexample
6977
6978 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6979 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6980 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6981 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6982 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6983 @c conflict?? --mew
6984
6985 @cindex wrong values
6986 @cindex variable values, wrong
6987 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6988 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6989 @quotation
6990 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6991 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6992 scope, and just before exit.
6993 @end quotation
6994 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6995 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6996 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6997 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6998 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6999 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7000 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7001 variable definitions may be gone.
7002
7003 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7004 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7005 when compiling.
7006
7007 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7008 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7009 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7010 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7011 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7012 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7013 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7014
7015 @smallexample
7016 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7017 @end smallexample
7018
7019 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7020 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7021 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7022 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7023 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7024 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7025 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7026 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7027 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7028 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7029 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7030
7031 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7032 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7033 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7034 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7035
7036 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7037 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7038 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7039 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7040 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7041 For program code
7042
7043 @smallexample
7044 char var0[] = "A";
7045 signed char var1[] = "A";
7046 @end smallexample
7047
7048 You get during debugging
7049 @smallexample
7050 (gdb) print var0
7051 $1 = "A"
7052 (gdb) print var1
7053 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7054 @end smallexample
7055
7056 @node Arrays
7057 @section Artificial Arrays
7058
7059 @cindex artificial array
7060 @cindex arrays
7061 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7062 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7063 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7064 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7065 program.
7066
7067 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7068 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7069 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7070 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7071 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7072 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7073 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7074 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7075 example. If a program says
7076
7077 @smallexample
7078 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7079 @end smallexample
7080
7081 @noindent
7082 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7083
7084 @smallexample
7085 p *array@@len
7086 @end smallexample
7087
7088 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7089 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7090 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7091 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7092 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7093
7094 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7095 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7096 The value need not be in memory:
7097 @smallexample
7098 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7099 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7100 @end smallexample
7101
7102 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7103 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7104 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7105 @smallexample
7106 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7107 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7108 @end smallexample
7109
7110 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7111 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7112 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7113 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7114 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7115 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7116 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7117 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7118 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7119 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7120
7121 @smallexample
7122 set $i = 0
7123 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7124 @key{RET}
7125 @key{RET}
7126 @dots{}
7127 @end smallexample
7128
7129 @node Output Formats
7130 @section Output Formats
7131
7132 @cindex formatted output
7133 @cindex output formats
7134 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7135 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7136 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7137 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7138 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7139
7140 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7141 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7142 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7143 letters supported are:
7144
7145 @table @code
7146 @item x
7147 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7148 hexadecimal.
7149
7150 @item d
7151 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7152
7153 @item u
7154 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7155
7156 @item o
7157 Print as integer in octal.
7158
7159 @item t
7160 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7161 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7162 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7163 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7164
7165 @item a
7166 @cindex unknown address, locating
7167 @cindex locate address
7168 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7169 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7170 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7171
7172 @smallexample
7173 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7174 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7175 @end smallexample
7176
7177 @noindent
7178 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7179 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7180
7181 @item c
7182 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7183 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7184 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7185 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7186
7187 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7188 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7189 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7190 data.
7191
7192 @item f
7193 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7194 using typical floating point syntax.
7195
7196 @item s
7197 @cindex printing strings
7198 @cindex printing byte arrays
7199 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7200 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7201 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7202 natural types.
7203
7204 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7205 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7206 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7207 array.
7208
7209 @item r
7210 @cindex raw printing
7211 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7212 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7213 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7214 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7215 pretty-printer which might exist.
7216 @end table
7217
7218 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7219
7220 @smallexample
7221 p/x $pc
7222 @end smallexample
7223
7224 @noindent
7225 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7226 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7227
7228 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7229 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7230 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7231
7232 @node Memory
7233 @section Examining Memory
7234
7235 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7236 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7237
7238 @cindex examining memory
7239 @table @code
7240 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7241 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7242 @itemx x @var{addr}
7243 @itemx x
7244 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7245 @end table
7246
7247 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7248 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7249 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7250 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7251 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7252
7253 @table @r
7254 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7255 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7256 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7257 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7258 @c 4.1.2.
7259
7260 @item @var{f}, the display format
7261 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7262 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7263 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7264 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7265 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7266
7267 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7268 The unit size is any of
7269
7270 @table @code
7271 @item b
7272 Bytes.
7273 @item h
7274 Halfwords (two bytes).
7275 @item w
7276 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7277 @item g
7278 Giant words (eight bytes).
7279 @end table
7280
7281 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7282 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7283 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7284 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7285 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7286 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7287 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7288 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7289 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7290 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7291 be altered.
7292
7293 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7294 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7295 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7296 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7297 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7298 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7299 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7300 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7301 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7302 a value from memory).
7303 @end table
7304
7305 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7306 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7307 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7308 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7309 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7310
7311 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7312 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7313 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7314 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7315 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7316
7317 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7318 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7319 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7320 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7321 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7322 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7323 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7324 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7325 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7326
7327 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7328 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7329 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7330 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7331 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7332 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7333 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7334
7335 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7336 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7337
7338 @smallexample
7339 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7340 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7341 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7342 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7343 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7344 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7345 @end smallexample
7346
7347 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7348 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7349 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7350 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7351 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7352 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7353 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7354 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7355 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7356
7357 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7358 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7359 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7360
7361 @cindex remote memory comparison
7362 @cindex verify remote memory image
7363 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7364 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7365 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7366 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7367 situations.
7368
7369 @table @code
7370 @kindex compare-sections
7371 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7372 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7373 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7374 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7375 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7376 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7377 remote request.
7378 @end table
7379
7380 @node Auto Display
7381 @section Automatic Display
7382 @cindex automatic display
7383 @cindex display of expressions
7384
7385 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7386 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7387 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7388 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7389 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7390 The automatic display looks like this:
7391
7392 @smallexample
7393 2: foo = 38
7394 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7395 @end smallexample
7396
7397 @noindent
7398 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7399 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7400 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7401 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7402 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7403 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7404
7405 @table @code
7406 @kindex display
7407 @item display @var{expr}
7408 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7409 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7410
7411 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7412
7413 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7414 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7415 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7416 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7417 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7418
7419 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7420 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7421 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7422 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7423 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7424 @end table
7425
7426 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7427 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7428 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7429
7430 @table @code
7431 @kindex delete display
7432 @kindex undisplay
7433 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7434 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7435 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7436
7437 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7438 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7439
7440 @kindex disable display
7441 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7442 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7443 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7444 enabled again later.
7445
7446 @kindex enable display
7447 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7448 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7449 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7450
7451 @item display
7452 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7453 done when your program stops.
7454
7455 @kindex info display
7456 @item info display
7457 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7458 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7459 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7460 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7461 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7462 @end table
7463
7464 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7465 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7466 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7467 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7468 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7469 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7470 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7471 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7472 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7473 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7474 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7475
7476 @node Print Settings
7477 @section Print Settings
7478
7479 @cindex format options
7480 @cindex print settings
7481 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7482 and symbols are printed.
7483
7484 @noindent
7485 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7486
7487 @table @code
7488 @kindex set print
7489 @item set print address
7490 @itemx set print address on
7491 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7492 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7493 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7494 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7495 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7496 @code{set print address on}:
7497
7498 @smallexample
7499 @group
7500 (@value{GDBP}) f
7501 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7502 at input.c:530
7503 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7504 @end group
7505 @end smallexample
7506
7507 @item set print address off
7508 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7509 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7510
7511 @smallexample
7512 @group
7513 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7514 (@value{GDBP}) f
7515 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7516 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7517 @end group
7518 @end smallexample
7519
7520 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7521 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7522 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7523 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7524
7525 @kindex show print
7526 @item show print address
7527 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7528 @end table
7529
7530 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7531 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7532 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7533 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7534 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7535 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7536 it prints a symbolic address:
7537
7538 @table @code
7539 @item set print symbol-filename on
7540 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7541 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7542 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7543 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7544
7545 @item set print symbol-filename off
7546 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7547 default.
7548
7549 @item show print symbol-filename
7550 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7551 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7552 @end table
7553
7554 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7555 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7556 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7557
7558 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7559 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7560
7561 @table @code
7562 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7563 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7564 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7565 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7566 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7567 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7568
7569 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7570 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7571 symbolic address.
7572 @end table
7573
7574 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7575 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7576 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7577 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7578 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7579 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7580 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7581 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7582
7583 @smallexample
7584 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7585 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7586 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7587 @end smallexample
7588
7589 @quotation
7590 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7591 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7592 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7593 @end quotation
7594
7595 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7596
7597 @table @code
7598 @item set print array
7599 @itemx set print array on
7600 @cindex pretty print arrays
7601 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7602 but uses more space. The default is off.
7603
7604 @item set print array off
7605 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7606
7607 @item show print array
7608 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7609 arrays.
7610
7611 @cindex print array indexes
7612 @item set print array-indexes
7613 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7614 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7615 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7616 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7617
7618 @item set print array-indexes off
7619 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7620
7621 @item show print array-indexes
7622 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7623 arrays.
7624
7625 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7626 @cindex number of array elements to print
7627 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7628 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7629 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7630 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7631 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7632 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7633 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7634
7635 @item show print elements
7636 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7637 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7638
7639 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7640 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7641 @cindex printing frame argument values
7642 @cindex print all frame argument values
7643 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7644 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7645 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7646 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7647 values are:
7648
7649 @table @code
7650 @item all
7651 The values of all arguments are printed.
7652
7653 @item scalars
7654 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7655 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7656 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7657 only scalar arguments are shown:
7658
7659 @smallexample
7660 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7661 at frame-args.c:23
7662 @end smallexample
7663
7664 @item none
7665 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7666 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7667
7668 @smallexample
7669 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7670 at frame-args.c:23
7671 @end smallexample
7672 @end table
7673
7674 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7675 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7676 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7677 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7678 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7679 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7680 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7681 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7682 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7683 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7684
7685 @item show print frame-arguments
7686 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7687
7688 @item set print repeats
7689 @cindex repeated array elements
7690 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7691 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7692 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7693 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7694 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7695 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7696 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7697
7698 @item show print repeats
7699 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7700 elements.
7701
7702 @item set print null-stop
7703 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7704 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7705 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7706 contain only short strings.
7707 The default is off.
7708
7709 @item show print null-stop
7710 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7711 @sc{null} character.
7712
7713 @item set print pretty on
7714 @cindex print structures in indented form
7715 @cindex indentation in structure display
7716 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7717 per line, like this:
7718
7719 @smallexample
7720 @group
7721 $1 = @{
7722 next = 0x0,
7723 flags = @{
7724 sweet = 1,
7725 sour = 1
7726 @},
7727 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7728 @}
7729 @end group
7730 @end smallexample
7731
7732 @item set print pretty off
7733 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7734
7735 @smallexample
7736 @group
7737 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7738 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7739 @end group
7740 @end smallexample
7741
7742 @noindent
7743 This is the default format.
7744
7745 @item show print pretty
7746 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7747
7748 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7749 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7750 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7751 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7752 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7753 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7754 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7755 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7756
7757 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7758 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7759 international character sets, and is the default.
7760
7761 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7762 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7763
7764 @item set print union on
7765 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7766 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7767 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7768
7769 @item set print union off
7770 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7771 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7772 instead.
7773
7774 @item show print union
7775 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7776 structures and other unions.
7777
7778 For example, given the declarations
7779
7780 @smallexample
7781 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7782 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7783 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7784 Bug_forms;
7785
7786 struct thing @{
7787 Species it;
7788 union @{
7789 Tree_forms tree;
7790 Bug_forms bug;
7791 @} form;
7792 @};
7793
7794 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7795 @end smallexample
7796
7797 @noindent
7798 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7799
7800 @smallexample
7801 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7802 @end smallexample
7803
7804 @noindent
7805 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7806
7807 @smallexample
7808 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7809 @end smallexample
7810
7811 @noindent
7812 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7813 and in Pascal.
7814 @end table
7815
7816 @need 1000
7817 @noindent
7818 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7819
7820 @table @code
7821 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7822 @item set print demangle
7823 @itemx set print demangle on
7824 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7825 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7826 linkage. The default is on.
7827
7828 @item show print demangle
7829 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7830
7831 @item set print asm-demangle
7832 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7833 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7834 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7835 The default is off.
7836
7837 @item show print asm-demangle
7838 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7839 or demangled form.
7840
7841 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7842 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7843 @kindex set demangle-style
7844 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7845 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7846 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7847
7848 @table @code
7849 @item auto
7850 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7851
7852 @item gnu
7853 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7854 This is the default.
7855
7856 @item hp
7857 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7858
7859 @item lucid
7860 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7861
7862 @item arm
7863 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7864 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7865 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7866 require further enhancement to permit that.
7867
7868 @end table
7869 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7870
7871 @item show demangle-style
7872 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7873
7874 @item set print object
7875 @itemx set print object on
7876 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7877 @cindex display derived types
7878 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7879 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7880 the virtual function table.
7881
7882 @item set print object off
7883 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7884 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7885
7886 @item show print object
7887 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7888
7889 @item set print static-members
7890 @itemx set print static-members on
7891 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7892 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7893
7894 @item set print static-members off
7895 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7896
7897 @item show print static-members
7898 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7899
7900 @item set print pascal_static-members
7901 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7902 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7903 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7904 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7905
7906 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7907 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7908
7909 @item show print pascal_static-members
7910 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7911
7912 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7913 @item set print vtbl
7914 @itemx set print vtbl on
7915 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7916 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7917 @cindex VTBL display
7918 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7919 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7920 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7921
7922 @item set print vtbl off
7923 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7924
7925 @item show print vtbl
7926 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7927 @end table
7928
7929 @node Pretty Printing
7930 @section Pretty Printing
7931
7932 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
7933 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
7934 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
7935
7936 For example, here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a
7937 pretty-printer:
7938
7939 @smallexample
7940 (@value{GDBP}) print s
7941 $1 = @{
7942 static npos = 4294967295,
7943 _M_dataplus = @{
7944 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
7945 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
7946 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
7947 @},
7948 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
7949 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
7950 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
7951 @}
7952 @}
7953 @end smallexample
7954
7955 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
7956
7957 @smallexample
7958 (@value{GDBP}) print s
7959 $2 = "abcd"
7960 @end smallexample
7961
7962 For implementing pretty printers for new types you should read the Python API
7963 details (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
7964
7965 @node Value History
7966 @section Value History
7967
7968 @cindex value history
7969 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7970 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7971 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7972 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7973 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7974 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7975 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7976 symbol table.
7977
7978 @cindex @code{$}
7979 @cindex @code{$$}
7980 @cindex history number
7981 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7982 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7983 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7984 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7985 history number.
7986
7987 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7988 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7989 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7990 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7991 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7992 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7993 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7994
7995 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7996 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7997
7998 @smallexample
7999 p *$
8000 @end smallexample
8001
8002 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8003 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8004
8005 @smallexample
8006 p *$.next
8007 @end smallexample
8008
8009 @noindent
8010 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8011 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8012
8013 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8014 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8015
8016 @smallexample
8017 print x
8018 set x=5
8019 @end smallexample
8020
8021 @noindent
8022 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8023 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8024
8025 @table @code
8026 @kindex show values
8027 @item show values
8028 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8029 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8030 values} does not change the history.
8031
8032 @item show values @var{n}
8033 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8034
8035 @item show values +
8036 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8037 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8038 @end table
8039
8040 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8041 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8042
8043 @node Convenience Vars
8044 @section Convenience Variables
8045
8046 @cindex convenience variables
8047 @cindex user-defined variables
8048 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8049 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8050 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8051 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8052 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8053
8054 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8055 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8056 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8057 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8058 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8059
8060 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8061 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8062 For example:
8063
8064 @smallexample
8065 set $foo = *object_ptr
8066 @end smallexample
8067
8068 @noindent
8069 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8070 @code{object_ptr}.
8071
8072 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8073 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8074 value with another assignment at any time.
8075
8076 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8077 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8078 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8079 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8080
8081 @table @code
8082 @kindex show convenience
8083 @cindex show all user variables
8084 @item show convenience
8085 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8086 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8087
8088 @kindex init-if-undefined
8089 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8090 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8091 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8092 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8093 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8094 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8095 override default values used in a command script.
8096
8097 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8098 any side-effects do not occur.
8099 @end table
8100
8101 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8102 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8103 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8104
8105 @smallexample
8106 set $i = 0
8107 print bar[$i++]->contents
8108 @end smallexample
8109
8110 @noindent
8111 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8112
8113 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8114 values likely to be useful.
8115
8116 @table @code
8117 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8118 @item $_
8119 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8120 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8121 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8122 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8123 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8124 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8125 to the type of @code{$__}.
8126
8127 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8128 @item $__
8129 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8130 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8131 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8132
8133 @item $_exitcode
8134 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8135 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8136 the program being debugged terminates.
8137
8138 @item $_siginfo
8139 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8140 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8141 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8142 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8143 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8144
8145 @item $_tlb
8146 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8147 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8148 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8149 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8150 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8151 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8152
8153 @end table
8154
8155 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8156 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8157 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8158
8159 @cindex convenience functions
8160 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8161 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8162 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8163 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8164 @value{GDBN}.
8165
8166 @table @code
8167 @item help function
8168 @kindex help function
8169 @cindex show all convenience functions
8170 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8171 @end table
8172
8173 @node Registers
8174 @section Registers
8175
8176 @cindex registers
8177 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8178 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8179 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8180 your machine.
8181
8182 @table @code
8183 @kindex info registers
8184 @item info registers
8185 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8186 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8187
8188 @kindex info all-registers
8189 @cindex floating point registers
8190 @item info all-registers
8191 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8192 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8193
8194 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8195 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8196 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8197 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8198 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8199 @end table
8200
8201 @cindex stack pointer register
8202 @cindex program counter register
8203 @cindex process status register
8204 @cindex frame pointer register
8205 @cindex standard registers
8206 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8207 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8208 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8209 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8210 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8211 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8212 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8213 you could print the program counter in hex with
8214
8215 @smallexample
8216 p/x $pc
8217 @end smallexample
8218
8219 @noindent
8220 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8221
8222 @smallexample
8223 x/i $pc
8224 @end smallexample
8225
8226 @noindent
8227 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8228 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8229 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8230 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8231 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8232 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8233 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8234
8235 @smallexample
8236 set $sp += 4
8237 @end smallexample
8238
8239 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8240 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8241 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8242 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8243 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8244 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8245 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8246
8247 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8248 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8249 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8250 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8251 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8252 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8253 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8254
8255 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8256 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8257 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8258 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8259 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8260 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8261 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8262 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8263 prints the data in both formats.
8264
8265 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8266 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8267 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8268 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8269 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8270 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8271 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8272
8273 @smallexample
8274 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8275 $1 = @{
8276 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8277 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8278 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8279 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8280 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8281 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8282 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8283 @}
8284 @end smallexample
8285
8286 @noindent
8287 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8288 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8289 value to a @code{struct} member:
8290
8291 @smallexample
8292 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8293 @end smallexample
8294
8295 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8296 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8297 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8298 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8299 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8300 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8301
8302 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8303 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8304 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8305 frame makes no difference.
8306
8307 @node Floating Point Hardware
8308 @section Floating Point Hardware
8309 @cindex floating point
8310
8311 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8312 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8313
8314 @table @code
8315 @kindex info float
8316 @item info float
8317 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8318 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8319 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8320 the ARM and x86 machines.
8321 @end table
8322
8323 @node Vector Unit
8324 @section Vector Unit
8325 @cindex vector unit
8326
8327 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8328 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8329
8330 @table @code
8331 @kindex info vector
8332 @item info vector
8333 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8334 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8335 @end table
8336
8337 @node OS Information
8338 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8339 @cindex OS information
8340
8341 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8342 you debug your program.
8343
8344 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8345 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8346 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8347 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8348 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8349 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8350 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8351 structure.
8352
8353 @table @code
8354 @item info udot
8355 @kindex info udot
8356 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8357 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8358 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8359 the @code{examine} command.
8360 @end table
8361
8362 @cindex auxiliary vector
8363 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8364 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8365 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8366 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8367 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8368 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8369 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8370 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8371 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8372 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8373 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8374 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8375
8376 @table @code
8377 @kindex info auxv
8378 @item info auxv
8379 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8380 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8381 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8382 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8383 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8384 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8385 an unrecognized tag.
8386 @end table
8387
8388 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8389 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8390 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8391 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8392
8393 @table @code
8394 @kindex info os processes
8395 @item info os processes
8396 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8397 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8398 the command corresponding to the process.
8399 @end table
8400
8401 @node Memory Region Attributes
8402 @section Memory Region Attributes
8403 @cindex memory region attributes
8404
8405 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8406 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8407 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8408 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8409 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8410 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8411 user can override the fetched regions.
8412
8413 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8414 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8415 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8416 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8417 all memory.
8418
8419 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8420 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8421
8422 @table @code
8423 @kindex mem
8424 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8425 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8426 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8427 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8428 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8429 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8430
8431 @item mem auto
8432 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8433 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8434
8435 @kindex delete mem
8436 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8437 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8438 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8439
8440 @kindex disable mem
8441 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8442 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8443 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8444 It may be enabled again later.
8445
8446 @kindex enable mem
8447 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8448 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8449
8450 @kindex info mem
8451 @item info mem
8452 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8453 for each region:
8454
8455 @table @emph
8456 @item Memory Region Number
8457 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8458 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8459 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8460
8461 @item Lo Address
8462 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8463
8464 @item Hi Address
8465 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8466
8467 @item Attributes
8468 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8469 @end table
8470 @end table
8471
8472
8473 @subsection Attributes
8474
8475 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8476 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8477 write accesses to a memory region.
8478
8479 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8480 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8481 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8482
8483 @table @code
8484 @item ro
8485 Memory is read only.
8486 @item wo
8487 Memory is write only.
8488 @item rw
8489 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8490 @end table
8491
8492 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8493 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8494 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8495 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8496 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8497
8498 @table @code
8499 @item 8
8500 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8501 @item 16
8502 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8503 @item 32
8504 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8505 @item 64
8506 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8507 @end table
8508
8509 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8510 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8511 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8512 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8513 @c
8514 @c @table @code
8515 @c @item hwbreak
8516 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8517 @c @item swbreak (default)
8518 @c @end table
8519
8520 @subsubsection Data Cache
8521 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8522 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8523 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8524 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8525 registers.
8526
8527 @table @code
8528 @item cache
8529 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8530 @item nocache
8531 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8532 @end table
8533
8534 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8535 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8536 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8537 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8538 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8539
8540 @table @code
8541 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8542 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8543 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8544 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8545 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8546 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8547 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8548 The default value is @code{on}.
8549 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8550 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8551 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8552 @end table
8553
8554
8555 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8556 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8557 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8558 @c
8559 @c @table @code
8560 @c @item verify
8561 @c @item noverify (default)
8562 @c @end table
8563
8564 @node Dump/Restore Files
8565 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8566 @cindex dump/restore files
8567 @cindex append data to a file
8568 @cindex dump data to a file
8569 @cindex restore data from a file
8570
8571 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8572 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8573 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8574 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8575 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8576 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8577 files.
8578
8579 @table @code
8580
8581 @kindex dump
8582 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8583 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8584 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8585 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8586
8587 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8588 @table @code
8589 @item binary
8590 Raw binary form.
8591 @item ihex
8592 Intel hex format.
8593 @item srec
8594 Motorola S-record format.
8595 @item tekhex
8596 Tektronix Hex format.
8597 @end table
8598
8599 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8600 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8601 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8602 form.
8603
8604 @kindex append
8605 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8606 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8607 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8608 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8609 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8610
8611 @kindex restore
8612 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8613 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8614 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8615 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8616 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8617
8618 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8619 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8620 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8621 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8622 from that location.
8623
8624 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8625 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8626 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8627 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8628
8629 @end table
8630
8631 @node Core File Generation
8632 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8633 @cindex dump core from inferior
8634
8635 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8636 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8637 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8638 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8639 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8640 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8641 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8642
8643 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8644 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8645 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8646
8647 @table @code
8648 @kindex gcore
8649 @kindex generate-core-file
8650 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8651 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8652 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8653 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8654 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8655 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8656
8657 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
8658 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
8659 @end table
8660
8661 @node Character Sets
8662 @section Character Sets
8663 @cindex character sets
8664 @cindex charset
8665 @cindex translating between character sets
8666 @cindex host character set
8667 @cindex target character set
8668
8669 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
8670 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
8671 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
8672 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
8673 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
8674 @dfn{target character set}.
8675
8676 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
8677 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
8678 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
8679 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
8680 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
8681 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
8682 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
8683 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
8684 character and string literals in expressions.
8685
8686 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
8687 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
8688 target-charset} command, described below.
8689
8690 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
8691 support:
8692
8693 @table @code
8694 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
8695 @kindex set target-charset
8696 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8697 list of supported target character sets, type
8698 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8699
8700 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
8701 @kindex set host-charset
8702 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8703
8704 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8705 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8706 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8707 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8708 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8709
8710 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8711 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8712 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8713
8714 @item set charset @var{charset}
8715 @kindex set charset
8716 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8717 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8718 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8719 for both host and target.
8720
8721 @item show charset
8722 @kindex show charset
8723 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8724
8725 @item show host-charset
8726 @kindex show host-charset
8727 Show the name of the current host character set.
8728
8729 @item show target-charset
8730 @kindex show target-charset
8731 Show the name of the current target character set.
8732
8733 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8734 @kindex set target-wide-charset
8735 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8736 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8737 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8738 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8739
8740 @item show target-wide-charset
8741 @kindex show target-wide-charset
8742 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8743 @end table
8744
8745 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8746 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8747 @file{charset-test.c}:
8748
8749 @smallexample
8750 #include <stdio.h>
8751
8752 char ascii_hello[]
8753 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8754 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8755 char ibm1047_hello[]
8756 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8757 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8758
8759 main ()
8760 @{
8761 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8762 @}
8763 @end smallexample
8764
8765 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8766 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8767 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8768
8769 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8770
8771 @smallexample
8772 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8773 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8774 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8775 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8776 @dots{}
8777 (@value{GDBP})
8778 @end smallexample
8779
8780 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8781 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8782 strings:
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8786 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8787 (@value{GDBP})
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8791 initial character set:
8792 @smallexample
8793 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8794 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8795 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8796 (@value{GDBP})
8797 @end smallexample
8798
8799 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8800 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8801 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8802 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8803 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8804
8805 @smallexample
8806 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8807 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8808 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8809 $2 = 72 'H'
8810 (@value{GDBP})
8811 @end smallexample
8812
8813 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8814 literals you use in expressions:
8815
8816 @smallexample
8817 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8818 $3 = 43 '+'
8819 (@value{GDBP})
8820 @end smallexample
8821
8822 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8823 character.
8824
8825 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8826 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8827 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8828
8829 @smallexample
8830 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8831 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8832 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8833 $5 = 200 '\310'
8834 (@value{GDBP})
8835 @end smallexample
8836
8837 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8838 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8839
8840 @smallexample
8841 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8842 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8843 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8844 @end smallexample
8845
8846 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8847 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8848 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8849 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8850 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8851
8852 @smallexample
8853 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8854 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8855 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8856 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8857 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8858 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8859 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8860 $7 = 72 '\110'
8861 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8862 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8863 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8864 $9 = 200 'H'
8865 (@value{GDBP})
8866 @end smallexample
8867
8868 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8869 string literals you use in expressions:
8870
8871 @smallexample
8872 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8873 $10 = 78 '+'
8874 (@value{GDBP})
8875 @end smallexample
8876
8877 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8878 character.
8879
8880 @node Caching Remote Data
8881 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8882 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8883
8884 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
8885 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8886 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8887 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
8888 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
8889 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
8890 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
8891 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
8892 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
8893 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
8894 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
8895 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
8896 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
8897 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
8898 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
8899
8900 @table @code
8901 @kindex set remotecache
8902 @item set remotecache on
8903 @itemx set remotecache off
8904 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
8905 with old scripts.
8906
8907 @kindex show remotecache
8908 @item show remotecache
8909 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
8910
8911 @kindex set stack-cache
8912 @item set stack-cache on
8913 @itemx set stack-cache off
8914 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
8915 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
8916
8917 @kindex show stack-cache
8918 @item show stack-cache
8919 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
8920
8921 @kindex info dcache
8922 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
8923 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8924 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
8925 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
8926 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
8927 operation.
8928
8929 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
8930 printed in hex.
8931 @end table
8932
8933 @node Searching Memory
8934 @section Search Memory
8935 @cindex searching memory
8936
8937 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8938 @code{find} command.
8939
8940 @table @code
8941 @kindex find
8942 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8943 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8944 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8945 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8946 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8947 @end table
8948
8949 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8950 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8951
8952 @table @r
8953 @item @var{s}, search query size
8954 The size of each search query value.
8955
8956 @table @code
8957 @item b
8958 bytes
8959 @item h
8960 halfwords (two bytes)
8961 @item w
8962 words (four bytes)
8963 @item g
8964 giant words (eight bytes)
8965 @end table
8966
8967 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8968 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8969 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8970
8971 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8972 value's type in the current language.
8973 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8974 pattern as a mixture of types.
8975 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8976 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8977 which is typically four bytes.
8978
8979 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8980 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8981 @end table
8982
8983 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8984 (@code{"}).
8985 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8986 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8987
8988 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8989 number of matches found.
8990
8991 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8992 @samp{$_}.
8993 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8994
8995 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8996
8997 @smallexample
8998 void
8999 hello ()
9000 @{
9001 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9002 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9003 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9004 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9005 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9006 @}
9007 @end smallexample
9008
9009 @noindent
9010 you get during debugging:
9011
9012 @smallexample
9013 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9014 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9015 1 pattern found
9016 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9017 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9018 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9019 2 patterns found
9020 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9021 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9022 1 pattern found
9023 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9024 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9025 1 pattern found
9026 (gdb) print $numfound
9027 $1 = 1
9028 (gdb) print $_
9029 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9030 @end smallexample
9031
9032 @node Optimized Code
9033 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9034 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9035 @cindex debugging optimized code
9036
9037 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9038 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9039 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9040 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9041 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9042 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9043 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9044
9045 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9046 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9047 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9048 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9049
9050 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9051 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9052 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9053 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9054 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9055 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9056
9057 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9058 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9059 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9060 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9061 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9062
9063 @menu
9064 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9065 @end menu
9066
9067 @node Inline Functions
9068 @section Inline Functions
9069 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9070
9071 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9072 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9073 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9074 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9075 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9076 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9077 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9078 @code{info frame} command.
9079
9080 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9081 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9082 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9083 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9084 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9085 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9086 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9087 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9088 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9089 local variables in the caller.
9090
9091 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9092 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9093 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9094 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9095 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9096 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9097 instructions are executed.
9098
9099 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9100 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9101 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9102 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9103
9104 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9105 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9106
9107 @itemize @bullet
9108 @item
9109 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9110 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9111 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9112 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9113 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9114 function instead.
9115
9116 @item
9117 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9118 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9119 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9120 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9121 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9122 or inside the inlined function instead.
9123
9124 @item
9125 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9126 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9127 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9128 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9129
9130 @end itemize
9131
9132
9133 @node Macros
9134 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9135
9136 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9137 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9138 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9139 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9140 where it was defined.
9141
9142 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9143 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9144 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9145 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9146
9147 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9148 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9149 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9150 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9151 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9152 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9153 see @ref{List}.
9154
9155 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9156 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9157 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9158
9159 @table @code
9160
9161 @kindex macro expand
9162 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9163 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9164 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9165 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9166 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9167 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9168 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9169 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9170 it can be any string of tokens.
9171
9172 @kindex macro exp1
9173 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9174 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9175 @cindex expand macro once
9176 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9177 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9178 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9179 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9180 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9181 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9182 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9183 can be any string of tokens.
9184
9185 @kindex info macro
9186 @cindex macro definition, showing
9187 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9188 @item info macro @var{macro}
9189 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9190 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9191
9192 @kindex macro define
9193 @cindex user-defined macros
9194 @cindex defining macros interactively
9195 @cindex macros, user-defined
9196 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9197 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9198 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9199 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9200 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9201 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9202 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9203 @var{arglist}.
9204
9205 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9206 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9207 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9208 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9209 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9210
9211 @kindex macro undef
9212 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9213 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9214 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9215 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9216 in the program being debugged.
9217
9218 @kindex macro list
9219 @item macro list
9220 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9221 @end table
9222
9223 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9224 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9225 show our source files:
9226
9227 @smallexample
9228 $ cat sample.c
9229 #include <stdio.h>
9230 #include "sample.h"
9231
9232 #define M 42
9233 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9234
9235 main ()
9236 @{
9237 #define N 28
9238 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9239 #undef N
9240 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9241 #define N 1729
9242 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9243 @}
9244 $ cat sample.h
9245 #define Q <
9246 $
9247 @end smallexample
9248
9249 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9250 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9251 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9252 information.
9253
9254 @smallexample
9255 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9256 $
9257 @end smallexample
9258
9259 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9260
9261 @smallexample
9262 $ gdb -nw sample
9263 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9264 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9265 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9266 (@value{GDBP})
9267 @end smallexample
9268
9269 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9270 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9271 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9272
9273 @smallexample
9274 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9275 3
9276 4 #define M 42
9277 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9278 6
9279 7 main ()
9280 8 @{
9281 9 #define N 28
9282 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9283 11 #undef N
9284 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9285 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9286 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9287 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9288 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9289 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9290 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9291 #define Q <
9292 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9293 expands to: (42 + 1)
9294 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9295 expands to: once (M + 1)
9296 (@value{GDBP})
9297 @end smallexample
9298
9299 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9300 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9301 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9302 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9303
9304 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9305 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9306
9307 @smallexample
9308 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9309 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9310 (@value{GDBP}) run
9311 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9312
9313 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9314 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9315 (@value{GDBP})
9316 @end smallexample
9317
9318 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9319
9320 @smallexample
9321 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9322 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9323 #define N 28
9324 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9325 expands to: 28 < 42
9326 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9327 $1 = 1
9328 (@value{GDBP})
9329 @end smallexample
9330
9331 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9332 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9333 thereof) in force at each point:
9334
9335 @smallexample
9336 (@value{GDBP}) next
9337 Hello, world!
9338 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9339 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9340 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9341 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9342 (@value{GDBP}) next
9343 We're so creative.
9344 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9345 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9346 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9347 #define N 1729
9348 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9349 expands to: 1729 < 42
9350 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9351 $2 = 0
9352 (@value{GDBP})
9353 @end smallexample
9354
9355 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9356 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9357 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9358 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9359
9360 @smallexample
9361 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9362 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9363 -D__STDC__=1
9364 (@value{GDBP})
9365 @end smallexample
9366
9367
9368 @node Tracepoints
9369 @chapter Tracepoints
9370 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9371 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9372
9373 @cindex tracepoints
9374 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9375 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9376 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9377 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9378 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9379 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9380 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9381
9382 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9383 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9384 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9385 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9386 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9387 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9388 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9389 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9390 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9391 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9392 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9393
9394 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9395 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9396 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9397 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9398 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9399 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9400 Packets}.
9401
9402 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
9403 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
9404 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
9405
9406 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9407
9408 @menu
9409 * Set Tracepoints::
9410 * Analyze Collected Data::
9411 * Tracepoint Variables::
9412 * Trace Files::
9413 @end menu
9414
9415 @node Set Tracepoints
9416 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9417
9418 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9419 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9420 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9421 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9422 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9423 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9424 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9425
9426 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9427 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9428 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9429 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9430 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9431 tracepoint was hit.
9432
9433 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
9434 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
9435 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
9436 either.
9437
9438 @cindex fast tracepoints
9439 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9440 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9441 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9442
9443 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
9444 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
9445
9446 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9447 conditions and actions.
9448
9449 @menu
9450 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9451 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9452 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9453 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9454 * Trace State Variables::
9455 * Tracepoint Actions::
9456 * Listing Tracepoints::
9457 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9458 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
9459 @end menu
9460
9461 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9462 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9463
9464 @table @code
9465 @cindex set tracepoint
9466 @kindex trace
9467 @item trace @var{location}
9468 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9469 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9470 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9471 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9472 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9473 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9474 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9475 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9476 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9477
9478 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9479
9480 @smallexample
9481 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9482
9483 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9484
9485 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9486
9487 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9488
9489 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 @noindent
9493 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9494
9495 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9496 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9497 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9498 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9499 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9500 information on tracepoint conditions.
9501
9502 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9503 @cindex set fast tracepoint
9504 @kindex ftrace
9505 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9506 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9507 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9508 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9509 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9510 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9511 message.
9512
9513 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9514 @code{trace}.
9515
9516 @vindex $tpnum
9517 @cindex last tracepoint number
9518 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9519 @cindex tracepoint number
9520 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9521 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9522
9523 @kindex delete tracepoint
9524 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9525 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9526 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9527 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9528 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9529
9530 Examples:
9531
9532 @smallexample
9533 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9534
9535 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9536 @end smallexample
9537
9538 @noindent
9539 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9540 @end table
9541
9542 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9543 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9544
9545 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9546
9547 @table @code
9548 @kindex disable tracepoint
9549 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9550 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9551 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9552 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9553 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9554
9555 @kindex enable tracepoint
9556 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9557 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9558 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9559 run.
9560 @end table
9561
9562 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
9563 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
9564
9565 @table @code
9566 @kindex passcount
9567 @cindex tracepoint pass count
9568 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
9569 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
9570 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
9571 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
9572 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
9573 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
9574 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
9575 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
9576 user.
9577
9578 Examples:
9579
9580 @smallexample
9581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
9582 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
9583
9584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
9585 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
9586 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9587 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
9588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
9589 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
9590 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
9591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
9592 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
9593 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
9594 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
9595 @end smallexample
9596 @end table
9597
9598 @node Tracepoint Conditions
9599 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
9600 @cindex conditional tracepoints
9601 @cindex tracepoint conditions
9602
9603 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
9604 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
9605 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
9606 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
9607 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
9608 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
9609 is true.
9610
9611 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
9612 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
9613 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
9614 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
9615 just as with breakpoints.
9616
9617 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
9618 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
9619 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
9620 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
9621 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
9622 accesses, and so forth.
9623
9624 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
9625 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
9626 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
9627 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
9628 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
9629 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
9630 search through.
9631
9632 @smallexample
9633 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
9634 @end smallexample
9635
9636 @node Trace State Variables
9637 @subsection Trace State Variables
9638 @cindex trace state variables
9639
9640 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
9641 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
9642 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
9643 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
9644 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
9645 integers.
9646
9647 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
9648 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
9649 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
9650 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
9651
9652 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
9653 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
9654 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
9655 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
9656 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
9657 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
9658 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
9659 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
9660 variable with the same name.
9661
9662 @table @code
9663
9664 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
9665 @kindex tvariable
9666 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
9667 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
9668 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
9669 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
9670 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
9671 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
9672 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
9673 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
9674 value. The default initial value is 0.
9675
9676 @item info tvariables
9677 @kindex info tvariables
9678 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
9679 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
9680 currently running.
9681
9682 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
9683 @kindex delete tvariable
9684 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
9685 are specified.
9686
9687 @end table
9688
9689 @node Tracepoint Actions
9690 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
9691
9692 @table @code
9693 @kindex actions
9694 @cindex tracepoint actions
9695 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9696 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
9697 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
9698 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
9699 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
9700 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
9701 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
9702 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
9703 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
9704 @code{while-stepping}.
9705
9706 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
9707 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
9708 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
9709
9710 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
9711 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
9712 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
9713
9714 @smallexample
9715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
9716
9717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
9718
9719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
9720 @end smallexample
9721
9722 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
9723 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
9724 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
9725 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
9726 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
9727 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
9728 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
9729 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
9730
9731 @smallexample
9732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9734 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
9735 > collect bar,baz
9736 > collect $regs
9737 > while-stepping 12
9738 > collect $pc, arr[i]
9739 > end
9740 end
9741 @end smallexample
9742
9743 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
9744 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9745 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
9746 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
9747 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
9748 special arguments are supported:
9749
9750 @table @code
9751 @item $regs
9752 collect all registers
9753
9754 @item $args
9755 collect all function arguments
9756
9757 @item $locals
9758 collect all local variables.
9759 @end table
9760
9761 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
9762 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
9763 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
9764
9765 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
9766 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
9767
9768 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
9769 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9770 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
9771 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
9772 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
9773 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
9774 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
9775 action were used.
9776
9777 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
9778 @item while-stepping @var{n}
9779 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
9780 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
9781 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
9782 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
9783
9784 @smallexample
9785 > while-stepping 12
9786 > collect $regs, myglobal
9787 > end
9788 >
9789 @end smallexample
9790
9791 @noindent
9792 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
9793 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
9794 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
9795 @code{stepping}.
9796
9797 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9798 @kindex set default-collect
9799 @cindex default collection action
9800 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
9801 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
9802 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
9803 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
9804 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
9805 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
9806
9807 @item show default-collect
9808 @kindex show default-collect
9809 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
9810 tracepoint hit.
9811
9812 @end table
9813
9814 @node Listing Tracepoints
9815 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
9816
9817 @table @code
9818 @kindex info tracepoints
9819 @kindex info tp
9820 @cindex information about tracepoints
9821 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9822 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
9823 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
9824 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
9825 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
9826 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
9827
9828 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
9829 tracing:
9830
9831 @itemize @bullet
9832 @item
9833 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
9834 @end itemize
9835
9836 @smallexample
9837 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
9838 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
9839 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
9840 while-stepping 20
9841 collect globfoo, $regs
9842 end
9843 collect globfoo2
9844 end
9845 pass count 1200
9846 (@value{GDBP})
9847 @end smallexample
9848
9849 @noindent
9850 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
9851 @end table
9852
9853 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9854 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9855
9856 @table @code
9857 @kindex tstart
9858 @cindex start a new trace experiment
9859 @cindex collected data discarded
9860 @item tstart
9861 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
9862 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
9863 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
9864 experiment.
9865
9866 @kindex tstop
9867 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
9868 @item tstop
9869 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
9870 stops collecting data.
9871
9872 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
9873 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
9874 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
9875
9876 @kindex tstatus
9877 @cindex status of trace data collection
9878 @cindex trace experiment, status of
9879 @item tstatus
9880 This command displays the status of the current trace data
9881 collection.
9882 @end table
9883
9884 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
9885
9886 @smallexample
9887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
9888 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9889 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
9890 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
9891 > while-stepping 11
9892 > collect $regs
9893 > end
9894 > end
9895 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9896 [time passes @dots{}]
9897 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
9898 @end smallexample
9899
9900 @cindex disconnected tracing
9901 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
9902 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
9903 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
9904 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
9905 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
9906 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
9907 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
9908 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
9909
9910 @table @code
9911 @item set disconnected-tracing on
9912 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
9913 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
9914 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
9915 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
9916 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
9917 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
9918 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
9919
9920 @item show disconnected-tracing
9921 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
9922 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
9923
9924 @end table
9925
9926 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
9927 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
9928 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
9929 it will continue after reconnection.
9930
9931 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
9932 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
9933 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
9934 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
9935 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
9936 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
9937 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
9938 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
9939 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
9940 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
9941
9942 @cindex circular trace buffer
9943 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
9944 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
9945 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
9946 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
9947 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
9948 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
9949 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
9950 @samp{circular_trace_buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
9951 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
9952 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
9953 the next run.
9954
9955 @table @code
9956 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
9957 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
9958 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
9959 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
9960 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
9961 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
9962 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
9963
9964 @item show circular-trace-buffer
9965 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
9966 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
9967 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
9968 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
9969 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
9970
9971 @end table
9972
9973 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
9974 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
9975
9976 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
9977 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
9978 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
9979 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
9980 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
9981 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
9982 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
9983 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
9984 mentioned here.
9985
9986 @itemize @bullet
9987
9988 @item
9989 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
9990 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
9991 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
9992 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
9993 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
9994 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
9995 cannot be collected either.
9996
9997 @item
9998 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
9999 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
10000 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
10001 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
10002 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
10003 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
10004 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
10005 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
10006 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
10007 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
10008
10009 @item
10010 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
10011 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
10012 in a misleading way.
10013
10014 @item
10015 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
10016 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
10017 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
10018 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
10019 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
10020 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
10021 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
10022 by @code{ptr}.
10023
10024 @item
10025 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
10026 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
10027 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300}
10028 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
10029 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
10030 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
10031 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
10032 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
10033 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
10034 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
10035 invalid address.
10036
10037 @item
10038 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
10039 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
10040 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
10041 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
10042 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
10043 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
10044 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
10045 it to zero.
10046
10047 @end itemize
10048
10049 @node Analyze Collected Data
10050 @section Using the Collected Data
10051
10052 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
10053 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
10054 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
10055 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
10056 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
10057 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
10058 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
10059 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
10060 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
10061 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
10062 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
10063 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
10064 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
10065 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
10066 the buffer will fail.
10067
10068 @menu
10069 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
10070 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
10071 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
10072 @end menu
10073
10074 @node tfind
10075 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
10076
10077 @kindex tfind
10078 @cindex select trace snapshot
10079 @cindex find trace snapshot
10080 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
10081 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
10082 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
10083 snapshot is selected.
10084
10085 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
10086
10087 @table @code
10088 @item tfind start
10089 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
10090 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
10091
10092 @item tfind none
10093 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
10094
10095 @item tfind end
10096 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
10097
10098 @item tfind
10099 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
10100
10101 @item tfind -
10102 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
10103 retracing earlier steps.
10104
10105 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
10106 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
10107 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
10108 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
10109 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
10110
10111 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
10112 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
10113 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
10114 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
10115 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
10116
10117 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10118 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
10119 addresses (exclusive).
10120
10121 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10122 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
10123 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
10124
10125 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
10126 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
10127 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
10128 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
10129 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
10130 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
10131 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
10132 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
10133 @end table
10134
10135 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
10136 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
10137 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
10138 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
10139 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
10140 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
10141 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
10142 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
10143 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
10144 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
10145 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
10146 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
10147 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
10148 tracepoint as the current one.
10149
10150 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
10151 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
10152 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
10153 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
10154 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
10155
10156 @smallexample
10157 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10159 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
10160 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
10161 > tfind
10162 > end
10163
10164 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
10165 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
10166 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
10167 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
10168 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
10169 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
10170 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
10171 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
10172 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
10173 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
10174 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
10175 @end smallexample
10176
10177 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
10178 the buffer:
10179
10180 @smallexample
10181 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10183 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
10184 > tfind line
10185 > end
10186
10187 Frame 0, X = 1
10188 Frame 7, X = 2
10189 Frame 13, X = 255
10190 @end smallexample
10191
10192 @node tdump
10193 @subsection @code{tdump}
10194 @kindex tdump
10195 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
10196 @cindex tracepoint data, display
10197
10198 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
10199 the current trace snapshot.
10200
10201 @smallexample
10202 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
10203 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10204 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
10205 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
10206 > end
10207
10208 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10209
10210 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
10211 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
10212 at gdb_test.c:444
10213 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
10214
10215 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
10216 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
10217 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
10218 d1 0x18 24
10219 d2 0x80 128
10220 d3 0x33 51
10221 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
10222 d5 0x22 34
10223 d6 0xe0 224
10224 d7 0x380035 3670069
10225 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10226 a1 0x3000668 50333288
10227 a2 0x100 256
10228 a3 0x322000 3284992
10229 a4 0x3000698 50333336
10230 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10231 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10232 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10233 ps 0x0 0
10234 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10235 fpcontrol 0x0 0
10236 fpstatus 0x0 0
10237 fpiaddr 0x0 0
10238 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10239 p1 = (void *) 0x11
10240 p2 = (void *) 0x22
10241 p3 = (void *) 0x33
10242 p4 = (void *) 0x44
10243 p5 = (void *) 0x55
10244 p6 = (void *) 0x66
10245 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10246
10247 (@value{GDBP})
10248 @end smallexample
10249
10250 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
10251 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
10252 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
10253 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
10254
10255 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
10256 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
10257 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
10258 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
10259 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
10260 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
10261 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
10262 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
10263 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
10264 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
10265
10266 @node save tracepoints
10267 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
10268 @kindex save tracepoints
10269 @kindex save-tracepoints
10270 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10271
10272 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10273 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10274 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10275 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10276 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
10277 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
10278
10279 @node Tracepoint Variables
10280 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10281 @cindex tracepoint variables
10282 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10283
10284 @table @code
10285 @vindex $trace_frame
10286 @item (int) $trace_frame
10287 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10288 snapshot is selected.
10289
10290 @vindex $tracepoint
10291 @item (int) $tracepoint
10292 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10293
10294 @vindex $trace_line
10295 @item (int) $trace_line
10296 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10297
10298 @vindex $trace_file
10299 @item (char []) $trace_file
10300 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10301
10302 @vindex $trace_func
10303 @item (char []) $trace_func
10304 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10305 @end table
10306
10307 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10308 use @code{output} instead.
10309
10310 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10311 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10312 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10313 which are managed by the target.
10314
10315 @smallexample
10316 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10317
10318 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10319 > output $trace_file
10320 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10321 > tfind
10322 > end
10323 @end smallexample
10324
10325 @node Trace Files
10326 @section Using Trace Files
10327 @cindex trace files
10328
10329 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
10330 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
10331 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
10332 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
10333 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
10334
10335 @table @code
10336
10337 @kindex tsave
10338 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
10339 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
10340 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
10341 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
10342 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
10343 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
10344 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
10345 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
10346 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
10347
10348 @kindex target tfile
10349 @kindex tfile
10350 @item target tfile @var{filename}
10351 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
10352 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
10353 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
10354 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
10355 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
10356 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
10357
10358 @end table
10359
10360 @node Overlays
10361 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10362 @cindex overlays
10363
10364 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10365 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10366 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10367 use overlays.
10368
10369 @menu
10370 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10371 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10372 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10373 mapped by asking the inferior.
10374 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10375 @end menu
10376
10377 @node How Overlays Work
10378 @section How Overlays Work
10379 @cindex mapped overlays
10380 @cindex unmapped overlays
10381 @cindex load address, overlay's
10382 @cindex mapped address
10383 @cindex overlay area
10384
10385 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10386 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10387 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10388 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10389 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10390
10391 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10392 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10393 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10394 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10395 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10396 largest overlay as well.
10397
10398 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10399 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10400 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10401 there.
10402
10403 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10404 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10405 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10406
10407 @smallexample
10408 @group
10409 Data Instruction Larger
10410 Address Space Address Space Address Space
10411 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10412 | | | | | |
10413 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10414 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10415 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
10416 | and heap | | | | | |
10417 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10418 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
10419 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10420 | | | | | |
10421 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10422 address | | | | | |
10423 | overlay | <-' | | |
10424 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10425 | | <---. | | load address
10426 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10427 | | | |
10428 +-----------+ | |
10429 +-----------+
10430 | |
10431 +-----------+
10432
10433 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10434 @end group
10435 @end smallexample
10436
10437 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10438 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10439 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10440 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10441 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10442 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10443 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10444 program and the overlay area.
10445
10446 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10447 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10448 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10449 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10450 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10451 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10452 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10453
10454 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10455 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10456 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10457
10458 @itemize @bullet
10459
10460 @item
10461 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
10462 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
10463 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
10464 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
10465
10466 @item
10467 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
10468 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
10469 your program's performance.
10470
10471 @item
10472 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
10473 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
10474 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
10475 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
10476 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
10477 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
10478 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
10479
10480 @item
10481 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
10482 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
10483 instruction and data spaces.
10484
10485 @end itemize
10486
10487 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
10488 improved in many ways:
10489
10490 @itemize @bullet
10491
10492 @item
10493 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
10494 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
10495 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
10496 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
10497 area in the usual way.
10498
10499 @item
10500 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
10501 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
10502
10503 @item
10504 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
10505 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
10506 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
10507 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
10508 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
10509 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
10510 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
10511
10512 @end itemize
10513
10514
10515 @node Overlay Commands
10516 @section Overlay Commands
10517
10518 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
10519 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
10520 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
10521 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
10522 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
10523 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
10524
10525 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
10526 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
10527
10528 @table @code
10529 @item overlay off
10530 @kindex overlay
10531 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
10532 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
10533 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
10534 overlay support is disabled.
10535
10536 @item overlay manual
10537 @cindex manual overlay debugging
10538 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10539 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
10540 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
10541 commands described below.
10542
10543 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
10544 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
10545 @cindex map an overlay
10546 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
10547 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
10548 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
10549 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
10550 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
10551 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
10552
10553 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
10554 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
10555 @cindex unmap an overlay
10556 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
10557 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
10558 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
10559 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
10560
10561 @item overlay auto
10562 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10563 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
10564 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
10565 Overlay Debugging}.
10566
10567 @item overlay load-target
10568 @itemx overlay load
10569 @cindex reloading the overlay table
10570 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
10571 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
10572 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
10573 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
10574 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
10575
10576 @item overlay list-overlays
10577 @itemx overlay list
10578 @cindex listing mapped overlays
10579 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
10580 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
10581
10582 @end table
10583
10584 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
10585 of the function the address falls in:
10586
10587 @smallexample
10588 (@value{GDBP}) print main
10589 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
10590 @end smallexample
10591 @noindent
10592 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
10593 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
10594 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
10595 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
10596
10597 @smallexample
10598 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10599 No sections are mapped.
10600 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
10601 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
10602 @end smallexample
10603 @noindent
10604 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
10605 name normally:
10606
10607 @smallexample
10608 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10609 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
10610 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
10611 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
10612 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
10613 @end smallexample
10614
10615 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
10616 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
10617 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
10618 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
10619 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
10620
10621 @itemize @bullet
10622 @item
10623 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
10624 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
10625 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
10626 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
10627 @item
10628 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
10629 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
10630 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
10631 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
10632 breakpoints properly.
10633 @end itemize
10634
10635
10636 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
10637 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
10638 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
10639
10640 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
10641 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
10642 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
10643 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
10644 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
10645 current state of the overlays.
10646
10647 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
10648 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
10649
10650 @table @asis
10651
10652 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
10653 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
10654
10655 @smallexample
10656 struct
10657 @{
10658 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
10659 unsigned long vma;
10660
10661 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
10662 unsigned long size;
10663
10664 /* The overlay's load address. */
10665 unsigned long lma;
10666
10667 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
10668 zero otherwise. */
10669 unsigned long mapped;
10670 @}
10671 @end smallexample
10672
10673 @item @code{_novlys}:
10674 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
10675 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
10676
10677 @end table
10678
10679 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
10680 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
10681 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
10682 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
10683 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
10684 currently mapped.
10685
10686 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
10687 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
10688 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
10689 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
10690 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
10691 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
10692 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
10693 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
10694 are not being executed.
10695
10696 @node Overlay Sample Program
10697 @section Overlay Sample Program
10698 @cindex overlay example program
10699
10700 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
10701 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
10702 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
10703 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
10704 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
10705 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
10706 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
10707
10708 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
10709 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
10710 suite. The program consists of the following files from
10711 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
10712
10713 @table @file
10714 @item overlays.c
10715 The main program file.
10716 @item ovlymgr.c
10717 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
10718 @item foo.c
10719 @itemx bar.c
10720 @itemx baz.c
10721 @itemx grbx.c
10722 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
10723 @item d10v.ld
10724 @itemx m32r.ld
10725 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
10726 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
10727 @end table
10728
10729 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
10730 cross-compiler like this:
10731
10732 @smallexample
10733 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
10734 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
10735 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
10736 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
10737 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
10738 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
10739 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
10740 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
10741 @end smallexample
10742
10743 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
10744 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
10745 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
10746
10747
10748 @node Languages
10749 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
10750 @cindex languages
10751
10752 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
10753 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
10754 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
10755 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
10756 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
10757 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
10758
10759 @cindex working language
10760 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
10761 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
10762 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
10763 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
10764 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
10765 language}.
10766
10767 @menu
10768 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
10769 * Show:: Displaying the language
10770 * Checks:: Type and range checks
10771 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
10772 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
10773 @end menu
10774
10775 @node Setting
10776 @section Switching Between Source Languages
10777
10778 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
10779 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
10780 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
10781 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
10782 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
10783 are printed, etc.
10784
10785 In addition to the working language, every source file that
10786 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
10787 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
10788 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
10789 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
10790 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
10791 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
10792 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
10793 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
10794 Displaying the Language}.
10795
10796 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
10797 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
10798 another language. In that case, make the
10799 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
10800 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
10801 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
10802
10803 @menu
10804 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
10805 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
10806 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
10807 @end menu
10808
10809 @node Filenames
10810 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
10811
10812 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
10813 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
10814
10815 @table @file
10816 @item .ada
10817 @itemx .ads
10818 @itemx .adb
10819 @itemx .a
10820 Ada source file.
10821
10822 @item .c
10823 C source file
10824
10825 @item .C
10826 @itemx .cc
10827 @itemx .cp
10828 @itemx .cpp
10829 @itemx .cxx
10830 @itemx .c++
10831 C@t{++} source file
10832
10833 @item .d
10834 D source file
10835
10836 @item .m
10837 Objective-C source file
10838
10839 @item .f
10840 @itemx .F
10841 Fortran source file
10842
10843 @item .mod
10844 Modula-2 source file
10845
10846 @item .s
10847 @itemx .S
10848 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
10849 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
10850 @end table
10851
10852 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
10853 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
10854
10855 @node Manually
10856 @subsection Setting the Working Language
10857
10858 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
10859 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
10860 your program.
10861
10862 @kindex set language
10863 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
10864 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
10865 a language, such as
10866 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
10867 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
10868
10869 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
10870 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
10871 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
10872 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
10873 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
10874 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
10875 command such as:
10876
10877 @smallexample
10878 print a = b + c
10879 @end smallexample
10880
10881 @noindent
10882 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
10883 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
10884 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
10885 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
10886
10887 @node Automatically
10888 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
10889
10890 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
10891 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
10892 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
10893 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
10894 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
10895 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
10896 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
10897 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
10898 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
10899
10900 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
10901 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
10902 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
10903 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
10904 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
10905
10906 @node Show
10907 @section Displaying the Language
10908
10909 The following commands help you find out which language is the
10910 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
10911
10912 @table @code
10913 @item show language
10914 @kindex show language
10915 Display the current working language. This is the
10916 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
10917 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
10918
10919 @item info frame
10920 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
10921 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
10922 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
10923 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
10924 information listed here.
10925
10926 @item info source
10927 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
10928 Display the source language of this source file.
10929 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
10930 information listed here.
10931 @end table
10932
10933 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
10934 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
10935 with a language explicitly:
10936
10937 @table @code
10938 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
10939 @kindex set extension-language
10940 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
10941 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
10942
10943 @item info extensions
10944 @kindex info extensions
10945 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
10946 @end table
10947
10948 @node Checks
10949 @section Type and Range Checking
10950
10951 @quotation
10952 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
10953 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
10954 section documents the intended facilities.
10955 @end quotation
10956 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
10957
10958 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
10959 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
10960 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
10961 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
10962 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
10963 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
10964 errors when your program is running.
10965
10966 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
10967 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
10968 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
10969 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
10970 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
10971 automatically based on your program's source language.
10972 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
10973 settings of supported languages.
10974
10975 @menu
10976 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
10977 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
10978 @end menu
10979
10980 @cindex type checking
10981 @cindex checks, type
10982 @node Type Checking
10983 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
10984
10985 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
10986 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
10987 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
10988 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
10989
10990 @smallexample
10991 1 + 2 @result{} 3
10992 @exdent but
10993 @error{} 1 + 2.3
10994 @end smallexample
10995
10996 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
10997 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
10998
10999 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
11000 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
11001 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
11002 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
11003 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
11004 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
11005 also issues a warning.
11006
11007 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
11008 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
11009 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
11010 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
11011 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
11012 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
11013
11014 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
11015 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
11016 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
11017 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
11018 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
11019 details on specific languages.
11020
11021 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
11022
11023 @kindex set check type
11024 @kindex show check type
11025 @table @code
11026 @item set check type auto
11027 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
11028 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11029 each language.
11030
11031 @item set check type on
11032 @itemx set check type off
11033 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11034 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
11035 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
11036 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
11037 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
11038
11039 @item set check type warn
11040 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
11041 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
11042 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
11043 numbers and structures.
11044
11045 @item show type
11046 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
11047 is setting it automatically.
11048 @end table
11049
11050 @cindex range checking
11051 @cindex checks, range
11052 @node Range Checking
11053 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
11054
11055 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
11056 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
11057 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
11058 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
11059 not exceed the bounds of the array.
11060
11061 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
11062 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
11063 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
11064 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
11065
11066 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
11067 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
11068 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
11069 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
11070 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
11071 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
11072
11073 @smallexample
11074 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
11075 @end smallexample
11076
11077 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
11078 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
11079 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
11080
11081 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
11082
11083 @kindex set check range
11084 @kindex show check range
11085 @table @code
11086 @item set check range auto
11087 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
11088 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11089 each language.
11090
11091 @item set check range on
11092 @itemx set check range off
11093 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11094 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
11095 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
11096 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
11097
11098 @item set check range warn
11099 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
11100 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
11101 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
11102 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
11103 systems).
11104
11105 @item show range
11106 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
11107 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
11108 @end table
11109
11110 @node Supported Languages
11111 @section Supported Languages
11112
11113 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
11114 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
11115 @c This is false ...
11116 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
11117 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
11118 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
11119 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
11120 language.
11121
11122 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
11123 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
11124 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
11125 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
11126 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
11127 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
11128 language reference or tutorial.
11129
11130 @menu
11131 * C:: C and C@t{++}
11132 * D:: D
11133 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
11134 * Fortran:: Fortran
11135 * Pascal:: Pascal
11136 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
11137 * Ada:: Ada
11138 @end menu
11139
11140 @node C
11141 @subsection C and C@t{++}
11142
11143 @cindex C and C@t{++}
11144 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
11145
11146 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
11147 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
11148 together.
11149
11150 @cindex C@t{++}
11151 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
11152 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
11153 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
11154 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
11155 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
11156 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
11157 compiler (@code{aCC}).
11158
11159 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
11160 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
11161 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
11162 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
11163 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
11164 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
11165
11166 @menu
11167 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
11168 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
11169 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
11170 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
11171 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
11172 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
11173 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
11174 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
11175 @end menu
11176
11177 @node C Operators
11178 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
11179
11180 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
11181
11182 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11183 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11184 often defined on groups of types.
11185
11186 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
11187
11188 @itemize @bullet
11189
11190 @item
11191 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
11192 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
11193
11194 @item
11195 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
11196 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
11197
11198 @item
11199 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
11200
11201 @item
11202 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
11203
11204 @end itemize
11205
11206 @noindent
11207 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
11208 in order of increasing precedence:
11209
11210 @table @code
11211 @item ,
11212 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
11213 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
11214 expression being the last expression evaluated.
11215
11216 @item =
11217 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
11218 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
11219
11220 @item @var{op}=
11221 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
11222 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
11223 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
11224 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
11225 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
11226
11227 @item ?:
11228 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
11229 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
11230 integral type.
11231
11232 @item ||
11233 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11234
11235 @item &&
11236 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11237
11238 @item |
11239 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11240
11241 @item ^
11242 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11243
11244 @item &
11245 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11246
11247 @item ==@r{, }!=
11248 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
11249 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
11250
11251 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
11252 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
11253 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
11254 and non-zero for true.
11255
11256 @item <<@r{, }>>
11257 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
11258
11259 @item @@
11260 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11261
11262 @item +@r{, }-
11263 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
11264 pointer types.
11265
11266 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
11267 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
11268 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
11269 integral types.
11270
11271 @item ++@r{, }--
11272 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
11273 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
11274 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
11275 operation takes place.
11276
11277 @item *
11278 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
11279 @code{++}.
11280
11281 @item &
11282 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11283
11284 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11285 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11286 to examine the address
11287 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11288 stored.
11289
11290 @item -
11291 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11292 precedence as @code{++}.
11293
11294 @item !
11295 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11296 @code{++}.
11297
11298 @item ~
11299 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11300 @code{++}.
11301
11302
11303 @item .@r{, }->
11304 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11305 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11306 pointer based on the stored type information.
11307 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11308
11309 @item .*@r{, }->*
11310 Dereferences of pointers to members.
11311
11312 @item []
11313 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11314 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11315
11316 @item ()
11317 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11318
11319 @item ::
11320 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11321 and @code{class} types.
11322
11323 @item ::
11324 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11325 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11326 above.
11327 @end table
11328
11329 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11330 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11331 predefined meaning.
11332
11333 @node C Constants
11334 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11335
11336 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11337
11338 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11339 following ways:
11340
11341 @itemize @bullet
11342 @item
11343 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11344 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11345 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11346 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11347 @code{long} value.
11348
11349 @item
11350 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11351 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11352 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11353 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11354 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11355 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11356 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11357 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11358 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11359 constant.
11360
11361 @item
11362 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11363 integral equivalents.
11364
11365 @item
11366 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11367 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11368 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11369 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11370 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11371 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11372 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11373 @samp{\n} for newline.
11374
11375 @item
11376 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11377 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11378 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11379 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11380 characters.
11381
11382 @item
11383 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11384 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11385
11386 @item
11387 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11388 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11389 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11390 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11391 @end itemize
11392
11393 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
11394 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11395
11396 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11397 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11398
11399 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11400 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
11401 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11402 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11403 @quotation
11404 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11405 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11406 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11407 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11408 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11409 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11410 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11411 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11412 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11413 C@t{++} code.
11414 @end quotation
11415
11416 @enumerate
11417
11418 @cindex member functions
11419 @item
11420 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11421
11422 @smallexample
11423 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11424 @end smallexample
11425
11426 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11427 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11428 @item
11429 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11430 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11431 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11432 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11433
11434 @cindex call overloaded functions
11435 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11436 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11437 @item
11438 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11439 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11440 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11441 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11442 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11443 default arguments.
11444
11445 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11446 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11447 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11448 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11449 number of function arguments.
11450
11451 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11452 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11453 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11454
11455 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11456 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11457 @smallexample
11458 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11459 @end smallexample
11460
11461 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
11462 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
11463
11464 @cindex reference declarations
11465 @item
11466 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
11467 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
11468 dereferenced.
11469
11470 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
11471 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
11472 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
11473 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
11474 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
11475
11476 @item
11477 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
11478 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
11479 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
11480 necessary, for example in an expression like
11481 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
11482 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
11483 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
11484 @end enumerate
11485
11486 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
11487 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
11488 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
11489 invoking user-defined operators.
11490
11491 @node C Defaults
11492 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
11493
11494 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
11495
11496 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
11497 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
11498 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11499 selects the working language.
11500
11501 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
11502 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
11503 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
11504 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
11505 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
11506 for further details.
11507
11508 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
11509 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
11510 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
11511
11512 @node C Checks
11513 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
11514
11515 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
11516
11517 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
11518 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
11519 considers two variables type equivalent if:
11520
11521 @itemize @bullet
11522 @item
11523 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
11524 enumerated tag.
11525
11526 @item
11527 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
11528 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
11529
11530 @ignore
11531 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
11532 @c FIXME--beers?
11533 @item
11534 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
11535 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
11536 compilers.)
11537 @end ignore
11538 @end itemize
11539
11540 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
11541 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
11542 that is not itself an array.
11543
11544 @node Debugging C
11545 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
11546
11547 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
11548 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
11549 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
11550 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
11551
11552 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
11553 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
11554 ,Expressions}.
11555
11556 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
11557 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
11558
11559 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
11560
11561 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
11562 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
11563
11564 @table @code
11565 @cindex break in overloaded functions
11566 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
11567 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
11568 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
11569 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
11570 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
11571
11572 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
11573 @item rbreak @var{regex}
11574 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
11575 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
11576 classes.
11577 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11578
11579 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
11580 @item catch throw
11581 @itemx catch catch
11582 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
11583 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
11584
11585 @cindex inheritance
11586 @item ptype @var{typename}
11587 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
11588 @var{typename}.
11589 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
11590
11591 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
11592 @item set print demangle
11593 @itemx show print demangle
11594 @itemx set print asm-demangle
11595 @itemx show print asm-demangle
11596 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
11597 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
11598 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11599
11600 @item set print object
11601 @itemx show print object
11602 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
11603 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11604
11605 @item set print vtbl
11606 @itemx show print vtbl
11607 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
11608 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11609 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11610 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11611
11612 @kindex set overload-resolution
11613 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
11614 @item set overload-resolution on
11615 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
11616 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
11617 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
11618 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
11619 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
11620 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
11621
11622 @item set overload-resolution off
11623 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
11624 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11625 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
11626 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
11627 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11628 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
11629 argument types.
11630
11631 @kindex show overload-resolution
11632 @item show overload-resolution
11633 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
11634
11635 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
11636 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
11637 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
11638 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
11639 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
11640 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
11641 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
11642 @end table
11643
11644 @node Decimal Floating Point
11645 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
11646 @cindex decimal floating point format
11647
11648 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
11649 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
11650 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
11651 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
11652
11653 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
11654 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
11655 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
11656 target.
11657
11658 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
11659 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
11660 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
11661
11662 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
11663 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
11664 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
11665
11666 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
11667 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
11668 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
11669
11670 @node D
11671 @subsection D
11672
11673 @cindex D
11674 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
11675 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
11676 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
11677
11678 @node Objective-C
11679 @subsection Objective-C
11680
11681 @cindex Objective-C
11682 This section provides information about some commands and command
11683 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
11684 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
11685 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
11686
11687 @menu
11688 * Method Names in Commands::
11689 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
11690 @end menu
11691
11692 @node Method Names in Commands
11693 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
11694
11695 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
11696 names as line specifications:
11697
11698 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
11699 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
11700 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
11701 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
11702 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
11703 @itemize
11704 @item @code{clear}
11705 @item @code{break}
11706 @item @code{info line}
11707 @item @code{jump}
11708 @item @code{list}
11709 @end itemize
11710
11711 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
11712
11713 @smallexample
11714 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
11715 @end smallexample
11716
11717 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
11718 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
11719 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
11720 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
11721 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
11722 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
11723 debugged, enter:
11724
11725 @smallexample
11726 break -[Fruit create]
11727 @end smallexample
11728
11729 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
11730 enter:
11731
11732 @smallexample
11733 list +[NSText initialize]
11734 @end smallexample
11735
11736 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
11737 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
11738 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
11739 is also possible to specify just a method name:
11740
11741 @smallexample
11742 break create
11743 @end smallexample
11744
11745 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
11746 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
11747 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
11748 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
11749 none apply.
11750
11751 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
11752 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
11753
11754 @smallexample
11755 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
11756 @end smallexample
11757
11758 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
11759 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
11760 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
11761 @kindex print-object
11762 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
11763
11764 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
11765
11766 @smallexample
11767 print -[@var{object} hash]
11768 @end smallexample
11769
11770 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
11771 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
11772 @noindent
11773 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
11774 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
11775 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
11776 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
11777 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
11778 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
11779
11780 @node Fortran
11781 @subsection Fortran
11782 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
11783
11784 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
11785 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
11786
11787 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
11788 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
11789 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
11790 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
11791 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
11792 underscore.
11793
11794 @menu
11795 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
11796 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
11797 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
11798 @end menu
11799
11800 @node Fortran Operators
11801 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
11802
11803 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
11804
11805 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11806 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
11807 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
11808
11809 @table @code
11810 @item **
11811 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
11812 of the second one.
11813
11814 @item :
11815 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
11816 represent a section of array.
11817
11818 @item %
11819 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
11820 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
11821 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
11822 union type.
11823 @end table
11824
11825 @node Fortran Defaults
11826 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
11827
11828 @cindex Fortran Defaults
11829
11830 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
11831 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
11832 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
11833 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
11834
11835 @node Special Fortran Commands
11836 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
11837
11838 @cindex Special Fortran commands
11839
11840 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
11841 such as displaying common blocks.
11842
11843 @table @code
11844 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
11845 @kindex info common
11846 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
11847 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
11848 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
11849 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
11850 printed.
11851 @end table
11852
11853 @node Pascal
11854 @subsection Pascal
11855
11856 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
11857 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
11858 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
11859 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
11860 syntax.
11861
11862 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
11863 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
11864 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
11865
11866 @node Modula-2
11867 @subsection Modula-2
11868
11869 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
11870
11871 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
11872 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
11873 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
11874 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11875 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
11876 table.
11877
11878 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
11879 @menu
11880 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
11881 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
11882 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
11883 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
11884 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
11885 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
11886 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
11887 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11888 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11889 @end menu
11890
11891 @node M2 Operators
11892 @subsubsection Operators
11893 @cindex Modula-2 operators
11894
11895 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11896 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11897 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
11898 following definitions hold:
11899
11900 @itemize @bullet
11901
11902 @item
11903 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
11904 their subranges.
11905
11906 @item
11907 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
11908
11909 @item
11910 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
11911
11912 @item
11913 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
11914 @var{type}}.
11915
11916 @item
11917 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
11918
11919 @item
11920 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
11921
11922 @item
11923 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
11924 @end itemize
11925
11926 @noindent
11927 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
11928 increasing precedence:
11929
11930 @table @code
11931 @item ,
11932 Function argument or array index separator.
11933
11934 @item :=
11935 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
11936 @var{value}.
11937
11938 @item <@r{, }>
11939 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
11940 types.
11941
11942 @item <=@r{, }>=
11943 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
11944 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
11945 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
11946
11947 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
11948 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
11949 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
11950 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
11951 comment character.
11952
11953 @item IN
11954 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
11955 Same precedence as @code{<}.
11956
11957 @item OR
11958 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11959
11960 @item AND@r{, }&
11961 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11962
11963 @item @@
11964 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11965
11966 @item +@r{, }-
11967 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
11968 and difference on set types.
11969
11970 @item *
11971 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
11972 on set types.
11973
11974 @item /
11975 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
11976 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
11977
11978 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
11979 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
11980 precedence as @code{*}.
11981
11982 @item -
11983 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
11984
11985 @item ^
11986 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
11987
11988 @item NOT
11989 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
11990 @code{^}.
11991
11992 @item .
11993 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
11994 precedence as @code{^}.
11995
11996 @item []
11997 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
11998
11999 @item ()
12000 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
12001 as @code{^}.
12002
12003 @item ::@r{, }.
12004 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
12005 @end table
12006
12007 @quotation
12008 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
12009 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
12010 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
12011 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
12012 @end quotation
12013
12014
12015 @node Built-In Func/Proc
12016 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
12017 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
12018
12019 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
12020 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
12021
12022 @table @var
12023
12024 @item a
12025 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
12026
12027 @item c
12028 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
12029
12030 @item i
12031 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
12032
12033 @item m
12034 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
12035 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
12036 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
12037
12038 @item n
12039 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
12040
12041 @item r
12042 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
12043
12044 @item t
12045 represents a type.
12046
12047 @item v
12048 represents a variable.
12049
12050 @item x
12051 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
12052 explanation of the function for details.
12053 @end table
12054
12055 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
12056
12057 @table @code
12058 @item ABS(@var{n})
12059 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
12060
12061 @item CAP(@var{c})
12062 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
12063 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
12064
12065 @item CHR(@var{i})
12066 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12067
12068 @item DEC(@var{v})
12069 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12070
12071 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
12072 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12073 new value.
12074
12075 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12076 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
12077 set.
12078
12079 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
12080 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
12081
12082 @item HIGH(@var{a})
12083 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
12084
12085 @item INC(@var{v})
12086 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12087
12088 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
12089 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12090 new value.
12091
12092 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12093 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
12094 there. Returns the new set.
12095
12096 @item MAX(@var{t})
12097 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
12098
12099 @item MIN(@var{t})
12100 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
12101
12102 @item ODD(@var{i})
12103 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
12104
12105 @item ORD(@var{x})
12106 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
12107 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
12108 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
12109 integral, character and enumerated types.
12110
12111 @item SIZE(@var{x})
12112 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12113
12114 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
12115 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
12116
12117 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
12118 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12119
12120 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
12121 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12122 @end table
12123
12124 @quotation
12125 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
12126 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
12127 an error.
12128 @end quotation
12129
12130 @cindex Modula-2 constants
12131 @node M2 Constants
12132 @subsubsection Constants
12133
12134 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
12135 ways:
12136
12137 @itemize @bullet
12138
12139 @item
12140 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
12141 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
12142 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
12143 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
12144
12145 @item
12146 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
12147 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
12148 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
12149 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
12150 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
12151 digits.
12152
12153 @item
12154 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
12155 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
12156 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
12157 followed by a @samp{C}.
12158
12159 @item
12160 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
12161 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
12162 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
12163 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
12164 sequences.
12165
12166 @item
12167 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
12168
12169 @item
12170 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
12171 @code{FALSE}.
12172
12173 @item
12174 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
12175
12176 @item
12177 Set constants are not yet supported.
12178 @end itemize
12179
12180 @node M2 Types
12181 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
12182 @cindex Modula-2 types
12183
12184 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
12185 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
12186 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
12187 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
12188 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
12189 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
12190
12191 The first example contains the following section of code:
12192
12193 @smallexample
12194 VAR
12195 s: SET OF CHAR ;
12196 r: [20..40] ;
12197 @end smallexample
12198
12199 @noindent
12200 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
12201 @code{r} and @code{s}.
12202
12203 @smallexample
12204 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12205 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
12206 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12207 SET OF CHAR
12208 (@value{GDBP}) print r
12209 21
12210 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
12211 [20..40]
12212 @end smallexample
12213
12214 @noindent
12215 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
12216
12217 @smallexample
12218 VAR
12219 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
12220 @end smallexample
12221
12222 @noindent
12223 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
12224
12225 @smallexample
12226 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12227 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
12228 @end smallexample
12229
12230 @noindent
12231 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
12232 expressions using the debugger.
12233
12234 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
12235 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
12236
12237 @smallexample
12238 VAR
12239 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
12240 @end smallexample
12241
12242 @smallexample
12243 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12244 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
12245 @end smallexample
12246
12247 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
12248 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
12249 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
12250 above.
12251
12252 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
12253
12254 @smallexample
12255 TYPE
12256 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
12257 t = [blue..yellow] ;
12258 VAR
12259 s: t ;
12260 BEGIN
12261 s := blue ;
12262 @end smallexample
12263
12264 @noindent
12265 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
12266 and value of a variable.
12267
12268 @smallexample
12269 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12270 $1 = blue
12271 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
12272 type = [blue..yellow]
12273 @end smallexample
12274
12275 @noindent
12276 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
12277 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
12278 their @code{C} counterparts.
12279
12280 @smallexample
12281 VAR
12282 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12283 BEGIN
12284 s[1] := 1 ;
12285 @end smallexample
12286
12287 @smallexample
12288 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12289 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12290 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12291 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12292 @end smallexample
12293
12294 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12295 pointer types as shown in this example:
12296
12297 @smallexample
12298 VAR
12299 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12300 BEGIN
12301 NEW(s) ;
12302 s^[1] := 1 ;
12303 @end smallexample
12304
12305 @noindent
12306 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12307
12308 @smallexample
12309 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12310 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12311 @end smallexample
12312
12313 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12314 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12315 types:
12316
12317 @smallexample
12318 TYPE
12319 foo = RECORD
12320 f1: CARDINAL ;
12321 f2: CHAR ;
12322 f3: myarray ;
12323 END ;
12324
12325 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12326 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12327 VAR
12328 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12329 @end smallexample
12330
12331 @noindent
12332 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12333 below.
12334
12335 @smallexample
12336 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12337 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12338 f1 : CARDINAL;
12339 f2 : CHAR;
12340 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12341 END
12342 @end smallexample
12343
12344 @node M2 Defaults
12345 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12346 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
12347
12348 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12349 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12350 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12351 selected the working language.
12352
12353 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12354 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12355 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12356 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12357
12358 @node Deviations
12359 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12360 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12361
12362 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12363 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12364
12365 @itemize @bullet
12366 @item
12367 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12368 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12369 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12370 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12371 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12372 returned a pointer.)
12373
12374 @item
12375 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12376 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12377 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12378 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12379
12380 @item
12381 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12382 argument.
12383
12384 @item
12385 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12386 @end itemize
12387
12388 @node M2 Checks
12389 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12390 @cindex Modula-2 checks
12391
12392 @quotation
12393 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12394 range checking.
12395 @end quotation
12396 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12397
12398 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12399
12400 @itemize @bullet
12401 @item
12402 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12403 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12404
12405 @item
12406 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12407 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12408 @end itemize
12409
12410 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12411 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12412
12413 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12414 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12415
12416 @node M2 Scope
12417 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12418 @cindex scope
12419 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12420 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12421 @ifinfo
12422 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
12423 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
12424 @end ifinfo
12425 @ifnotinfo
12426 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
12427 @end ifnotinfo
12428
12429 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
12430 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
12431 similar syntax:
12432
12433 @smallexample
12434
12435 @var{module} . @var{id}
12436 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
12437 @end smallexample
12438
12439 @noindent
12440 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
12441 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
12442 identifier within your program, except another module.
12443
12444 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
12445 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
12446 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
12447 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
12448
12449 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
12450 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
12451 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
12452 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
12453 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
12454 @var{module}.
12455
12456 @node GDB/M2
12457 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12458
12459 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
12460 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
12461 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
12462 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
12463 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
12464 analogue in Modula-2.
12465
12466 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
12467 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
12468 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
12469 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
12470 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
12471 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
12472
12473 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
12474 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
12475 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
12476
12477 @node Ada
12478 @subsection Ada
12479 @cindex Ada
12480
12481 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
12482 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
12483 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
12484 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12485 to be difficult.
12486
12487
12488 @cindex expressions in Ada
12489 @menu
12490 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
12491 and semantics supported by Ada mode
12492 in @value{GDBN}.
12493 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
12494 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
12495 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
12496 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
12497 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12498 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
12499 @end menu
12500
12501 @node Ada Mode Intro
12502 @subsubsection Introduction
12503 @cindex Ada mode, general
12504
12505 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
12506 syntax, with some extensions.
12507 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
12508
12509 @itemize @bullet
12510 @item
12511 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
12512 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
12513 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
12514 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
12515
12516 @item
12517 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
12518 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12519
12520 @item
12521 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12522 @end itemize
12523
12524 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
12525 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
12526 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
12527 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
12528 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
12529
12530 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
12531 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
12532 was translated from an Ada source file.
12533
12534 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
12535 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
12536 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
12537 middle (to allow based literals).
12538
12539 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
12540 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
12541 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
12542 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
12543 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
12544 functions to procedures elsewhere.
12545
12546 @node Omissions from Ada
12547 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
12548 @cindex Ada, omissions from
12549
12550 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
12551
12552 @itemize @bullet
12553 @item
12554 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
12555
12556 @itemize @minus
12557 @item
12558 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
12559 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
12560
12561 @item
12562 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
12563
12564 @item
12565 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
12566
12567 @item
12568 @t{'Tag}.
12569
12570 @item
12571 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
12572 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
12573
12574 @item
12575 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
12576 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
12577
12578 @item
12579 @t{'Address}.
12580 @end itemize
12581
12582 @item
12583 The names in
12584 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
12585 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
12586 not currently available.
12587
12588 @item
12589 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
12590 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
12591 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
12592 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
12593 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
12594 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
12595 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
12596 indeterminate values.
12597
12598 @item
12599 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
12600 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
12601 are not implemented.
12602
12603 @item
12604 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
12605 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
12606 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
12607 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
12608 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
12609
12610 @smallexample
12611 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
12612 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
12613 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
12614 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
12615 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
12616 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
12617 @end smallexample
12618
12619 Changing a
12620 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
12621 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
12622 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
12623 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
12624 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
12625 declared to have a type such as:
12626
12627 @smallexample
12628 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
12629 Id : Integer;
12630 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
12631 end record;
12632 @end smallexample
12633
12634 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
12635 assignments:
12636
12637 @smallexample
12638 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
12639 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
12640 @end smallexample
12641
12642 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
12643 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
12644 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
12645 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
12646 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
12647 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
12648 redundant component associations, although which component values are
12649 assigned in such cases is not defined.
12650
12651 @item
12652 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
12653
12654 @item
12655 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
12656 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
12657 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
12658 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
12659 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
12660 the proper resolution.
12661
12662 @item
12663 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
12664
12665 @item
12666 Entry calls are not implemented.
12667
12668 @item
12669 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
12670 formats are not supported.
12671
12672 @item
12673 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
12674
12675 @item
12676 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
12677 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
12678 context.
12679 Should your program
12680 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
12681 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
12682 @end itemize
12683
12684 @node Additions to Ada
12685 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
12686 @cindex Ada, deviations from
12687
12688 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
12689 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
12690
12691 @itemize @bullet
12692 @item
12693 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
12694 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
12695 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
12696 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
12697 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
12698 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
12699 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
12700 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
12701
12702 @item
12703 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
12704 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
12705 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
12706
12707 @item
12708 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
12709 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
12710
12711 @item
12712 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
12713 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
12714 @end itemize
12715
12716 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
12717 additions specific to Ada:
12718
12719 @itemize @bullet
12720 @item
12721 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
12722 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
12723
12724 @smallexample
12725 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
12726 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
12727 @end smallexample
12728
12729 @item
12730 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
12731 the value of its right-hand operand.
12732 This allows, for example,
12733 complex conditional breaks:
12734
12735 @smallexample
12736 (@value{GDBP}) break f
12737 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
12738 @end smallexample
12739
12740 @item
12741 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
12742 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
12743 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
12744 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
12745 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
12746 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
12747 in strings. For example,
12748 @smallexample
12749 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
12750 @end smallexample
12751 @noindent
12752 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
12753 after each period.
12754
12755 @item
12756 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
12757 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
12758 to write
12759
12760 @smallexample
12761 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
12762 @end smallexample
12763
12764 @item
12765 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
12766 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
12767 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
12768 of 3 might print as
12769
12770 @smallexample
12771 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
12772 @end smallexample
12773
12774 @noindent
12775 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
12776 clause.
12777
12778 @item
12779 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
12780 multi-character subsequence of
12781 their names (an exact match gets preference).
12782 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
12783 in place of @t{a'length}.
12784
12785 @item
12786 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
12787 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
12788 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
12789 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
12790 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
12791 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
12792 For example,
12793 @smallexample
12794 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
12795 @end smallexample
12796
12797 @item
12798 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
12799 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
12800 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
12801 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
12802 object.
12803
12804 @end itemize
12805
12806 @node Stopping Before Main Program
12807 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
12808
12809 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
12810 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
12811 before reaching the main procedure.
12812 As defined in the Ada Reference
12813 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
12814 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
12815 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
12816 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
12817
12818 @node Ada Tasks
12819 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
12820 @cindex Ada, tasking
12821
12822 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
12823 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
12824
12825 @table @code
12826 @kindex info tasks
12827 @item info tasks
12828 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
12829
12830
12831 @smallexample
12832 @iftex
12833 @leftskip=0.5cm
12834 @end iftex
12835 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12836 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12837 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12838 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
12839 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
12840 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
12841
12842 @end smallexample
12843
12844 @noindent
12845 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
12846 task currently being inspected.
12847
12848 @table @asis
12849 @item ID
12850 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
12851
12852 @item TID
12853 The Ada task ID.
12854
12855 @item P-ID
12856 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
12857
12858 @item Pri
12859 The base priority of the task.
12860
12861 @item State
12862 Current state of the task.
12863
12864 @table @code
12865 @item Unactivated
12866 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
12867 executing.
12868
12869 @item Runnable
12870 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
12871 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
12872
12873 @item Terminated
12874 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
12875 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
12876 terminated themselves.
12877
12878 @item Child Activation Wait
12879 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
12880
12881 @item Accept Statement
12882 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
12883
12884 @item Waiting on entry call
12885 The task is waiting on an entry call.
12886
12887 @item Async Select Wait
12888 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
12889 select statement.
12890
12891 @item Delay Sleep
12892 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
12893 alternative open.
12894
12895 @item Child Termination Wait
12896 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
12897 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
12898 waiting on a terminate Phase.
12899
12900 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
12901 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
12902 finish terminating.
12903
12904 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
12905 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
12906 @end table
12907
12908 @item Name
12909 Name of the task in the program.
12910
12911 @end table
12912
12913 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
12914 @item info task @var{taskno}
12915 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
12916 the following example:
12917 @smallexample
12918 @iftex
12919 @leftskip=0.5cm
12920 @end iftex
12921 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12922 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12923 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12924 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
12925 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
12926 Ada Task: 0x807c468
12927 Name: task_1
12928 Thread: 0x807f378
12929 Parent: 1 (main_task)
12930 Base Priority: 15
12931 State: Runnable
12932 @end smallexample
12933
12934 @item task
12935 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
12936 @cindex current Ada task ID
12937 This command prints the ID of the current task.
12938
12939 @smallexample
12940 @iftex
12941 @leftskip=0.5cm
12942 @end iftex
12943 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12944 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12945 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12946 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12947 (@value{GDBP}) task
12948 [Current task is 2]
12949 @end smallexample
12950
12951 @item task @var{taskno}
12952 @cindex Ada task switching
12953 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
12954 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
12955 from the current task to the given task.
12956
12957 @smallexample
12958 @iftex
12959 @leftskip=0.5cm
12960 @end iftex
12961 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12962 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12963 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12964 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12965 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
12966 [Switching to task 1]
12967 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12968 (@value{GDBP}) bt
12969 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12970 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
12971 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
12972 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
12973 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
12974 @end smallexample
12975
12976 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
12977 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
12978 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
12979 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
12980 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
12981 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
12982 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
12983 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
12984 in @ref{Specify Location}.
12985
12986 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
12987 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
12988 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
12989 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
12990 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
12991
12992 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
12993 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
12994 program.
12995
12996 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
12997 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
12998 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
12999
13000 For example,
13001
13002 @smallexample
13003 @iftex
13004 @leftskip=0.5cm
13005 @end iftex
13006 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13007 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13008 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13009 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
13010 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13011 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
13012 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
13013 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
13014 (@value{GDBP}) cont
13015 Continuing.
13016 task # 1 running
13017 task # 2 running
13018
13019 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
13020 15 flush;
13021 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13022 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13023 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13024 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
13025 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13026 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
13027 @end smallexample
13028 @end table
13029
13030 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
13031 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13032 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
13033
13034 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
13035 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
13036 the platform being used.
13037 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
13038 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
13039 as usual.
13040
13041 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
13042 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
13043 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
13044 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
13045 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
13046 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
13047
13048 @node Ada Glitches
13049 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
13050 @cindex Ada, problems
13051
13052 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
13053 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
13054 @value{GDBN},
13055 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
13056 and the GNU Ada compiler.
13057
13058 @itemize @bullet
13059 @item
13060 Currently, the debugger
13061 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
13062 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
13063 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
13064 to get it printed properly.
13065
13066 @item
13067 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
13068 storage are invisible to the debugger.
13069
13070 @item
13071 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
13072 argument lists are treated as positional).
13073
13074 @item
13075 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
13076
13077 @item
13078 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
13079 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
13080 the host machine.
13081
13082 @item
13083 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
13084 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
13085 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
13086 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
13087 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
13088 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
13089 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
13090 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
13091 you can usually resolve the confusion
13092 by qualifying the problematic names with package
13093 @code{Standard} explicitly.
13094 @end itemize
13095
13096 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
13097 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
13098 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
13099 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
13100 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
13101 enabled.
13102
13103 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13104 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13105 @table @code
13106
13107 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
13108 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
13109 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
13110 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
13111 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
13112 This is the default.
13113
13114 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
13115 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
13116 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
13117 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
13118 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
13119 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
13120 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
13121
13122 @end table
13123
13124 @node Unsupported Languages
13125 @section Unsupported Languages
13126
13127 @cindex unsupported languages
13128 @cindex minimal language
13129 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
13130 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
13131 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
13132 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
13133 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
13134 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
13135
13136 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
13137 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
13138 language.
13139
13140 @node Symbols
13141 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
13142
13143 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
13144 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
13145 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
13146 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
13147 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
13148 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
13149 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13150
13151 @cindex symbol names
13152 @cindex names of symbols
13153 @cindex quoting names
13154 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
13155 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
13156 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
13157 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
13158 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
13159 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
13160 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
13161 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
13162
13163 @smallexample
13164 p 'foo.c'::x
13165 @end smallexample
13166
13167 @noindent
13168 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
13169
13170 @table @code
13171 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
13172 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
13173 @kindex set case-sensitive
13174 @item set case-sensitive on
13175 @itemx set case-sensitive off
13176 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
13177 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
13178 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
13179 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
13180 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
13181 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
13182 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
13183 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
13184 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
13185 case-insensitive matches.
13186
13187 @kindex show case-sensitive
13188 @item show case-sensitive
13189 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
13190 lookups.
13191
13192 @kindex info address
13193 @cindex address of a symbol
13194 @item info address @var{symbol}
13195 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
13196 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
13197 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
13198 is always stored.
13199
13200 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
13201 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
13202 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
13203
13204 @kindex info symbol
13205 @cindex symbol from address
13206 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
13207 @item info symbol @var{addr}
13208 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
13209 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
13210 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
13211
13212 @smallexample
13213 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
13214 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
13215 @end smallexample
13216
13217 @noindent
13218 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
13219 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
13220
13221 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
13222 library containing the symbol is also printed:
13223
13224 @smallexample
13225 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
13226 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
13227 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
13228 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
13229 @end smallexample
13230
13231 @kindex whatis
13232 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
13233 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
13234 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
13235 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
13236 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
13237 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
13238 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
13239 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
13240 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
13241 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
13242 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13243
13244 @kindex ptype
13245 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
13246 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
13247 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
13248 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13249
13250 For example, for this variable declaration:
13251
13252 @smallexample
13253 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
13254 @end smallexample
13255
13256 @noindent
13257 the two commands give this output:
13258
13259 @smallexample
13260 @group
13261 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
13262 type = struct complex
13263 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
13264 type = struct complex @{
13265 double real;
13266 double imag;
13267 @}
13268 @end group
13269 @end smallexample
13270
13271 @noindent
13272 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
13273 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
13274
13275 @cindex incomplete type
13276 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
13277 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
13278 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
13279 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
13280 given these declarations:
13281
13282 @smallexample
13283 struct foo;
13284 struct foo *fooptr;
13285 @end smallexample
13286
13287 @noindent
13288 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
13289
13290 @smallexample
13291 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
13292 $1 = <incomplete type>
13293 @end smallexample
13294
13295 @noindent
13296 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
13297 completely specified.
13298
13299 @kindex info types
13300 @item info types @var{regexp}
13301 @itemx info types
13302 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
13303 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
13304 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
13305 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
13306 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
13307 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
13308 name is @code{value}.
13309
13310 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
13311 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
13312 lists all source files where a type is defined.
13313
13314 @kindex info scope
13315 @cindex local variables
13316 @item info scope @var{location}
13317 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13318 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13319 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13320 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13321 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13322
13323 @smallexample
13324 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13325 Scope for command_line_handler:
13326 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13327 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13328 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13329 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13330 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13331 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13332 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13333 @end smallexample
13334
13335 @noindent
13336 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13337 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13338 collect}.
13339
13340 @kindex info source
13341 @item info source
13342 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13343 the function containing the current point of execution:
13344 @itemize @bullet
13345 @item
13346 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13347 @item
13348 the directory it was compiled in,
13349 @item
13350 its length, in lines,
13351 @item
13352 which programming language it is written in,
13353 @item
13354 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13355 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13356 @item
13357 whether the debugging information includes information about
13358 preprocessor macros.
13359 @end itemize
13360
13361
13362 @kindex info sources
13363 @item info sources
13364 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13365 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13366 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13367
13368 @kindex info functions
13369 @item info functions
13370 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13371
13372 @item info functions @var{regexp}
13373 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13374 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13375 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13376 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13377 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13378 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13379 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13380
13381 @kindex info variables
13382 @item info variables
13383 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13384 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13385
13386 @item info variables @var{regexp}
13387 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13388 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13389 @var{regexp}.
13390
13391 @kindex info classes
13392 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13393 @item info classes
13394 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13395 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13396 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13397 expression.
13398
13399 @kindex info selectors
13400 @item info selectors
13401 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
13402 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
13403 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13404 expression.
13405
13406 @ignore
13407 This was never implemented.
13408 @kindex info methods
13409 @item info methods
13410 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
13411 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
13412 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
13413 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
13414 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
13415 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
13416 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
13417 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
13418 @end ignore
13419
13420 @cindex reloading symbols
13421 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
13422 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
13423 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
13424 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
13425 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
13426
13427 @table @code
13428 @kindex set symbol-reloading
13429 @item set symbol-reloading on
13430 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
13431 object file with a particular name is seen again.
13432
13433 @item set symbol-reloading off
13434 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
13435 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
13436 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
13437 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
13438 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
13439 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
13440 name.
13441
13442 @kindex show symbol-reloading
13443 @item show symbol-reloading
13444 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
13445 @end table
13446
13447 @cindex opaque data types
13448 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
13449 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
13450 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
13451 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
13452 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
13453 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
13454 another source file. The default is on.
13455
13456 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
13457 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
13458
13459 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
13460 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
13461 is printed as follows:
13462 @smallexample
13463 @{<no data fields>@}
13464 @end smallexample
13465
13466 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
13467 @item show opaque-type-resolution
13468 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
13469
13470 @kindex maint print symbols
13471 @cindex symbol dump
13472 @kindex maint print psymbols
13473 @cindex partial symbol dump
13474 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
13475 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
13476 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
13477 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
13478 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
13479 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
13480 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
13481 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
13482 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
13483 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
13484 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
13485 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
13486 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
13487 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
13488 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
13489 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
13490 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
13491
13492 @kindex maint info symtabs
13493 @kindex maint info psymtabs
13494 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
13495 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13496 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13497 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13498 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13499 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13500
13501 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
13502 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
13503 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
13504 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
13505 structure in more detail. For example:
13506
13507 @smallexample
13508 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
13509 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13510 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13511 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13512 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
13513 readin no
13514 fullname (null)
13515 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
13516 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
13517 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
13518 dependencies (none)
13519 @}
13520 @}
13521 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13522 (@value{GDBP})
13523 @end smallexample
13524 @noindent
13525 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
13526 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
13527 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
13528 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
13529 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
13530
13531 @smallexample
13532 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
13533 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
13534 line 1574.
13535 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13536 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13537 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13538 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13539 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
13540 dirname (null)
13541 fullname (null)
13542 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
13543 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
13544 debugformat DWARF 2
13545 @}
13546 @}
13547 (@value{GDBP})
13548 @end smallexample
13549 @end table
13550
13551
13552 @node Altering
13553 @chapter Altering Execution
13554
13555 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
13556 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
13557 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
13558 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
13559 program.
13560
13561 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
13562 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
13563 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
13564
13565 @menu
13566 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
13567 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
13568 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
13569 * Returning:: Returning from a function
13570 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
13571 * Patching:: Patching your program
13572 @end menu
13573
13574 @node Assignment
13575 @section Assignment to Variables
13576
13577 @cindex assignment
13578 @cindex setting variables
13579 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
13580 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
13581
13582 @smallexample
13583 print x=4
13584 @end smallexample
13585
13586 @noindent
13587 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
13588 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
13589 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
13590 information on operators in supported languages.
13591
13592 @kindex set variable
13593 @cindex variables, setting
13594 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
13595 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
13596 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
13597 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
13598 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
13599
13600 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
13601 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
13602 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
13603 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
13604 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
13605 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
13606 command @code{set width}:
13607
13608 @smallexample
13609 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
13610 type = double
13611 (@value{GDBP}) p width
13612 $4 = 13
13613 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
13614 Invalid syntax in expression.
13615 @end smallexample
13616
13617 @noindent
13618 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
13619 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
13620
13621 @smallexample
13622 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
13623 @end smallexample
13624
13625 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
13626 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
13627 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
13628 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
13629 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
13630 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
13631
13632 @smallexample
13633 @group
13634 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
13635 type = double
13636 (@value{GDBP}) p g
13637 $1 = 1
13638 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
13639 (@value{GDBP}) p g
13640 $2 = 1
13641 (@value{GDBP}) r
13642 The program being debugged has been started already.
13643 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
13644 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
13645 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
13646 Invalid bfd target.
13647 (@value{GDBP}) show g
13648 The current BFD target is "=4".
13649 @end group
13650 @end smallexample
13651
13652 @noindent
13653 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
13654 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
13655 @code{g}, use
13656
13657 @smallexample
13658 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
13659 @end smallexample
13660
13661 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
13662 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
13663 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
13664 same length or shorter.
13665 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
13666 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
13667
13668 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
13669 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
13670 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
13671 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
13672 and representation in memory), and
13673
13674 @smallexample
13675 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
13676 @end smallexample
13677
13678 @noindent
13679 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
13680
13681 @node Jumping
13682 @section Continuing at a Different Address
13683
13684 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
13685 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
13686 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
13687
13688 @table @code
13689 @kindex jump
13690 @item jump @var{linespec}
13691 @itemx jump @var{location}
13692 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
13693 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
13694 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
13695 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
13696 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
13697 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
13698
13699 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
13700 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
13701 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
13702 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
13703 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
13704 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
13705 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
13706 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
13707 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
13708 @end table
13709
13710 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
13711 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
13712 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
13713 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
13714 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
13715 example,
13716
13717 @smallexample
13718 set $pc = 0x485
13719 @end smallexample
13720
13721 @noindent
13722 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
13723 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
13724 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
13725
13726 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
13727 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
13728 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
13729 detail.
13730
13731 @c @group
13732 @node Signaling
13733 @section Giving your Program a Signal
13734 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
13735
13736 @table @code
13737 @kindex signal
13738 @item signal @var{signal}
13739 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
13740 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
13741 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
13742 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
13743
13744 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
13745 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
13746 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
13747 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
13748 signal.
13749
13750 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
13751 after executing the command.
13752 @end table
13753 @c @end group
13754
13755 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
13756 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
13757 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
13758 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
13759 passes the signal directly to your program.
13760
13761
13762 @node Returning
13763 @section Returning from a Function
13764
13765 @table @code
13766 @cindex returning from a function
13767 @kindex return
13768 @item return
13769 @itemx return @var{expression}
13770 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
13771 command. If you give an
13772 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
13773 value.
13774 @end table
13775
13776 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
13777 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
13778 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
13779 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
13780
13781 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
13782 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
13783 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
13784 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
13785 of functions.
13786
13787 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
13788 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
13789 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
13790 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
13791 selected stack frame returns naturally.
13792
13793 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
13794 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
13795 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
13796 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
13797 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
13798 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
13799 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
13800 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
13801 assignment into the right register(s).
13802
13803 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
13804 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
13805 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
13806 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
13807 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
13808 into a @code{long long int}:
13809
13810 @smallexample
13811 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
13812 29 return 31;
13813 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
13814 Make func return now? (y or n) y
13815 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
13816 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
13817 (@value{GDBP})
13818 @end smallexample
13819
13820 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
13821 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
13822 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
13823 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
13824 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
13825 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
13826 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
13827 an appropriate cast explicitly:
13828
13829 @smallexample
13830 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
13831 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
13832 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
13833 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
13834 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
13835 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
13836 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
13837 (@value{GDBP})
13838 @end smallexample
13839
13840 @node Calling
13841 @section Calling Program Functions
13842
13843 @table @code
13844 @cindex calling functions
13845 @cindex inferior functions, calling
13846 @item print @var{expr}
13847 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
13848 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
13849 debugged.
13850
13851 @kindex call
13852 @item call @var{expr}
13853 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
13854 returned values.
13855
13856 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
13857 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
13858 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
13859 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
13860 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
13861 value history.
13862 @end table
13863
13864 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
13865 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
13866 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
13867 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
13868
13869 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
13870 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
13871 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
13872 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
13873 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
13874 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
13875 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
13876 in that case is controlled by the
13877 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
13878
13879 @table @code
13880 @item set unwindonsignal
13881 @kindex set unwindonsignal
13882 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
13883 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
13884 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
13885 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
13886 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
13887 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
13888 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
13889 received.
13890
13891 @item show unwindonsignal
13892 @kindex show unwindonsignal
13893 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13894 @value{GDBN}.
13895
13896 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13897 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13898 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
13899 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
13900 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
13901 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
13902 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
13903 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
13904 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
13905 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
13906
13907 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13908 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13909 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13910 @value{GDBN}.
13911
13912 @end table
13913
13914 @cindex weak alias functions
13915 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
13916 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
13917 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
13918 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
13919 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
13920 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
13921 function instead.
13922
13923 @node Patching
13924 @section Patching Programs
13925
13926 @cindex patching binaries
13927 @cindex writing into executables
13928 @cindex writing into corefiles
13929
13930 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
13931 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
13932 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
13933 patching your program's binary.
13934
13935 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
13936 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
13937 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
13938 repairs.
13939
13940 @table @code
13941 @kindex set write
13942 @item set write on
13943 @itemx set write off
13944 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
13945 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
13946 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
13947
13948 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
13949 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
13950 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
13951
13952 @item show write
13953 @kindex show write
13954 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
13955 as well as reading.
13956 @end table
13957
13958 @node GDB Files
13959 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
13960
13961 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
13962 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
13963 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
13964 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
13965
13966 @menu
13967 * Files:: Commands to specify files
13968 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
13969 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
13970 * Data Files:: GDB data files
13971 @end menu
13972
13973 @node Files
13974 @section Commands to Specify Files
13975
13976 @cindex symbol table
13977 @cindex core dump file
13978
13979 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
13980 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
13981 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
13982 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
13983
13984 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
13985 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
13986 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
13987 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
13988 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
13989 new files are useful.
13990
13991 @table @code
13992 @cindex executable file
13993 @kindex file
13994 @item file @var{filename}
13995 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
13996 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
13997 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
13998 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
13999 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
14000 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
14001 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
14002 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
14003
14004 @cindex unlinked object files
14005 @cindex patching object files
14006 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
14007 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
14008 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
14009 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
14010 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
14011 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
14012 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
14013 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
14014
14015 @item file
14016 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
14017 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
14018
14019 @kindex exec-file
14020 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14021 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
14022 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
14023 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
14024 discard information on the executable file.
14025
14026 @kindex symbol-file
14027 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14028 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
14029 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
14030 table and program to run from the same file.
14031
14032 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
14033 program's symbol table.
14034
14035 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
14036 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
14037 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
14038 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
14039 @value{GDBN}.
14040
14041 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
14042 executing it once.
14043
14044 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
14045 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
14046 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
14047 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
14048 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
14049 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
14050 optimized code.
14051
14052 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
14053 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
14054 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
14055 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
14056 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
14057
14058 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
14059 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
14060 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
14061 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
14062 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
14063 Warnings and Messages}.)
14064
14065 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
14066 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
14067 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
14068 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
14069 in stabs format.
14070
14071 @kindex readnow
14072 @cindex reading symbols immediately
14073 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
14074 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14075 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14076 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
14077 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
14078 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
14079 entire symbol table available.
14080
14081 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
14082 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
14083 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
14084 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
14085 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
14086 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
14087 @c files.
14088
14089 @kindex core-file
14090 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
14091 @itemx core
14092 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
14093 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
14094 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
14095 executable file itself for other parts.
14096
14097 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
14098 to be used.
14099
14100 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
14101 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
14102 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
14103 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
14104 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
14105
14106 @kindex add-symbol-file
14107 @cindex dynamic linking
14108 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
14109 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
14110 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
14111 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
14112 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
14113 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
14114 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
14115 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
14116 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
14117 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
14118 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
14119 @var{address} as an expression.
14120
14121 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
14122 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
14123 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
14124 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
14125 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
14126
14127 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
14128 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
14129 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
14130 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
14131 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
14132 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
14133 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
14134 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
14135 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
14136
14137 @itemize @bullet
14138 @item
14139 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
14140 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
14141 @item
14142 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
14143 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
14144 @item
14145 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
14146 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14147 @end itemize
14148
14149 @noindent
14150 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
14151 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
14152 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
14153 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
14154 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
14155 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
14156 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
14157 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
14158 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
14159 way.
14160
14161 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
14162
14163 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
14164 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
14165 @cindex load symbols from memory
14166 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
14167 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
14168 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
14169 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
14170 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
14171 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
14172 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
14173 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
14174 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
14175
14176 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
14177 @kindex assf
14178 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
14179 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
14180 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
14181 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
14182 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
14183 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
14184 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
14185 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
14186 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
14187 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
14188
14189 @kindex section
14190 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
14191 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
14192 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
14193 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
14194 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
14195 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
14196 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
14197 their addresses.
14198
14199 @kindex info files
14200 @kindex info target
14201 @item info files
14202 @itemx info target
14203 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
14204 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
14205 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
14206 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
14207 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
14208 current ones.
14209
14210 @kindex maint info sections
14211 @item maint info sections
14212 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
14213 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
14214 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
14215 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
14216 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
14217 may be arbitrarily combined):
14218
14219 @table @code
14220 @item ALLOBJ
14221 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
14222 @item @var{sections}
14223 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
14224 @item @var{section-flags}
14225 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
14226 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
14227 @table @code
14228 @item ALLOC
14229 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
14230 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
14231 @item LOAD
14232 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
14233 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
14234 @item RELOC
14235 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
14236 @item READONLY
14237 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
14238 @item CODE
14239 Section contains executable code only.
14240 @item DATA
14241 Section contains data only (no executable code).
14242 @item ROM
14243 Section will reside in ROM.
14244 @item CONSTRUCTOR
14245 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
14246 @item HAS_CONTENTS
14247 Section is not empty.
14248 @item NEVER_LOAD
14249 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
14250 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
14251 A notification to the linker that the section contains
14252 COFF shared library information.
14253 @item IS_COMMON
14254 Section contains common symbols.
14255 @end table
14256 @end table
14257 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
14258 @cindex read-only sections
14259 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
14260 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
14261 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
14262 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
14263 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
14264 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
14265 enhancement to debugging performance.
14266
14267 The default is off.
14268
14269 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
14270 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
14271 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
14272 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
14273
14274 @item show trust-readonly-sections
14275 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
14276 @end table
14277
14278 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
14279 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
14280 name and remembers it that way.
14281
14282 @cindex shared libraries
14283 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
14284 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
14285 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
14286
14287 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
14288 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
14289
14290 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
14291 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
14292 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
14293 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
14294 debugging a core file).
14295
14296 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
14297 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
14298
14299 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
14300 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
14301 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
14302
14303 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
14304 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
14305 particularly large or there are many of them.
14306
14307 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
14308 commands:
14309
14310 @table @code
14311 @kindex set auto-solib-add
14312 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
14313 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
14314 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
14315 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14316 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14317 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14318 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14319
14320 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
14321 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14322 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14323 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14324 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14325 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14326 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14327 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14328 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14329
14330 @kindex show auto-solib-add
14331 @item show auto-solib-add
14332 Display the current autoloading mode.
14333 @end table
14334
14335 @cindex load shared library
14336 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14337 command:
14338
14339 @table @code
14340 @kindex info sharedlibrary
14341 @kindex info share
14342 @item info share @var{regex}
14343 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14344 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14345 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14346 all shared libraries that are loaded.
14347
14348 @kindex sharedlibrary
14349 @kindex share
14350 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14351 @itemx share @var{regex}
14352 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14353 Unix regular expression.
14354 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14355 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14356 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14357 loaded.
14358
14359 @item nosharedlibrary
14360 @kindex nosharedlibrary
14361 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14362 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14363 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14364 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14365 discarded.
14366 @end table
14367
14368 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14369 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14370 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14371
14372 @table @code
14373 @item set stop-on-solib-events
14374 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14375 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14376 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14377 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14378 shared library.
14379
14380 @item show stop-on-solib-events
14381 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14382 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14383 library events happen.
14384 @end table
14385
14386 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14387 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14388 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14389 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14390 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14391 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14392 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14393 not.
14394
14395 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
14396 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
14397 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
14398 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
14399 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
14400
14401 @table @code
14402 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
14403 @cindex system root, alternate
14404 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
14405 @kindex set sysroot
14406 @item set sysroot @var{path}
14407 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
14408 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
14409 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
14410 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
14411 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
14412 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
14413 under @var{path}.
14414
14415 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
14416 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
14417 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
14418 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
14419 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
14420 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
14421 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
14422 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
14423 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
14424
14425 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
14426 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
14427 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
14428 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
14429 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
14430
14431 @smallexample
14432 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
14433 @end smallexample
14434
14435 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
14436 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
14437 system:
14438
14439 @smallexample
14440 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
14441 @end smallexample
14442
14443 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
14444 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
14445 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
14446 colons:
14447
14448 @smallexample
14449 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
14450 @end smallexample
14451
14452 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
14453 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
14454 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
14455 @samp{z}):
14456
14457 @smallexample
14458 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
14459 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
14460 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
14461 @end smallexample
14462
14463 @noindent
14464 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
14465 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
14466 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
14467
14468 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
14469 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
14470
14471 @smallexample
14472 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
14473 @end smallexample
14474
14475 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
14476 if you don't want or need to.
14477
14478 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
14479 sysroot}.
14480
14481 @cindex default system root
14482 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
14483 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
14484 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
14485 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14486 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
14487 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14488 location.
14489
14490 @kindex show sysroot
14491 @item show sysroot
14492 Display the current shared library prefix.
14493
14494 @kindex set solib-search-path
14495 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
14496 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
14497 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
14498 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
14499 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
14500 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
14501 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
14502 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
14503 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
14504 of shared library symbols.
14505
14506 @kindex show solib-search-path
14507 @item show solib-search-path
14508 Display the current shared library search path.
14509
14510 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
14511 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
14512 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
14513 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
14514 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
14515
14516 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
14517 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
14518 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
14519 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
14520 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
14521 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
14522 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
14523 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
14524 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
14525 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
14526 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
14527 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
14528 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
14529 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
14530 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
14531 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
14532 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
14533 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
14534 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
14535 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
14536 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
14537 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
14538
14539 @table @code
14540 @item unix
14541 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
14542 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
14543 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
14544 the forward slash.
14545
14546 @item dos-based
14547 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
14548 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
14549 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
14550 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
14551 considered directory separators.
14552
14553 @item auto
14554 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
14555 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
14556 This is the default.
14557 @end table
14558 @end table
14559
14560
14561 @node Separate Debug Files
14562 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
14563 @cindex separate debugging information files
14564 @cindex debugging information in separate files
14565 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
14566 @cindex debugging information directory, global
14567 @cindex global debugging information directory
14568 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
14569 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
14570
14571 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
14572 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
14573 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
14574 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
14575 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
14576 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
14577 install only when they need to debug a problem.
14578
14579 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
14580 file:
14581
14582 @itemize @bullet
14583 @item
14584 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
14585 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
14586 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
14587 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
14588 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
14589 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
14590 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
14591 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
14592
14593 @item
14594 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
14595 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
14596 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
14597 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
14598 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
14599 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
14600 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
14601 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
14602 below.
14603 @end itemize
14604
14605 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
14606 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
14607
14608 @itemize @bullet
14609 @item
14610 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
14611 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
14612 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
14613 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
14614 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
14615
14616 @item
14617 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
14618 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
14619 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
14620 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
14621 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
14622 hex characters, not 10.)
14623 @end itemize
14624
14625 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
14626 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
14627 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
14628 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
14629 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
14630 debug information files, in the indicated order:
14631
14632 @itemize @minus
14633 @item
14634 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
14635 @item
14636 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
14637 @item
14638 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
14639 @item
14640 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
14641 @end itemize
14642
14643 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
14644 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
14645
14646 @table @code
14647
14648 @kindex set debug-file-directory
14649 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
14650 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14651 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
14652 concatenating them by a directory separator.
14653
14654 @kindex show debug-file-directory
14655 @item show debug-file-directory
14656 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14657 information files.
14658
14659 @end table
14660
14661 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
14662 @cindex debug link sections
14663 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
14664 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
14665
14666 @itemize
14667 @item
14668 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
14669 a zero byte,
14670 @item
14671 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
14672 boundary within the section, and
14673 @item
14674 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
14675 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
14676 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
14677 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
14678 @end itemize
14679
14680 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
14681 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
14682 described above.
14683
14684 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
14685 @cindex build ID sections
14686 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
14687 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
14688 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
14689 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
14690 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
14691 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
14692 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
14693 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
14694 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
14695
14696 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
14697 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
14698 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
14699 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
14700 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
14701 in an ordinary executable.
14702
14703 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
14704 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
14705 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
14706 following commands:
14707
14708 @smallexample
14709 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
14710 @kbd{strip -g foo}
14711 @end smallexample
14712
14713 @noindent
14714 These commands remove the debugging
14715 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
14716 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
14717 two files:
14718
14719 @itemize @bullet
14720 @item
14721 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
14722 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
14723
14724 @smallexample
14725 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
14726 @end smallexample
14727
14728 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
14729 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
14730 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
14731 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
14732
14733 @item
14734 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
14735 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
14736 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
14737 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
14738 @end itemize
14739
14740 @noindent
14741
14742 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
14743 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
14744 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
14745
14746 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
14747 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
14748 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
14749 @c different ways!
14750 @ifhtml
14751 @display
14752 @html
14753 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
14754 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
14755 @end html
14756 @end display
14757 @end ifhtml
14758 @ifnothtml
14759 @display
14760 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
14761 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
14762 @end display
14763 @end ifnothtml
14764
14765 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
14766 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
14767 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
14768 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
14769 CRC.
14770
14771 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
14772 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
14773 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
14774 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
14775 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
14776 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
14777
14778 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
14779 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
14780 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
14781 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
14782 @code{0xffffffff}.
14783
14784 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
14785 @smallexample
14786 unsigned long
14787 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
14788 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
14789 @{
14790 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
14791 @{
14792 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
14793 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
14794 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
14795 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
14796 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
14797 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
14798 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
14799 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
14800 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
14801 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
14802 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
14803 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
14804 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
14805 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
14806 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
14807 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
14808 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
14809 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
14810 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
14811 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
14812 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
14813 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
14814 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
14815 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
14816 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
14817 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
14818 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
14819 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
14820 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
14821 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
14822 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
14823 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
14824 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
14825 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
14826 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
14827 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
14828 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
14829 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
14830 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
14831 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
14832 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
14833 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
14834 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
14835 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
14836 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
14837 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
14838 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
14839 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
14840 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
14841 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
14842 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
14843 0x2d02ef8d
14844 @};
14845 unsigned char *end;
14846
14847 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14848 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
14849 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
14850 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14851 @}
14852 @end smallexample
14853
14854 @noindent
14855 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
14856
14857
14858 @node Symbol Errors
14859 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
14860
14861 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
14862 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
14863 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
14864 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
14865 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
14866 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
14867 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
14868 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
14869 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
14870 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14871 Messages}).
14872
14873 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
14874
14875 @table @code
14876 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
14877
14878 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
14879 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
14880 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
14881 in its outer scope blocks.
14882
14883 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
14884 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
14885 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
14886 function.
14887
14888 @item block at @var{address} out of order
14889
14890 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
14891 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
14892 do so.
14893
14894 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
14895 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
14896 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
14897 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14898 Messages}.)
14899
14900 @item bad block start address patched
14901
14902 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
14903 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
14904 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
14905
14906 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
14907 starting on the previous source line.
14908
14909 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
14910
14911 @cindex foo
14912 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
14913 larger than the size of the string table.
14914
14915 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
14916 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
14917 with this name.
14918
14919 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
14920
14921 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
14922 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
14923 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
14924
14925 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
14926 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
14927 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
14928 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
14929 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
14930 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
14931
14932 @item stub type has NULL name
14933
14934 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
14935
14936 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
14937 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
14938 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
14939 it.
14940
14941 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
14942
14943 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
14944
14945 @end table
14946
14947 @node Data Files
14948 @section GDB Data Files
14949
14950 @cindex prefix for data files
14951 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
14952 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
14953
14954 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
14955 is currently using.
14956
14957 @table @code
14958 @kindex set data-directory
14959 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
14960 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
14961 to @var{directory}.
14962
14963 @kindex show data-directory
14964 @item show data-directory
14965 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
14966 @end table
14967
14968 @cindex default data directory
14969 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
14970 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
14971 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
14972 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14973 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
14974 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14975 location.
14976
14977 @node Targets
14978 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
14979
14980 @cindex debugging target
14981 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
14982
14983 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
14984 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
14985 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
14986 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
14987 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
14988 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
14989 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
14990 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
14991
14992 @cindex target architecture
14993 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
14994 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
14995 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
14996 command.
14997
14998 @table @code
14999 @kindex set architecture
15000 @kindex show architecture
15001 @item set architecture @var{arch}
15002 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
15003 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
15004 supported architectures.
15005
15006 @item show architecture
15007 Show the current target architecture.
15008
15009 @item set processor
15010 @itemx processor
15011 @kindex set processor
15012 @kindex show processor
15013 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
15014 and @code{show architecture}.
15015 @end table
15016
15017 @menu
15018 * Active Targets:: Active targets
15019 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
15020 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
15021 @end menu
15022
15023 @node Active Targets
15024 @section Active Targets
15025
15026 @cindex stacking targets
15027 @cindex active targets
15028 @cindex multiple targets
15029
15030 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
15031 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
15032 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
15033 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
15034 a core file.
15035
15036 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
15037 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
15038 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
15039 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
15040 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
15041 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
15042 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
15043 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
15044 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
15045
15046 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
15047 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
15048 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
15049 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
15050 process target is active.
15051
15052 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
15053 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
15054 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
15055 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
15056 Process}).
15057
15058 @node Target Commands
15059 @section Commands for Managing Targets
15060
15061 @table @code
15062 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
15063 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
15064 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
15065 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
15066 protocol of the target machine.
15067
15068 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
15069 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
15070 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
15071
15072 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
15073 after executing the command.
15074
15075 @kindex help target
15076 @item help target
15077 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
15078 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
15079 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15080
15081 @item help target @var{name}
15082 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
15083 select it.
15084
15085 @kindex set gnutarget
15086 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
15087 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
15088 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
15089 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
15090 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
15091 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
15092
15093 @quotation
15094 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
15095 you must know the actual BFD name.
15096 @end quotation
15097
15098 @noindent
15099 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
15100
15101 @kindex show gnutarget
15102 @item show gnutarget
15103 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
15104 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
15105 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
15106 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
15107 @end table
15108
15109 @cindex common targets
15110 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
15111 configuration):
15112
15113 @table @code
15114 @kindex target
15115 @item target exec @var{program}
15116 @cindex executable file target
15117 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
15118 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
15119
15120 @item target core @var{filename}
15121 @cindex core dump file target
15122 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
15123 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
15124
15125 @item target remote @var{medium}
15126 @cindex remote target
15127 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
15128 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
15129 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
15130
15131 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
15132 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 target remote /dev/ttya
15136 @end smallexample
15137
15138 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
15139 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
15140 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
15141 clobbered by the download.
15142
15143 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
15144 @cindex built-in simulator target
15145 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
15146 In general,
15147 @smallexample
15148 target sim
15149 load
15150 run
15151 @end smallexample
15152 @noindent
15153 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
15154 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
15155 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
15156 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
15157 Processors}.
15158
15159 @end table
15160
15161 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
15162
15163 @table @code
15164
15165 @item target nrom @var{dev}
15166 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
15167 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
15168
15169 @end table
15170
15171 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
15172 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
15173
15174 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
15175 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
15176 various aspects of this process.
15177
15178 @table @code
15179
15180 @item set hash
15181 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15182 @cindex hash mark while downloading
15183 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
15184 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
15185 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
15186 monitor.
15187
15188 @item show hash
15189 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15190 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
15191
15192 @item set debug monitor
15193 @kindex set debug monitor
15194 @cindex display remote monitor communications
15195 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
15196 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15197
15198 @item show debug monitor
15199 @kindex show debug monitor
15200 Show the current status of displaying communications between
15201 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15202 @end table
15203
15204 @table @code
15205
15206 @kindex load @var{filename}
15207 @item load @var{filename}
15208 @anchor{load}
15209 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
15210 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
15211 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
15212 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
15213 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
15214 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15215
15216 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
15217 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
15218 target is @dots{}}''
15219
15220 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
15221 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
15222 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
15223 specifies a fixed address.
15224 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
15225
15226 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
15227 load programs into flash memory.
15228
15229 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
15230 @end table
15231
15232 @node Byte Order
15233 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
15234
15235 @cindex choosing target byte order
15236 @cindex target byte order
15237
15238 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
15239 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
15240 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
15241 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
15242 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
15243 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
15244
15245 @table @code
15246 @kindex set endian
15247 @item set endian big
15248 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
15249
15250 @item set endian little
15251 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
15252
15253 @item set endian auto
15254 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
15255 executable.
15256
15257 @item show endian
15258 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
15259
15260 @end table
15261
15262 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
15263 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
15264 target system.
15265
15266
15267 @node Remote Debugging
15268 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
15269 @cindex remote debugging
15270
15271 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
15272 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
15273 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
15274 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
15275 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
15276
15277 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
15278 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
15279 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
15280 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
15281 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
15282 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
15283
15284 Other remote targets may be available in your
15285 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
15286
15287 @menu
15288 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
15289 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
15290 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
15291 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
15292 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
15293 @end menu
15294
15295 @node Connecting
15296 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
15297
15298 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
15299 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
15300 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
15301 program as the first argument.
15302
15303 @cindex @code{target remote}
15304 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
15305 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
15306 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
15307 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
15308 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
15309 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
15310
15311 @table @code
15312
15313 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
15314 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
15315 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
15316 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
15317
15318 @smallexample
15319 target remote /dev/ttyb
15320 @end smallexample
15321
15322 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
15323 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
15324 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
15325 @code{target} command.
15326
15327 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
15328 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15329 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
15330 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
15331 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
15332 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
15333 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
15334 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
15335 target.
15336
15337 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
15338 @code{manyfarms}:
15339
15340 @smallexample
15341 target remote manyfarms:2828
15342 @end smallexample
15343
15344 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
15345 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
15346 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
15347 port 1234 on your local machine:
15348
15349 @smallexample
15350 target remote :1234
15351 @end smallexample
15352 @noindent
15353
15354 Note that the colon is still required here.
15355
15356 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15357 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
15358 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
15359 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
15360
15361 @smallexample
15362 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
15363 @end smallexample
15364
15365 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
15366 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
15367 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
15368 cause havoc with your debugging session.
15369
15370 @item target remote | @var{command}
15371 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
15372 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
15373 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
15374 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
15375 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
15376 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
15377 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
15378 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
15379
15380 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
15381 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
15382 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
15383
15384 @end table
15385
15386 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
15387 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
15388 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
15389 need to use @kbd{run}.
15390
15391 @cindex interrupting remote programs
15392 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
15393 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
15394 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
15395 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
15396 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
15397 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
15398
15399 @smallexample
15400 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
15401 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
15402 @end smallexample
15403
15404 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
15405 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
15406 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
15407 goes back to waiting.
15408
15409 @table @code
15410 @kindex detach (remote)
15411 @item detach
15412 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
15413 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
15414 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
15415 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
15416 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
15417
15418 @kindex disconnect
15419 @item disconnect
15420 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
15421 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
15422 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
15423 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
15424 another target.
15425
15426 @cindex send command to remote monitor
15427 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
15428 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
15429 @kindex monitor
15430 @item monitor @var{cmd}
15431 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
15432 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
15433 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
15434 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
15435 and implement.
15436 @end table
15437
15438 @node File Transfer
15439 @section Sending files to a remote system
15440 @cindex remote target, file transfer
15441 @cindex file transfer
15442 @cindex sending files to remote systems
15443
15444 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
15445 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
15446 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
15447 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
15448 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
15449 the only way to upload or download files.
15450
15451 Not all remote targets support these commands.
15452
15453 @table @code
15454 @kindex remote put
15455 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
15456 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
15457 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
15458
15459 @kindex remote get
15460 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
15461 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
15462 on the host system.
15463
15464 @kindex remote delete
15465 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
15466 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
15467
15468 @end table
15469
15470 @node Server
15471 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
15472
15473 @kindex gdbserver
15474 @cindex remote connection without stubs
15475 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
15476 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
15477 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
15478
15479 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
15480 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
15481 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
15482 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
15483 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
15484 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
15485 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
15486 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
15487 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
15488 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
15489 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
15490 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
15491 choice for debugging.
15492
15493 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
15494 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
15495 protocol.
15496
15497 @quotation
15498 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
15499 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
15500 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
15501 target system with the same privileges as the user running
15502 @code{gdbserver}.
15503 @end quotation
15504
15505 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
15506 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
15507
15508 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
15509 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
15510 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
15511 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
15512 system does all the symbol handling.
15513
15514 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
15515 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
15516 syntax is:
15517
15518 @smallexample
15519 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
15520 @end smallexample
15521
15522 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
15523 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
15524 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
15525 @file{/dev/com1}:
15526
15527 @smallexample
15528 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
15529 @end smallexample
15530
15531 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
15532 with it.
15533
15534 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
15535
15536 @smallexample
15537 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
15538 @end smallexample
15539
15540 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
15541 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
15542 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
15543 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
15544 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
15545 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
15546 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
15547 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
15548 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
15549 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
15550 @code{target remote} command.
15551
15552 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
15553
15554 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
15555 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
15556
15557 @smallexample
15558 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
15559 @end smallexample
15560
15561 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
15562 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
15563
15564 @pindex pidof
15565 @cindex attach to a program by name
15566 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
15567 @code{pidof} utility:
15568
15569 @smallexample
15570 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
15571 @end smallexample
15572
15573 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
15574 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
15575 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
15576
15577 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
15578 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
15579 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
15580
15581 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
15582 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
15583 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
15584 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
15585
15586 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
15587 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
15588 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
15589 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
15590 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
15591 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
15592 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
15593 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
15594 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
15595
15596 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
15597 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
15598 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
15599 the program you want to debug.
15600
15601 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
15602 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
15603 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
15604
15605 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
15606
15607 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
15608 status information about the debugging process. The
15609 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
15610 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
15611 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
15612
15613 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
15614 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
15615 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
15616 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
15617
15618 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
15619 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
15620 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
15621 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
15622
15623 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
15624 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
15625 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
15626 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
15627
15628 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
15629 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
15630 environment:
15631
15632 @smallexample
15633 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
15634 @end smallexample
15635
15636 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
15637
15638 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
15639
15640 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
15641 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
15642 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
15643 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
15644
15645 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
15646 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
15647 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
15648 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
15649 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
15650 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
15651 programs.
15652
15653 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15654 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
15655 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
15656 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
15657 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
15658 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
15659 already on the target.
15660
15661 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
15662 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
15663 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
15664
15665 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
15666 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
15667 Here are the available commands.
15668
15669 @table @code
15670 @item monitor help
15671 List the available monitor commands.
15672
15673 @item monitor set debug 0
15674 @itemx monitor set debug 1
15675 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
15676
15677 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
15678 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
15679 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
15680 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
15681
15682 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
15683 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
15684 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15685 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
15686 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
15687 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
15688
15689 @item monitor exit
15690 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
15691 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
15692 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
15693 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
15694 of a multi-process mode debug session.
15695
15696 @end table
15697
15698 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
15699 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
15700
15701 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints and fast
15702 tracepoints.
15703
15704 For fast tracepoints to work, a special library called the
15705 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
15706 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
15707 @code{gdbserver}.
15708
15709 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
15710
15711 @table @code
15712 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
15713
15714 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
15715 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
15716 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
15717
15718 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
15719
15720 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
15721 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
15722 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
15723 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
15724 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
15725 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
15726
15727 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
15728
15729 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
15730 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
15731 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
15732 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
15733 command for that. For example:
15734
15735 @smallexample
15736 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
15737 @end smallexample
15738
15739 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
15740 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
15741 @end table
15742
15743 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
15744 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
15745 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
15746 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
15747 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
15748 case, before being able to use any of the fast tracepoints features,
15749 you need to let the loader run and load the shared libraries. The
15750 most simple way to do that is to run the program to the main
15751 procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
15752 @code{gdbserver} like so:
15753
15754 @smallexample
15755 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
15756 @end smallexample
15757
15758 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
15759
15760 @smallexample
15761 $ gdb myprogram
15762 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
15763 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
15764 (@value{GDBP}) b main
15765 (@value{GDBP}) continue
15766 @end smallexample
15767
15768 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
15769 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
15770 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
15771 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints and start
15772 tracing.
15773
15774 @node Remote Configuration
15775 @section Remote Configuration
15776
15777 @kindex set remote
15778 @kindex show remote
15779 This section documents the configuration options available when
15780 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
15781 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
15782 system-call-allowed}.
15783
15784 @table @code
15785 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
15786 @cindex address size for remote targets
15787 @cindex bits in remote address
15788 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
15789 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
15790 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
15791 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
15792
15793 @item show remoteaddresssize
15794 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
15795
15796 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
15797 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
15798 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
15799 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
15800 remote targets.
15801
15802 @item show remotebaud
15803 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
15804
15805 @item set remotebreak
15806 @cindex interrupt remote programs
15807 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
15808 @anchor{set remotebreak}
15809 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
15810 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
15811 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
15812 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
15813 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
15814
15815 @item show remotebreak
15816 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
15817 interrupt the remote program.
15818
15819 @item set remoteflow on
15820 @itemx set remoteflow off
15821 @kindex set remoteflow
15822 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
15823 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
15824
15825 @item show remoteflow
15826 @kindex show remoteflow
15827 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
15828
15829 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
15830 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
15831 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
15832 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
15833 @code{ascii}.
15834
15835 @item show remotelogbase
15836 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
15837 protocol.
15838
15839 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
15840 @cindex record serial communications on file
15841 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
15842 default is not to record at all.
15843
15844 @item show remotelogfile.
15845 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
15846 serial communications.
15847
15848 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
15849 @cindex timeout for serial communications
15850 @cindex remote timeout
15851 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
15852 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
15853
15854 @item show remotetimeout
15855 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
15856 responses.
15857
15858 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
15859 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
15860 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
15861 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
15862 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
15863 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
15864 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
15865 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
15866
15867 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
15868 @itemx show remote exec-file
15869 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
15870 @cindex executable file, for remote target
15871 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
15872 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
15873 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
15874 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
15875
15876 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
15877 @cindex interrupt remote programs
15878 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
15879 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
15880 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
15881 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
15882 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
15883 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
15884 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
15885 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
15886
15887 @item show interrupt-sequence
15888 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
15889 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
15890 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
15891 also known as Magic SysRq g.
15892
15893 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
15894 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
15895 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
15896 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
15897 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
15898 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
15899
15900 @item show interrupt-on-connect
15901 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
15902 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
15903
15904 @kindex set tcp
15905 @kindex show tcp
15906 @item set tcp auto-retry on
15907 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
15908 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
15909 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
15910 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
15911 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
15912 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
15913 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
15914 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
15915
15916 @item set tcp auto-retry off
15917 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
15918
15919 @item show tcp auto-retry
15920 Show the current auto-retry setting.
15921
15922 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
15923 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
15924 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
15925 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
15926 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
15927 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
15928 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
15929 value.
15930
15931 @item show tcp connect-timeout
15932 Show the current connection timeout setting.
15933 @end table
15934
15935 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
15936 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
15937 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
15938 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
15939 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
15940 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
15941 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
15942 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
15943 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
15944
15945 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
15946 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
15947 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
15948 @value{GDBN} developers.
15949
15950 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
15951 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
15952 are:
15953
15954 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
15955 @item Command Name
15956 @tab Remote Packet
15957 @tab Related Features
15958
15959 @item @code{fetch-register}
15960 @tab @code{p}
15961 @tab @code{info registers}
15962
15963 @item @code{set-register}
15964 @tab @code{P}
15965 @tab @code{set}
15966
15967 @item @code{binary-download}
15968 @tab @code{X}
15969 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
15970
15971 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
15972 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
15973 @tab @code{info auxv}
15974
15975 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
15976 @tab @code{qSymbol}
15977 @tab Detecting multiple threads
15978
15979 @item @code{attach}
15980 @tab @code{vAttach}
15981 @tab @code{attach}
15982
15983 @item @code{verbose-resume}
15984 @tab @code{vCont}
15985 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
15986
15987 @item @code{run}
15988 @tab @code{vRun}
15989 @tab @code{run}
15990
15991 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
15992 @tab @code{Z0}
15993 @tab @code{break}
15994
15995 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
15996 @tab @code{Z1}
15997 @tab @code{hbreak}
15998
15999 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
16000 @tab @code{Z2}
16001 @tab @code{watch}
16002
16003 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
16004 @tab @code{Z3}
16005 @tab @code{rwatch}
16006
16007 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
16008 @tab @code{Z4}
16009 @tab @code{awatch}
16010
16011 @item @code{target-features}
16012 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
16013 @tab @code{set architecture}
16014
16015 @item @code{library-info}
16016 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
16017 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
16018
16019 @item @code{memory-map}
16020 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
16021 @tab @code{info mem}
16022
16023 @item @code{read-spu-object}
16024 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
16025 @tab @code{info spu}
16026
16027 @item @code{write-spu-object}
16028 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
16029 @tab @code{info spu}
16030
16031 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
16032 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
16033 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
16034
16035 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
16036 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
16037 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
16038
16039 @item @code{threads}
16040 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
16041 @tab @code{info threads}
16042
16043 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
16044 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
16045 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
16046
16047 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
16048 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
16049 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
16050
16051 @item @code{search-memory}
16052 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
16053 @tab @code{find}
16054
16055 @item @code{supported-packets}
16056 @tab @code{qSupported}
16057 @tab Remote communications parameters
16058
16059 @item @code{pass-signals}
16060 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
16061 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
16062
16063 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
16064 @tab @code{vFile:close}
16065 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16066
16067 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
16068 @tab @code{vFile:open}
16069 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16070
16071 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
16072 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
16073 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16074
16075 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
16076 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
16077 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16078
16079 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
16080 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
16081 @tab @code{remote delete}
16082
16083 @item @code{noack-packet}
16084 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
16085 @tab Packet acknowledgment
16086
16087 @item @code{osdata}
16088 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
16089 @tab @code{info os}
16090
16091 @item @code{query-attached}
16092 @tab @code{qAttached}
16093 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
16094 @end multitable
16095
16096 @node Remote Stub
16097 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
16098
16099 @cindex debugging stub, example
16100 @cindex remote stub, example
16101 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
16102 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
16103 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
16104 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
16105 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
16106 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
16107 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
16108 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
16109
16110 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
16111 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
16112 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
16113 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
16114 program, you need:
16115
16116 @enumerate
16117 @item
16118 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
16119 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
16120 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
16121
16122 @item
16123 A C subroutine library to support your program's
16124 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
16125
16126 @item
16127 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
16128 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
16129 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
16130 documentation.
16131 @end enumerate
16132
16133 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
16134 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
16135 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
16136
16137 @table @emph
16138 @item On the host,
16139 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
16140 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
16141 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16142
16143 @item On the target,
16144 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
16145 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
16146 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
16147
16148 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
16149 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
16150 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
16151 @end table
16152
16153 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
16154 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
16155 @sc{sparc} boards.
16156
16157 @cindex remote serial stub list
16158 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
16159
16160 @table @code
16161
16162 @item i386-stub.c
16163 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
16164 @cindex Intel
16165 @cindex i386
16166 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
16167
16168 @item m68k-stub.c
16169 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
16170 @cindex Motorola 680x0
16171 @cindex m680x0
16172 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
16173
16174 @item sh-stub.c
16175 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
16176 @cindex Renesas
16177 @cindex SH
16178 For Renesas SH architectures.
16179
16180 @item sparc-stub.c
16181 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
16182 @cindex Sparc
16183 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
16184
16185 @item sparcl-stub.c
16186 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
16187 @cindex Fujitsu
16188 @cindex SparcLite
16189 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
16190
16191 @end table
16192
16193 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
16194 recently added stubs.
16195
16196 @menu
16197 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
16198 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
16199 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
16200 @end menu
16201
16202 @node Stub Contents
16203 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
16204
16205 @cindex remote serial stub
16206 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
16207 subroutines:
16208
16209 @table @code
16210 @item set_debug_traps
16211 @findex set_debug_traps
16212 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
16213 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
16214 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
16215 beginning of your program.
16216
16217 @item handle_exception
16218 @findex handle_exception
16219 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
16220 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
16221 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
16222 run when a trap is triggered.
16223
16224 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
16225 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
16226 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
16227 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
16228 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
16229 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
16230 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
16231 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
16232 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
16233 machine.
16234
16235 @item breakpoint
16236 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
16237 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
16238 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
16239 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
16240 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
16241 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
16242 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
16243 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
16244 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
16245 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
16246 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
16247
16248 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
16249 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
16250 start of your debugging session.
16251 @end table
16252
16253 @node Bootstrapping
16254 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
16255
16256 @cindex remote stub, support routines
16257 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
16258 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
16259 debugging target machine.
16260
16261 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
16262 serial port.
16263
16264 @table @code
16265 @item int getDebugChar()
16266 @findex getDebugChar
16267 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
16268 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
16269 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16270
16271 @item void putDebugChar(int)
16272 @findex putDebugChar
16273 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
16274 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
16275 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16276 @end table
16277
16278 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
16279 @cindex interrupting remote targets
16280 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
16281 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
16282 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
16283 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
16284 remote system to stop.
16285
16286 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
16287 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
16288 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
16289 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
16290
16291 Other routines you need to supply are:
16292
16293 @table @code
16294 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
16295 @findex exceptionHandler
16296 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
16297 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
16298 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
16299 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
16300 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
16301 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
16302 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
16303 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
16304 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
16305 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
16306 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
16307 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
16308 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
16309
16310 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
16311 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
16312 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
16313 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
16314 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
16315
16316 @item void flush_i_cache()
16317 @findex flush_i_cache
16318 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
16319 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
16320 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
16321
16322 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
16323 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
16324 @end table
16325
16326 @noindent
16327 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
16328
16329 @table @code
16330 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
16331 @findex memset
16332 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
16333 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
16334 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
16335 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
16336 @end table
16337
16338 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
16339 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
16340 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
16341 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
16342
16343
16344 @node Debug Session
16345 @subsection Putting it All Together
16346
16347 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
16348 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
16349 steps.
16350
16351 @enumerate
16352 @item
16353 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
16354 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
16355 @display
16356 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
16357 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
16358 @end display
16359
16360 @item
16361 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
16362
16363 @smallexample
16364 set_debug_traps();
16365 breakpoint();
16366 @end smallexample
16367
16368 @item
16369 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
16370 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
16371
16372 @smallexample
16373 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
16374 @end smallexample
16375
16376 @noindent
16377 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
16378 function in your program, that function is called when
16379 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
16380 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
16381 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
16382
16383 @item
16384 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
16385 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
16386
16387 @item
16388 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
16389 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
16390
16391 @item
16392 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
16393 @c document that. FIXME.
16394 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
16395 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
16396
16397 @item
16398 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
16399 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16400
16401 @end enumerate
16402
16403 @node Configurations
16404 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
16405
16406 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
16407 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
16408 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
16409
16410 There are three major categories of configurations: native
16411 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
16412 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
16413 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
16414 are quite different from each other.
16415
16416 @menu
16417 * Native::
16418 * Embedded OS::
16419 * Embedded Processors::
16420 * Architectures::
16421 @end menu
16422
16423 @node Native
16424 @section Native
16425
16426 This section describes details specific to particular native
16427 configurations.
16428
16429 @menu
16430 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
16431 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
16432 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
16433 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
16434 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
16435 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
16436 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
16437 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
16438 @end menu
16439
16440 @node HP-UX
16441 @subsection HP-UX
16442
16443 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
16444 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
16445 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
16446
16447
16448 @node BSD libkvm Interface
16449 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
16450
16451 @cindex libkvm
16452 @cindex kernel memory image
16453 @cindex kernel crash dump
16454
16455 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
16456 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
16457 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
16458 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
16459 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
16460 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
16461 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
16462 @code{kvm} target:
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
16466 @end smallexample
16467
16468 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
16469 argument:
16470
16471 @smallexample
16472 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
16473 @end smallexample
16474
16475 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
16476 available:
16477
16478 @table @code
16479 @kindex kvm
16480 @item kvm pcb
16481 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
16482
16483 @item kvm proc
16484 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
16485 modern FreeBSD systems.
16486 @end table
16487
16488 @node SVR4 Process Information
16489 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
16490 @cindex /proc
16491 @cindex examine process image
16492 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
16493
16494 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
16495 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
16496 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
16497 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
16498 proc} is available to report information about the process running
16499 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
16500 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
16501 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
16502 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
16503
16504 @table @code
16505 @kindex info proc
16506 @cindex process ID
16507 @item info proc
16508 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
16509 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
16510 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
16511 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
16512 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
16513 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
16514 executable file's absolute file name.
16515
16516 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
16517 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
16518 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
16519 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
16520 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
16521 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
16522
16523 @item info proc mappings
16524 @cindex memory address space mappings
16525 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
16526 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
16527 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
16528 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
16529 memory access rights to that range.
16530
16531 @item info proc stat
16532 @itemx info proc status
16533 @cindex process detailed status information
16534 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
16535 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
16536 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
16537 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
16538 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
16539 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
16540 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
16541
16542 @item info proc all
16543 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
16544 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
16545
16546 @ignore
16547 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
16548 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
16549 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
16550 @kindex info proc times
16551 @item info proc times
16552 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
16553 its children.
16554
16555 @kindex info proc id
16556 @item info proc id
16557 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
16558 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
16559 @end ignore
16560
16561 @item set procfs-trace
16562 @kindex set procfs-trace
16563 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
16564 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
16565
16566 @item show procfs-trace
16567 @kindex show procfs-trace
16568 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
16569
16570 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
16571 @kindex set procfs-file
16572 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
16573 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
16574 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
16575 standard output.
16576
16577 @item show procfs-file
16578 @kindex show procfs-file
16579 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
16580
16581 @item proc-trace-entry
16582 @itemx proc-trace-exit
16583 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
16584 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
16585 @kindex proc-trace-entry
16586 @kindex proc-trace-exit
16587 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
16588 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
16589 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
16590 from the @code{syscall} interface.
16591
16592 @item info pidlist
16593 @kindex info pidlist
16594 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
16595 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
16596 processes and all the threads within each process.
16597
16598 @item info meminfo
16599 @kindex info meminfo
16600 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
16601 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
16602 @end table
16603
16604 @node DJGPP Native
16605 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
16606 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
16607 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
16608 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
16609
16610 @cindex DPMI
16611 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
16612 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
16613 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
16614 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
16615
16616 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
16617 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
16618 subsection describes those commands.
16619
16620 @table @code
16621 @kindex info dos
16622 @item info dos
16623 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
16624 information about the target system and important OS structures.
16625
16626 @kindex sysinfo
16627 @cindex MS-DOS system info
16628 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
16629 @item info dos sysinfo
16630 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
16631 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
16632 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
16633
16634 @cindex GDT
16635 @cindex LDT
16636 @cindex IDT
16637 @cindex segment descriptor tables
16638 @cindex descriptor tables display
16639 @item info dos gdt
16640 @itemx info dos ldt
16641 @itemx info dos idt
16642 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
16643 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
16644 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
16645 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
16646 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
16647 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
16648 rights.
16649
16650 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
16651 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
16652 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
16653 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
16654 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
16655
16656 @cindex garbled pointers
16657 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
16658 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
16659 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
16660 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
16661 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
16662 debugged program's data segment:
16663
16664 @smallexample
16665 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
16666 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
16667 @end smallexample
16668
16669 @noindent
16670 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
16671 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
16672
16673 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
16674 @item info dos pde
16675 @itemx info dos pte
16676 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
16677 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
16678 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
16679 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
16680 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
16681 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
16682 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
16683 that is currently in use.
16684
16685 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
16686 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
16687 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
16688 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
16689 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
16690 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
16691 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
16692
16693 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
16694 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
16695 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
16696 controller.
16697
16698 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
16699
16700 @cindex physical address from linear address
16701 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
16702 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
16703 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
16704 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
16705 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
16706 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
16707 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
16708
16709 @smallexample
16710 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
16711 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
16712 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
16713 @end smallexample
16714
16715 @noindent
16716 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
16717 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
16718 attributes of that page.
16719
16720 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
16721 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
16722 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
16723 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
16724 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
16725 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
16726
16727 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
16728 transfer buffer:
16729
16730 @smallexample
16731 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
16732 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
16733 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
16734 @end smallexample
16735
16736 @noindent
16737 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
16738 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
16739 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
16740 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
16741 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
16742
16743 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
16744 @end table
16745
16746 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
16747 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
16748 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
16749 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
16750
16751 @table @code
16752 @kindex set com1base
16753 @kindex set com1irq
16754 @kindex set com2base
16755 @kindex set com2irq
16756 @kindex set com3base
16757 @kindex set com3irq
16758 @kindex set com4base
16759 @kindex set com4irq
16760 @item set com1base @var{addr}
16761 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
16762 port.
16763
16764 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
16765 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
16766 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
16767
16768 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
16769 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
16770 other 3 COM ports.
16771
16772 @kindex show com1base
16773 @kindex show com1irq
16774 @kindex show com2base
16775 @kindex show com2irq
16776 @kindex show com3base
16777 @kindex show com3irq
16778 @kindex show com4base
16779 @kindex show com4irq
16780 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
16781 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
16782 lines used by the COM ports.
16783
16784 @item info serial
16785 @kindex info serial
16786 @cindex DOS serial port status
16787 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
16788 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
16789 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
16790 counts of various errors encountered so far.
16791 @end table
16792
16793
16794 @node Cygwin Native
16795 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
16796 @cindex MS Windows debugging
16797 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
16798 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
16799
16800 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
16801 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
16802
16803 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
16804 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
16805 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
16806 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
16807 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
16808 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
16809 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
16810 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
16811
16812 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
16813 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
16814 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
16815
16816 @table @code
16817 @kindex info w32
16818 @item info w32
16819 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
16820 information about the target system and important OS structures.
16821
16822 @item info w32 selector
16823 This command displays information returned by
16824 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
16825 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
16826 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
16827 Without argument, this command displays information
16828 about the six segment registers.
16829
16830 @item info w32 thread-information-block
16831 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
16832 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
16833 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
16834
16835 @kindex info dll
16836 @item info dll
16837 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
16838
16839 @kindex dll-symbols
16840 @item dll-symbols
16841 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
16842 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
16843
16844 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
16845 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
16846 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
16847 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
16848 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
16849 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
16850 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
16851 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
16852 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
16853 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
16854 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
16855
16856 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
16857 @item show cygwin-exceptions
16858 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
16859 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
16860
16861 @kindex set new-console
16862 @item set new-console @var{mode}
16863 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
16864 be started in a new console on next start.
16865 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
16866 be started in the same console as the debugger.
16867
16868 @kindex show new-console
16869 @item show new-console
16870 Displays whether a new console is used
16871 when the debuggee is started.
16872
16873 @kindex set new-group
16874 @item set new-group @var{mode}
16875 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
16876 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
16877 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
16878 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
16879
16880 @kindex show new-group
16881 @item show new-group
16882 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
16883
16884 @kindex set debugevents
16885 @item set debugevents
16886 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
16887 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
16888 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
16889 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
16890 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
16891
16892 @kindex set debugexec
16893 @item set debugexec
16894 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
16895 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
16896
16897 @kindex set debugexceptions
16898 @item set debugexceptions
16899 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
16900 debuggee seen by the debugger.
16901
16902 @kindex set debugmemory
16903 @item set debugmemory
16904 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
16905 and writes by the debugger.
16906
16907 @kindex set shell
16908 @item set shell
16909 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
16910 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
16911
16912 @kindex show shell
16913 @item show shell
16914 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
16915
16916 @end table
16917
16918 @menu
16919 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
16920 @end menu
16921
16922 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
16923 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
16924 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
16925 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
16926
16927 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
16928 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
16929 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
16930 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
16931 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
16932 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
16933 ``minimal symbols''.
16934
16935 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
16936 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
16937 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
16938 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
16939 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
16940 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
16941 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
16942 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
16943 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
16944 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
16945
16946 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
16947
16948 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
16949 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
16950 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
16951 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
16952 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
16953 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
16954 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
16955 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
16956 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
16957
16958 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
16959 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
16960 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
16961 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
16962 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
16963 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
16964
16965 @smallexample
16966 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
16967 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
16968
16969 Non-debugging symbols:
16970 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
16971 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
16972 @end smallexample
16973
16974 @smallexample
16975 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
16976 All functions matching regular expression "!":
16977
16978 Non-debugging symbols:
16979 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
16980 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
16981 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
16982 [etc...]
16983 @end smallexample
16984
16985 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
16986
16987 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
16988 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
16989 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
16990 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
16991 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
16992 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
16993 a function within a DLL without a running program.
16994
16995 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
16996 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
16997 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
16998 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
16999 problem:
17000
17001 @smallexample
17002 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
17003 $1 = 268572168
17004 @end smallexample
17005
17006 @smallexample
17007 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
17008 0x10021610: "\230y\""
17009 @end smallexample
17010
17011 And two possible solutions:
17012
17013 @smallexample
17014 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
17015 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17016 @end smallexample
17017
17018 @smallexample
17019 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
17020 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
17021 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
17022 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
17023 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
17024 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17025 @end smallexample
17026
17027 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
17028 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
17029 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
17030 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
17031 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
17032
17033 @smallexample
17034 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
17035 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
17036 @end smallexample
17037
17038 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
17039 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
17040 safe.
17041
17042 @node Hurd Native
17043 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
17044 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
17045
17046 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
17047 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
17048
17049 @table @code
17050 @item set signals
17051 @itemx set sigs
17052 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
17053 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17054 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
17055 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
17056 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
17057 @code{signals}.
17058
17059 @item show signals
17060 @itemx show sigs
17061 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
17062 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17063 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
17064
17065 @item set signal-thread
17066 @itemx set sigthread
17067 @kindex set signal-thread
17068 @kindex set sigthread
17069 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
17070 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
17071 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
17072 signal-thread}.
17073
17074 @item show signal-thread
17075 @itemx show sigthread
17076 @kindex show signal-thread
17077 @kindex show sigthread
17078 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
17079 delivered a signal.
17080
17081 @item set stopped
17082 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17083 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
17084 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
17085 continued by delivering a signal to it.
17086
17087 @item show stopped
17088 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17089 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
17090 stopped.
17091
17092 @item set exceptions
17093 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17094 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
17095 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
17096 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
17097 trapping on.
17098
17099 @item show exceptions
17100 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17101 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
17102
17103 @item set task pause
17104 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
17105 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17106 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17107 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
17108 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
17109 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
17110 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
17111 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
17112 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
17113
17114 @item show task pause
17115 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
17116 Show the current state of task suspension.
17117
17118 @item set task detach-suspend-count
17119 @cindex task suspend count
17120 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17121 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
17122 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
17123
17124 @item show task detach-suspend-count
17125 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
17126
17127 @item set task exception-port
17128 @itemx set task excp
17129 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17130 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
17131 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
17132 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
17133
17134 @item set noninvasive
17135 @cindex noninvasive task options
17136 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
17137 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
17138 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
17139 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
17140
17141 @item info send-rights
17142 @itemx info receive-rights
17143 @itemx info port-rights
17144 @itemx info port-sets
17145 @itemx info dead-names
17146 @itemx info ports
17147 @itemx info psets
17148 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17149 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17150 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17151 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17152 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17153 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
17154 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
17155 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
17156 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
17157
17158 @item set thread pause
17159 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
17160 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17161 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17162 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
17163 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
17164 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
17165 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
17166 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
17167 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
17168 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
17169 only the current thread.
17170
17171 @item show thread pause
17172 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
17173 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
17174
17175 @item set thread run
17176 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17177
17178 @item show thread run
17179 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17180
17181 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
17182 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17183 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17184 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
17185 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
17186 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
17187 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
17188
17189 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
17190 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
17191 detaching.
17192
17193 @item set thread exception-port
17194 @itemx set thread excp
17195 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
17196 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
17197 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
17198
17199 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
17200 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
17201 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
17202 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
17203
17204 @item set thread default
17205 @itemx show thread default
17206 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17207 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
17208 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
17209 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
17210 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
17211 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
17212 the non-default commands.
17213 @end table
17214
17215
17216 @node Neutrino
17217 @subsection QNX Neutrino
17218 @cindex QNX Neutrino
17219
17220 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
17221 Neutrino target:
17222
17223 @table @code
17224 @item set debug nto-debug
17225 @kindex set debug nto-debug
17226 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
17227 Neutrino support.
17228
17229 @item show debug nto-debug
17230 @kindex show debug nto-debug
17231 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
17232 @end table
17233
17234 @node Darwin
17235 @subsection Darwin
17236 @cindex Darwin
17237
17238 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
17239
17240 @table @code
17241 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
17242 @kindex set debug darwin
17243 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
17244 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
17245
17246 @item show debug darwin
17247 @kindex show debug darwin
17248 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
17249
17250 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
17251 @kindex set debug mach-o
17252 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
17253 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
17254 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
17255 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
17256 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
17257 usage.
17258
17259 @item show debug mach-o
17260 @kindex show debug mach-o
17261 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
17262
17263 @item set mach-exceptions on
17264 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
17265 @kindex set mach-exceptions
17266 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
17267 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
17268 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
17269 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
17270
17271 @item show mach-exceptions
17272 @kindex show mach-exceptions
17273 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
17274 @end table
17275
17276
17277 @node Embedded OS
17278 @section Embedded Operating Systems
17279
17280 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
17281 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
17282 architectures.
17283
17284 @menu
17285 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17286 @end menu
17287
17288 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
17289 various real-time operating systems.
17290
17291 @node VxWorks
17292 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17293
17294 @cindex VxWorks
17295
17296 @table @code
17297
17298 @kindex target vxworks
17299 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
17300 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
17301 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
17302
17303 @end table
17304
17305 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
17306 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
17307
17308 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
17309 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
17310 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17311 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
17312 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
17313 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
17314 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
17315
17316 @table @code
17317 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
17318 @kindex vxworks-timeout
17319 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
17320 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17321 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
17322 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
17323 of a thin network line.
17324 @end table
17325
17326 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
17327 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
17328 procedures.
17329
17330 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
17331 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
17332 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
17333 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
17334 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
17335 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
17336 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
17337 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
17338 manual.
17339 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
17340
17341 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
17342 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17343 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
17344 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
17345
17346 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17347
17348 @smallexample
17349 (vxgdb)
17350 @end smallexample
17351
17352 @menu
17353 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
17354 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
17355 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
17356 @end menu
17357
17358 @node VxWorks Connection
17359 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
17360
17361 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
17362 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
17363
17364 @smallexample
17365 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
17366 @end smallexample
17367
17368 @need 750
17369 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17370
17371 @smallexample
17372 Attaching remote machine across net...
17373 Connected to tt.
17374 @end smallexample
17375
17376 @need 1000
17377 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
17378 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
17379 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
17380 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
17381 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
17382
17383 @smallexample
17384 prog.o: No such file or directory.
17385 @end smallexample
17386
17387 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
17388 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
17389 command again.
17390
17391 @node VxWorks Download
17392 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
17393
17394 @cindex download to VxWorks
17395 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
17396 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
17397 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
17398 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
17399 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
17400 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
17401 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
17402 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
17403 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
17404 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
17405 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
17406 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
17407 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
17408 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
17409 program, type this on VxWorks:
17410
17411 @smallexample
17412 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
17413 @end smallexample
17414
17415 @noindent
17416 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
17417
17418 @smallexample
17419 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
17420 (vxgdb) load prog.o
17421 @end smallexample
17422
17423 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
17424
17425 @smallexample
17426 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
17427 @end smallexample
17428
17429 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
17430 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
17431 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
17432 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
17433 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
17434 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
17435 table.)
17436
17437 @node VxWorks Attach
17438 @subsubsection Running Tasks
17439
17440 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
17441 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
17442 follows:
17443
17444 @smallexample
17445 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
17446 @end smallexample
17447
17448 @noindent
17449 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
17450 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
17451 the time of attachment.
17452
17453 @node Embedded Processors
17454 @section Embedded Processors
17455
17456 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
17457 configurations.
17458
17459 @cindex send command to simulator
17460 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
17461 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
17462
17463 @table @code
17464 @item sim @var{command}
17465 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
17466 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
17467 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
17468 acceptable commands.
17469 @end table
17470
17471
17472 @menu
17473 * ARM:: ARM RDI
17474 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
17475 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
17476 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
17477 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
17478 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
17479 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
17480 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
17481 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
17482 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
17483 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
17484 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
17485 * CRIS:: CRIS
17486 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
17487 @end menu
17488
17489 @node ARM
17490 @subsection ARM
17491 @cindex ARM RDI
17492
17493 @table @code
17494 @kindex target rdi
17495 @item target rdi @var{dev}
17496 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
17497 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
17498 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
17499
17500 @kindex target rdp
17501 @item target rdp @var{dev}
17502 ARM Demon monitor.
17503
17504 @end table
17505
17506 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
17507
17508 @table @code
17509 @item set arm disassembler
17510 @kindex set arm
17511 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
17512 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
17513
17514 @item show arm disassembler
17515 @kindex show arm
17516 Show the current disassembly style.
17517
17518 @item set arm apcs32
17519 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
17520 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
17521
17522 @item show arm apcs32
17523 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
17524
17525 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
17526 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
17527 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
17528
17529 @table @code
17530 @item auto
17531 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
17532 @item softfpa
17533 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
17534 processors.
17535 @item fpa
17536 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
17537 @item softvfp
17538 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
17539 @item vfp
17540 VFP co-processor.
17541 @end table
17542
17543 @item show arm fpu
17544 Show the current type of the FPU.
17545
17546 @item set arm abi
17547 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
17548
17549 @item show arm abi
17550 Show the currently used ABI.
17551
17552 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
17553 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
17554 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
17555 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
17556 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
17557 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
17558 register).
17559
17560 @item show arm fallback-mode
17561 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
17562
17563 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
17564 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
17565 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
17566 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
17567 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
17568
17569 @item show arm force-mode
17570 Show the current forced instruction mode.
17571
17572 @item set debug arm
17573 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
17574 target support subsystem.
17575
17576 @item show debug arm
17577 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
17578 @end table
17579
17580 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
17581 using the RDI interface:
17582
17583 @table @code
17584 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17585 @kindex rdilogfile
17586 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
17587 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
17588 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
17589 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
17590 @file{rdi.log}.
17591
17592 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
17593 @kindex rdilogenable
17594 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
17595 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
17596 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
17597 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
17598 are logged to a file.
17599
17600 @item set rdiromatzero
17601 @kindex set rdiromatzero
17602 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
17603 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
17604 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
17605 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
17606 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
17607
17608 @item show rdiromatzero
17609 @kindex show rdiromatzero
17610 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
17611
17612 @item set rdiheartbeat
17613 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
17614 @cindex RDI heartbeat
17615 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
17616 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
17617 well as the Angel monitor.
17618
17619 @item show rdiheartbeat
17620 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
17621 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
17622 @end table
17623
17624 @table @code
17625 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
17626 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
17627
17628 @table @code
17629 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
17630 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
17631 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
17632 The default value is @code{all}.
17633
17634 @table @code
17635 @item none
17636 @item demon
17637 @item angel
17638 @item redboot
17639 @item all
17640 @end table
17641 @end table
17642 @end table
17643
17644 @node M32R/D
17645 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
17646
17647 @table @code
17648 @kindex target m32r
17649 @item target m32r @var{dev}
17650 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
17651
17652 @kindex target m32rsdi
17653 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
17654 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
17655 @end table
17656
17657 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
17658
17659 @table @code
17660 @item set download-path @var{path}
17661 @kindex set download-path
17662 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
17663 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
17664
17665 @item show download-path
17666 @kindex show download-path
17667 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
17668
17669 @item set board-address @var{addr}
17670 @kindex set board-address
17671 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
17672 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
17673
17674 @item show board-address
17675 @kindex show board-address
17676 Show the current IP address of the target board.
17677
17678 @item set server-address @var{addr}
17679 @kindex set server-address
17680 @cindex download server address (M32R)
17681 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
17682 host machine.
17683
17684 @item show server-address
17685 @kindex show server-address
17686 Display the IP address of the download server.
17687
17688 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17689 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
17690 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
17691 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
17692 executable file is uploaded.
17693
17694 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17695 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
17696 Test the @code{upload} command.
17697 @end table
17698
17699 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
17700
17701 @table @code
17702 @item sdireset
17703 @kindex sdireset
17704 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
17705 This command resets the SDI connection.
17706
17707 @item sdistatus
17708 @kindex sdistatus
17709 This command shows the SDI connection status.
17710
17711 @item debug_chaos
17712 @kindex debug_chaos
17713 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
17714 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
17715
17716 @item use_debug_dma
17717 @kindex use_debug_dma
17718 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
17719
17720 @item use_mon_code
17721 @kindex use_mon_code
17722 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
17723
17724 @item use_ib_break
17725 @kindex use_ib_break
17726 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
17727
17728 @item use_dbt_break
17729 @kindex use_dbt_break
17730 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
17731 @end table
17732
17733 @node M68K
17734 @subsection M68k
17735
17736 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
17737 target command for the following ROM monitor.
17738
17739 @table @code
17740
17741 @kindex target dbug
17742 @item target dbug @var{dev}
17743 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
17744
17745 @end table
17746
17747 @node MicroBlaze
17748 @subsection MicroBlaze
17749 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
17750 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
17751
17752 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
17753 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
17754 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
17755 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
17756 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
17757 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
17758 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
17759 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
17760 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
17761 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
17762 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
17763
17764 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
17765
17766 @table @code
17767 @item target remote :1234
17768 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
17769 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
17770
17771 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
17772 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
17773 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
17774
17775 @item load
17776 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
17777
17778 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
17779 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
17780
17781 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
17782 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
17783 @end table
17784
17785 @node MIPS Embedded
17786 @subsection MIPS Embedded
17787
17788 @cindex MIPS boards
17789 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
17790 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
17791 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
17792
17793 @need 1000
17794 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
17795
17796 @table @code
17797 @item target mips @var{port}
17798 @kindex target mips @var{port}
17799 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
17800 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
17801 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
17802 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
17803 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
17804 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
17805
17806 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
17807 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
17808 debugger:
17809
17810 @smallexample
17811 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
17812 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
17813 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
17814 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
17815 (@value{GDBP}) run
17816 @end smallexample
17817
17818 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
17819 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
17820 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
17821 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
17822 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
17823
17824 @item target pmon @var{port}
17825 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
17826 PMON ROM monitor.
17827
17828 @item target ddb @var{port}
17829 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
17830 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
17831
17832 @item target lsi @var{port}
17833 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
17834 LSI variant of PMON.
17835
17836 @kindex target r3900
17837 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
17838 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
17839
17840 @kindex target array
17841 @item target array @var{dev}
17842 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
17843
17844 @end table
17845
17846
17847 @noindent
17848 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
17849
17850 @table @code
17851 @item set mipsfpu double
17852 @itemx set mipsfpu single
17853 @itemx set mipsfpu none
17854 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
17855 @itemx show mipsfpu
17856 @kindex set mipsfpu
17857 @kindex show mipsfpu
17858 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
17859 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
17860 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
17861 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
17862 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
17863 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
17864 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
17865 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
17866 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
17867 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
17868 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
17869 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
17870 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
17871
17872 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
17873 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
17874 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
17875
17876 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
17877 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
17878
17879 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
17880 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
17881 @itemx show timeout
17882 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
17883 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
17884 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
17885 @kindex set timeout
17886 @kindex show timeout
17887 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
17888 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
17889 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
17890 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
17891 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
17892 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
17893 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
17894 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
17895 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
17896 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
17897
17898 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
17899 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
17900 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
17901 to run before stopping.
17902
17903 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
17904 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17905 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
17906 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
17907 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
17908 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
17909
17910 @item show syn-garbage-limit
17911 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17912 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
17913 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
17914
17915 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
17916 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17917 @cindex remote monitor prompt
17918 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
17919 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
17920 @table @asis
17921 @item pmon target
17922 @samp{PMON}
17923 @item ddb target
17924 @samp{NEC010}
17925 @item lsi target
17926 @samp{PMON>}
17927 @end table
17928
17929 @item show monitor-prompt
17930 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17931 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
17932 remote monitor.
17933
17934 @item set monitor-warnings
17935 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17936 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
17937 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
17938 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
17939 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
17940
17941 @item show monitor-warnings
17942 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17943 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
17944
17945 @item pmon @var{command}
17946 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
17947 @cindex send PMON command
17948 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
17949 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
17950 @end table
17951
17952 @node OpenRISC 1000
17953 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
17954 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
17955
17956 @cindex or1k boards
17957 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
17958 about platform and commands.
17959
17960 @table @code
17961
17962 @kindex target jtag
17963 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
17964
17965 Connects to remote JTAG server.
17966 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
17967 connected via parallel port to the board.
17968
17969 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
17970
17971 @kindex or1ksim
17972 @item or1ksim @var{command}
17973 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
17974 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
17975
17976 @kindex info or1k spr
17977 @item info or1k spr
17978 Displays spr groups.
17979
17980 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
17981 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
17982 Displays register names in selected group.
17983
17984 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
17985 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
17986 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
17987 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
17988 Shows information about specified spr register.
17989
17990 @kindex spr
17991 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
17992 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
17993 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
17994 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
17995 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
17996 @end table
17997
17998 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
17999 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
18000 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
18001 triggers can be set using:
18002 @table @code
18003 @item $LEA/$LDATA
18004 Load effective address/data
18005 @item $SEA/$SDATA
18006 Store effective address/data
18007 @item $AEA/$ADATA
18008 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
18009 @item $FETCH
18010 Fetch data
18011 @end table
18012
18013 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
18014 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
18015
18016 @code{htrace} commands:
18017 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
18018 @table @code
18019 @kindex hwatch
18020 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
18021 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
18022 or Data. For example:
18023
18024 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18025
18026 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18027
18028 @kindex htrace
18029 @item htrace info
18030 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
18031
18032 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
18033 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
18034
18035 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
18036 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
18037
18038 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
18039 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
18040
18041 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
18042 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
18043 triggered.
18044
18045 @item htrace enable
18046 @itemx htrace disable
18047 Enables/disables the HW trace.
18048
18049 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
18050 Clears currently recorded trace data.
18051
18052 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
18053 will be written there.
18054
18055 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
18056 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
18057
18058 @item htrace mode continuous
18059 Set continuous trace mode.
18060
18061 @item htrace mode suspend
18062 Set suspend trace mode.
18063
18064 @end table
18065
18066 @node PowerPC Embedded
18067 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
18068
18069 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
18070
18071 @table @code
18072 @kindex set powerpc
18073 @item set powerpc soft-float
18074 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
18075 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
18076 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
18077 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18078
18079 @item set powerpc vector-abi
18080 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
18081 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
18082 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
18083 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
18084 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
18085 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
18086 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18087
18088 @kindex target dink32
18089 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
18090 DINK32 ROM monitor.
18091
18092 @kindex target ppcbug
18093 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
18094 @kindex target ppcbug1
18095 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
18096 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
18097
18098 @kindex target sds
18099 @item target sds @var{dev}
18100 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
18101 @end table
18102
18103 @cindex SDS protocol
18104 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
18105 by @value{GDBN}:
18106
18107 @table @code
18108 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
18109 @kindex set sdstimeout
18110 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
18111 default is 2 seconds.
18112
18113 @item show sdstimeout
18114 @kindex show sdstimeout
18115 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
18116
18117 @item sds @var{command}
18118 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
18119 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
18120 @end table
18121
18122
18123 @node PA
18124 @subsection HP PA Embedded
18125
18126 @table @code
18127
18128 @kindex target op50n
18129 @item target op50n @var{dev}
18130 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
18131
18132 @kindex target w89k
18133 @item target w89k @var{dev}
18134 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
18135
18136 @end table
18137
18138 @node Sparclet
18139 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
18140
18141 @cindex Sparclet
18142
18143 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
18144 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
18145 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18146 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
18147 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
18148
18149 @table @code
18150 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
18151 @kindex remotetimeout
18152 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
18153 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18154 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
18155 @end table
18156
18157 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
18158 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
18159 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
18160 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
18161 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
18162
18163 @smallexample
18164 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
18165 @end smallexample
18166
18167 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
18168
18169 @smallexample
18170 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
18171 @end smallexample
18172
18173 @cindex running, on Sparclet
18174 Once you have set
18175 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18176 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
18177 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
18178
18179 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18180
18181 @smallexample
18182 (gdbslet)
18183 @end smallexample
18184
18185 @menu
18186 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
18187 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
18188 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
18189 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
18190 @end menu
18191
18192 @node Sparclet File
18193 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
18194
18195 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
18196
18197 @smallexample
18198 (gdbslet) file prog
18199 @end smallexample
18200
18201 @need 1000
18202 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
18203 @value{GDBN} locates
18204 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
18205 path.
18206 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
18207 files will be searched as well.
18208 @value{GDBN} locates
18209 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
18210 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
18211 If it fails
18212 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
18213
18214 @smallexample
18215 prog: No such file or directory.
18216 @end smallexample
18217
18218 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
18219 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
18220 @code{target} command again.
18221
18222 @node Sparclet Connection
18223 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
18224
18225 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
18226 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
18227
18228 @smallexample
18229 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
18230 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
18231 main () at ../prog.c:3
18232 @end smallexample
18233
18234 @need 750
18235 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18236
18237 @smallexample
18238 Connected to ttya.
18239 @end smallexample
18240
18241 @node Sparclet Download
18242 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
18243
18244 @cindex download to Sparclet
18245 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
18246 you can use the @value{GDBN}
18247 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
18248 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
18249 command.
18250 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
18251 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
18252 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
18253 of each of the file's sections.
18254 For instance, if the program
18255 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
18256 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18257
18258 @smallexample
18259 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
18260 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
18261 @end smallexample
18262
18263 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
18264 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
18265 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
18266
18267 @node Sparclet Execution
18268 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
18269
18270 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
18271 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
18272 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
18273 manual for the list of commands.
18274
18275 @smallexample
18276 (gdbslet) b main
18277 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
18278 (gdbslet) run
18279 Starting program: prog
18280 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
18281 3 char *symarg = 0;
18282 (gdbslet) step
18283 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
18284 (gdbslet)
18285 @end smallexample
18286
18287 @node Sparclite
18288 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
18289
18290 @table @code
18291
18292 @kindex target sparclite
18293 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
18294 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
18295 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
18296 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
18297 remote protocol.
18298
18299 @end table
18300
18301 @node Z8000
18302 @subsection Zilog Z8000
18303
18304 @cindex Z8000
18305 @cindex simulator, Z8000
18306 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
18307
18308 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
18309 a Z8000 simulator.
18310
18311 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
18312 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
18313 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
18314 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
18315
18316 @table @code
18317 @item target sim @var{args}
18318 @kindex sim
18319 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
18320 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
18321 options, specify them via @var{args}.
18322 @end table
18323
18324 @noindent
18325 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
18326 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
18327 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
18328 to run your program, and so on.
18329
18330 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
18331 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
18332 additional items of information as specially named registers:
18333
18334 @table @code
18335
18336 @item cycles
18337 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
18338
18339 @item insts
18340 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
18341
18342 @item time
18343 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
18344
18345 @end table
18346
18347 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
18348 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
18349 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
18350 simulated clock ticks.
18351
18352 @node AVR
18353 @subsection Atmel AVR
18354 @cindex AVR
18355
18356 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
18357 following AVR-specific commands:
18358
18359 @table @code
18360 @item info io_registers
18361 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
18362 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
18363 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
18364 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
18365 @end table
18366
18367 @node CRIS
18368 @subsection CRIS
18369 @cindex CRIS
18370
18371 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
18372 following CRIS-specific commands:
18373
18374 @table @code
18375 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
18376 @cindex CRIS version
18377 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
18378 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
18379 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
18380
18381 @item show cris-version
18382 Show the current CRIS version.
18383
18384 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
18385 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
18386 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
18387 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
18388 @code{R59}.
18389
18390 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
18391 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
18392
18393 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
18394 @cindex CRIS mode
18395 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
18396 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
18397 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
18398
18399 @item show cris-mode
18400 Show the current CRIS mode.
18401 @end table
18402
18403 @node Super-H
18404 @subsection Renesas Super-H
18405 @cindex Super-H
18406
18407 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
18408 commands:
18409
18410 @table @code
18411 @item regs
18412 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
18413 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
18414
18415 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
18416 @kindex set sh calling-convention
18417 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
18418 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
18419 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
18420 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
18421 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
18422 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
18423 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
18424 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
18425 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
18426 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
18427
18428 @item show sh calling-convention
18429 @kindex show sh calling-convention
18430 Show the current calling convention setting.
18431
18432 @end table
18433
18434
18435 @node Architectures
18436 @section Architectures
18437
18438 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
18439 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
18440
18441 @menu
18442 * i386::
18443 * A29K::
18444 * Alpha::
18445 * MIPS::
18446 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
18447 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
18448 * PowerPC::
18449 @end menu
18450
18451 @node i386
18452 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
18453
18454 @table @code
18455 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
18456 @kindex set struct-convention
18457 @cindex struct return convention
18458 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
18459 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
18460 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
18461 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
18462 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
18463 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
18464 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
18465 be returned in a register.
18466
18467 @item show struct-convention
18468 @kindex show struct-convention
18469 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
18470 from functions.
18471 @end table
18472
18473 @node A29K
18474 @subsection A29K
18475
18476 @table @code
18477
18478 @kindex set rstack_high_address
18479 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
18480 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
18481 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
18482 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
18483 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
18484 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
18485 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
18486 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
18487 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
18488 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
18489 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
18490 hexadecimal.
18491
18492 @kindex show rstack_high_address
18493 @item show rstack_high_address
18494 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
18495 processors.
18496
18497 @end table
18498
18499 @node Alpha
18500 @subsection Alpha
18501
18502 See the following section.
18503
18504 @node MIPS
18505 @subsection MIPS
18506
18507 @cindex stack on Alpha
18508 @cindex stack on MIPS
18509 @cindex Alpha stack
18510 @cindex MIPS stack
18511 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
18512 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
18513 find the beginning of a function.
18514
18515 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
18516 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
18517 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
18518 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
18519 commands:
18520
18521 @table @code
18522 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
18523 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
18524 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
18525 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
18526 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
18527 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
18528 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
18529 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
18530
18531 @item show heuristic-fence-post
18532 Display the current limit.
18533 @end table
18534
18535 @noindent
18536 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
18537 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
18538
18539 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
18540 programs:
18541
18542 @table @code
18543 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
18544 @kindex set mips abi
18545 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
18546 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
18547 values of @var{arg} are:
18548
18549 @table @samp
18550 @item auto
18551 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
18552 default).
18553 @item o32
18554 @item o64
18555 @item n32
18556 @item n64
18557 @item eabi32
18558 @item eabi64
18559 @item auto
18560 @end table
18561
18562 @item show mips abi
18563 @kindex show mips abi
18564 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
18565
18566 @item set mipsfpu
18567 @itemx show mipsfpu
18568 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
18569
18570 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
18571 @kindex set mips mask-address
18572 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
18573 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
18574 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
18575 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
18576 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
18577
18578 @item show mips mask-address
18579 @kindex show mips mask-address
18580 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
18581 not.
18582
18583 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18584 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18585 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
18586 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
18587 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
18588 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
18589
18590 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18591 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18592 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
18593
18594 @item set debug mips
18595 @kindex set debug mips
18596 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
18597 target code in @value{GDBN}.
18598
18599 @item show debug mips
18600 @kindex show debug mips
18601 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
18602 @end table
18603
18604
18605 @node HPPA
18606 @subsection HPPA
18607 @cindex HPPA support
18608
18609 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
18610 following special commands:
18611
18612 @table @code
18613 @item set debug hppa
18614 @kindex set debug hppa
18615 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
18616 messages are to be displayed.
18617
18618 @item show debug hppa
18619 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
18620
18621 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
18622 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
18623 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
18624 given @var{address}.
18625
18626 @end table
18627
18628
18629 @node SPU
18630 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
18631 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
18632 @cindex SPU
18633
18634 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
18635 it provides the following special commands:
18636
18637 @table @code
18638 @item info spu event
18639 @kindex info spu
18640 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
18641 and pending event status.
18642
18643 @item info spu signal
18644 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
18645 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
18646 notification channels.
18647
18648 @item info spu mailbox
18649 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
18650 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
18651 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
18652
18653 @item info spu dma
18654 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
18655 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
18656 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
18657
18658 @item info spu proxydma
18659 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
18660 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
18661 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
18662
18663 @end table
18664
18665 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
18666 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
18667 special commands:
18668
18669 @table @code
18670 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
18671 @kindex set spu
18672 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
18673 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
18674 function. The default is @code{off}.
18675
18676 @item show spu stop-on-load
18677 @kindex show spu
18678 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
18679
18680 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
18681 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
18682 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
18683 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
18684 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
18685 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
18686
18687 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
18688 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
18689
18690 @end table
18691
18692 @node PowerPC
18693 @subsection PowerPC
18694 @cindex PowerPC architecture
18695
18696 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
18697 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
18698 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
18699 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
18700 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
18701
18702 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
18703 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
18704 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
18705
18706 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
18707 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
18708
18709
18710 @node Controlling GDB
18711 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
18712
18713 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
18714 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
18715 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
18716 described here.
18717
18718 @menu
18719 * Prompt:: Prompt
18720 * Editing:: Command editing
18721 * Command History:: Command history
18722 * Screen Size:: Screen size
18723 * Numbers:: Numbers
18724 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
18725 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
18726 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
18727 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
18728 @end menu
18729
18730 @node Prompt
18731 @section Prompt
18732
18733 @cindex prompt
18734
18735 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
18736 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
18737 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
18738 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
18739 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
18740 which one you are talking to.
18741
18742 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
18743 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
18744 or a prompt that does not.
18745
18746 @table @code
18747 @kindex set prompt
18748 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
18749 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
18750
18751 @kindex show prompt
18752 @item show prompt
18753 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
18754 @end table
18755
18756 @node Editing
18757 @section Command Editing
18758 @cindex readline
18759 @cindex command line editing
18760
18761 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
18762 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
18763 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
18764 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
18765 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
18766 debugging sessions.
18767
18768 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
18769 command @code{set}.
18770
18771 @table @code
18772 @kindex set editing
18773 @cindex editing
18774 @item set editing
18775 @itemx set editing on
18776 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
18777
18778 @item set editing off
18779 Disable command line editing.
18780
18781 @kindex show editing
18782 @item show editing
18783 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
18784 @end table
18785
18786 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
18787 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
18788 encouraged to read that chapter.
18789
18790 @node Command History
18791 @section Command History
18792 @cindex command history
18793
18794 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
18795 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
18796 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
18797 history facility.
18798
18799 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
18800 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
18801 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
18802
18803 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18804 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
18805 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
18806 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18807 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18808 pressed on a line by itself.
18809
18810 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
18811 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18812 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18813 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18814
18815 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
18816 history.
18817
18818 @table @code
18819 @cindex history substitution
18820 @cindex history file
18821 @kindex set history filename
18822 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
18823 @item set history filename @var{fname}
18824 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
18825 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
18826 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
18827 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
18828 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
18829 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
18830 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
18831 is not set.
18832
18833 @cindex save command history
18834 @kindex set history save
18835 @item set history save
18836 @itemx set history save on
18837 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
18838 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
18839
18840 @item set history save off
18841 Stop recording command history in a file.
18842
18843 @cindex history size
18844 @kindex set history size
18845 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
18846 @item set history size @var{size}
18847 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
18848 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
18849 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
18850 @end table
18851
18852 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
18853 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
18854
18855 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
18856 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
18857 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
18858 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
18859 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
18860 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
18861 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
18862 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
18863
18864 The commands to control history expansion are:
18865
18866 @table @code
18867 @item set history expansion on
18868 @itemx set history expansion
18869 @kindex set history expansion
18870 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
18871
18872 @item set history expansion off
18873 Disable history expansion.
18874
18875 @c @group
18876 @kindex show history
18877 @item show history
18878 @itemx show history filename
18879 @itemx show history save
18880 @itemx show history size
18881 @itemx show history expansion
18882 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
18883 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
18884 @c @end group
18885 @end table
18886
18887 @table @code
18888 @kindex show commands
18889 @cindex show last commands
18890 @cindex display command history
18891 @item show commands
18892 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
18893
18894 @item show commands @var{n}
18895 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
18896
18897 @item show commands +
18898 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
18899 @end table
18900
18901 @node Screen Size
18902 @section Screen Size
18903 @cindex size of screen
18904 @cindex pauses in output
18905
18906 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
18907 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
18908 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
18909 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
18910 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
18911 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
18912 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
18913 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
18914
18915 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
18916 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
18917 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
18918 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
18919 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
18920 width} commands:
18921
18922 @table @code
18923 @kindex set height
18924 @kindex set width
18925 @kindex show width
18926 @kindex show height
18927 @item set height @var{lpp}
18928 @itemx show height
18929 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
18930 @itemx show width
18931 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
18932 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
18933 commands display the current settings.
18934
18935 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
18936 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
18937 file or to an editor buffer.
18938
18939 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
18940 from wrapping its output.
18941
18942 @item set pagination on
18943 @itemx set pagination off
18944 @kindex set pagination
18945 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
18946 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
18947 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
18948 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
18949
18950 @item show pagination
18951 @kindex show pagination
18952 Show the current pagination mode.
18953 @end table
18954
18955 @node Numbers
18956 @section Numbers
18957 @cindex number representation
18958 @cindex entering numbers
18959
18960 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
18961 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
18962 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
18963 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
18964 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
18965 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
18966 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
18967 both input and output with the commands described below.
18968
18969 @table @code
18970 @kindex set input-radix
18971 @item set input-radix @var{base}
18972 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
18973 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18974 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
18975 example, any of
18976
18977 @smallexample
18978 set input-radix 012
18979 set input-radix 10.
18980 set input-radix 0xa
18981 @end smallexample
18982
18983 @noindent
18984 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
18985 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
18986 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
18987 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
18988 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
18989 change the radix.
18990
18991 @kindex set output-radix
18992 @item set output-radix @var{base}
18993 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
18994 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18995 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
18996
18997 @kindex show input-radix
18998 @item show input-radix
18999 Display the current default base for numeric input.
19000
19001 @kindex show output-radix
19002 @item show output-radix
19003 Display the current default base for numeric display.
19004
19005 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
19006 @itemx show radix
19007 @kindex set radix
19008 @kindex show radix
19009 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
19010 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
19011 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
19012 default value of 10.
19013
19014 @end table
19015
19016 @node ABI
19017 @section Configuring the Current ABI
19018
19019 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
19020 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
19021 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
19022 current ABI.
19023
19024 @cindex OS ABI
19025 @kindex set osabi
19026 @kindex show osabi
19027
19028 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
19029 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
19030 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
19031 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
19032 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
19033 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
19034 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
19035 platform provides.
19036
19037 @table @code
19038 @item show osabi
19039 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
19040
19041 @item set osabi
19042 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
19043
19044 @item set osabi @var{abi}
19045 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
19046 @end table
19047
19048 @cindex float promotion
19049
19050 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
19051 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
19052 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
19053 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
19054 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
19055 @code{double} and then passed.
19056
19057 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
19058 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
19059 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
19060
19061 @table @code
19062 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
19063 @item set coerce-float-to-double
19064 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
19065 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
19066 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
19067
19068 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
19069 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
19070 functions.
19071
19072 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
19073 @item show coerce-float-to-double
19074 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
19075 @end table
19076
19077 @kindex set cp-abi
19078 @kindex show cp-abi
19079 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
19080 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
19081 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
19082 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
19083 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
19084 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
19085 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
19086 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
19087 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
19088 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
19089 ``auto''.
19090
19091 @table @code
19092 @item show cp-abi
19093 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
19094
19095 @item set cp-abi
19096 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
19097
19098 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
19099 @itemx set cp-abi auto
19100 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
19101 @end table
19102
19103 @node Messages/Warnings
19104 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
19105
19106 @cindex verbose operation
19107 @cindex optional warnings
19108 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
19109 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
19110 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
19111 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
19112
19113 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
19114 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
19115 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19116
19117 @table @code
19118 @kindex set verbose
19119 @item set verbose on
19120 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19121
19122 @item set verbose off
19123 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19124
19125 @kindex show verbose
19126 @item show verbose
19127 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
19128 @end table
19129
19130 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
19131 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
19132 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
19133 Symbol Files}).
19134
19135 @table @code
19136
19137 @kindex set complaints
19138 @item set complaints @var{limit}
19139 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
19140 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
19141 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
19142 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
19143
19144 @kindex show complaints
19145 @item show complaints
19146 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
19147
19148 @end table
19149
19150 @anchor{confirmation requests}
19151 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
19152 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
19153 you try to run a program which is already running:
19154
19155 @smallexample
19156 (@value{GDBP}) run
19157 The program being debugged has been started already.
19158 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
19159 @end smallexample
19160
19161 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
19162 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
19163
19164 @table @code
19165
19166 @kindex set confirm
19167 @cindex flinching
19168 @cindex confirmation
19169 @cindex stupid questions
19170 @item set confirm off
19171 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
19172 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
19173 automatically disables confirmation requests.
19174
19175 @item set confirm on
19176 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
19177
19178 @kindex show confirm
19179 @item show confirm
19180 Displays state of confirmation requests.
19181
19182 @end table
19183
19184 @cindex command tracing
19185 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
19186 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
19187 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
19188 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
19189
19190 @table @code
19191 @kindex set trace-commands
19192 @cindex command scripts, debugging
19193 @item set trace-commands on
19194 Enable command tracing.
19195 @item set trace-commands off
19196 Disable command tracing.
19197 @item show trace-commands
19198 Display the current state of command tracing.
19199 @end table
19200
19201 @node Debugging Output
19202 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
19203 @cindex optional debugging messages
19204
19205 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
19206 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
19207 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
19208 section documents those commands.
19209
19210 @table @code
19211 @kindex set exec-done-display
19212 @item set exec-done-display
19213 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
19214 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
19215 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
19216 @kindex show exec-done-display
19217 @item show exec-done-display
19218 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
19219 notification.
19220 @kindex set debug
19221 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
19222 @cindex architecture debugging info
19223 @item set debug arch
19224 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
19225 @kindex show debug
19226 @item show debug arch
19227 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
19228 @item set debug aix-thread
19229 @cindex AIX threads
19230 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
19231 module.
19232 @item show debug aix-thread
19233 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
19234 @item set debug dwarf2-die
19235 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
19236 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
19237 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
19238 A value of zero turns off the display.
19239 @item show debug dwarf2-die
19240 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
19241 @item set debug displaced
19242 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
19243 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
19244 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
19245 @item show debug displaced
19246 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
19247 related to displaced stepping.
19248 @item set debug event
19249 @cindex event debugging info
19250 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
19251 default is off.
19252 @item show debug event
19253 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
19254 info.
19255 @item set debug expression
19256 @cindex expression debugging info
19257 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
19258 expression parsing. The default is off.
19259 @item show debug expression
19260 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
19261 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
19262 @item set debug frame
19263 @cindex frame debugging info
19264 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
19265 default is off.
19266 @item show debug frame
19267 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
19268 info.
19269 @item set debug gnu-nat
19270 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
19271 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
19272 @item show debug gnu-nat
19273 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
19274 @item set debug infrun
19275 @cindex inferior debugging info
19276 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
19277 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
19278 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
19279 @item show debug infrun
19280 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
19281 @item set debug lin-lwp
19282 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
19283 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19284 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
19285 @item show debug lin-lwp
19286 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
19287 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
19288 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
19289 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19290 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
19291 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
19292 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
19293 @item set debug observer
19294 @cindex observer debugging info
19295 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
19296 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
19297 @item show debug observer
19298 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
19299 @item set debug overload
19300 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
19301 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
19302 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
19303 is off.
19304 @item show debug overload
19305 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
19306 debugging info.
19307 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
19308 @cindex debug expression parser
19309 @item set debug parser
19310 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
19311 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
19312 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
19313 details. The default is off.
19314 @item show debug parser
19315 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
19316 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
19317 @cindex serial connections, debugging
19318 @cindex debug remote protocol
19319 @cindex remote protocol debugging
19320 @cindex display remote packets
19321 @item set debug remote
19322 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
19323 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
19324 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
19325 @item show debug remote
19326 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
19327 @item set debug serial
19328 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
19329 default is off.
19330 @item show debug serial
19331 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
19332 info.
19333 @item set debug solib-frv
19334 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
19335 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
19336 @item show debug solib-frv
19337 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
19338 messages.
19339 @item set debug target
19340 @cindex target debugging info
19341 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
19342 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
19343 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
19344 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
19345 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
19346 @item show debug target
19347 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
19348 info.
19349 @item set debug timestamp
19350 @cindex timestampping debugging info
19351 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
19352 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
19353 message.
19354 @item show debug timestamp
19355 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
19356 debugging info.
19357 @item set debugvarobj
19358 @cindex variable object debugging info
19359 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
19360 info. The default is off.
19361 @item show debugvarobj
19362 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
19363 debugging info.
19364 @item set debug xml
19365 @cindex XML parser debugging
19366 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
19367 @item show debug xml
19368 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
19369 @end table
19370
19371 @node Other Misc Settings
19372 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
19373 @cindex miscellaneous settings
19374
19375 @table @code
19376 @kindex set interactive-mode
19377 @item set interactive-mode
19378 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate interactively.
19379 If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate non-interactively,
19380 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} guesses which mode to use,
19381 based on whether the debugger was started in a terminal or not.
19382
19383 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
19384 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
19385 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
19386 inside a cygwin window.
19387
19388 @kindex show interactive-mode
19389 @item show interactive-mode
19390 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
19391 @end table
19392
19393 @node Extending GDB
19394 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
19395 @cindex extending GDB
19396
19397 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
19398 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
19399 Python scripting language.
19400
19401 To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
19402 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
19403 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
19404 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
19405 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
19406 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
19407
19408 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
19409 setting:
19410
19411 @table @code
19412 @kindex set script-extension
19413 @kindex show script-extension
19414 @item set script-extension off
19415 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
19416
19417 @item set script-extension soft
19418 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
19419 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
19420 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
19421 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
19422
19423 @item set script-extension strict
19424 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
19425 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
19426 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
19427
19428 @item show script-extension
19429 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
19430
19431 @end table
19432
19433 @menu
19434 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
19435 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
19436 @end menu
19437
19438 @node Sequences
19439 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
19440
19441 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
19442 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
19443 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
19444 files.
19445
19446 @menu
19447 * Define:: How to define your own commands
19448 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
19449 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
19450 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
19451 @end menu
19452
19453 @node Define
19454 @subsection User-defined Commands
19455
19456 @cindex user-defined command
19457 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
19458 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
19459 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
19460 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
19461 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
19462 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
19463
19464 @smallexample
19465 define adder
19466 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
19467 end
19468 @end smallexample
19469
19470 @noindent
19471 To execute the command use:
19472
19473 @smallexample
19474 adder 1 2 3
19475 @end smallexample
19476
19477 @noindent
19478 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
19479 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
19480 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
19481 functions calls.
19482
19483 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
19484 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
19485 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
19486 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
19487
19488 @smallexample
19489 define adder
19490 if $argc == 2
19491 print $arg0 + $arg1
19492 end
19493 if $argc == 3
19494 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
19495 end
19496 end
19497 @end smallexample
19498
19499 @table @code
19500
19501 @kindex define
19502 @item define @var{commandname}
19503 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
19504 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
19505 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
19506 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
19507 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
19508 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
19509
19510 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
19511 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
19512 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
19513
19514 @kindex document
19515 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
19516 @item document @var{commandname}
19517 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
19518 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
19519 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
19520 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
19521 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
19522 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
19523
19524 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
19525 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
19526 does not change the documentation.
19527
19528 @kindex dont-repeat
19529 @cindex don't repeat command
19530 @item dont-repeat
19531 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
19532 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
19533 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
19534
19535 @kindex help user-defined
19536 @item help user-defined
19537 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
19538 (if any) for each.
19539
19540 @kindex show user
19541 @item show user
19542 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
19543 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
19544 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
19545 definitions for all user-defined commands.
19546
19547 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
19548 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
19549 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
19550 @item show max-user-call-depth
19551 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
19552 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
19553 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
19554 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
19555 @end table
19556
19557 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
19558 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
19559
19560 When user-defined commands are executed, the
19561 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
19562 stops execution of the user-defined command.
19563
19564 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
19565 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
19566 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
19567 messages when used in a user-defined command.
19568
19569 @node Hooks
19570 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
19571 @cindex command hooks
19572 @cindex hooks, for commands
19573 @cindex hooks, pre-command
19574
19575 @kindex hook
19576 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
19577 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
19578 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
19579 before that command.
19580
19581 @cindex hooks, post-command
19582 @kindex hookpost
19583 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
19584 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
19585 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
19586 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
19587 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
19588
19589 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
19590 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
19591
19592 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
19593 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
19594
19595 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
19596 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
19597 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
19598 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
19599 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
19600
19601 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
19602 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
19603 you could define:
19604
19605 @smallexample
19606 define hook-stop
19607 handle SIGALRM nopass
19608 end
19609
19610 define hook-run
19611 handle SIGALRM pass
19612 end
19613
19614 define hook-continue
19615 handle SIGALRM pass
19616 end
19617 @end smallexample
19618
19619 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
19620 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
19621 you could define:
19622
19623 @smallexample
19624 define hook-echo
19625 echo <<<---
19626 end
19627
19628 define hookpost-echo
19629 echo --->>>\n
19630 end
19631
19632 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
19633 <<<---Hello World--->>>
19634 (@value{GDBP})
19635
19636 @end smallexample
19637
19638 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
19639 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
19640 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
19641 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
19642 @c or not?
19643 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
19644 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
19645 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
19646
19647 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
19648 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
19649 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
19650
19651 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
19652 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
19653
19654 @node Command Files
19655 @subsection Command Files
19656
19657 @cindex command files
19658 @cindex scripting commands
19659 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
19660 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
19661 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
19662 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
19663 terminal.
19664
19665 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
19666 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
19667 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
19668 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
19669 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
19670
19671 @table @code
19672 @kindex source
19673 @cindex execute commands from a file
19674 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
19675 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
19676 @end table
19677
19678 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
19679 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
19680 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
19681 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
19682 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
19683
19684 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
19685 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
19686 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
19687 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
19688 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
19689 is not relevant to scripts.
19690
19691 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
19692 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
19693 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
19694 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
19695 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
19696 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
19697 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
19698 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
19699 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
19700 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
19701 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
19702 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
19703 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
19704 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
19705
19706 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
19707 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
19708 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
19709
19710 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
19711 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
19712 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
19713 when called from command files.
19714
19715 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
19716 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
19717 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
19718 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
19719 the next command.
19720
19721 @smallexample
19722 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
19723 @end smallexample
19724
19725 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
19726 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
19727 would be directed to @file{log}.
19728
19729 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
19730 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
19731 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
19732 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
19733 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
19734 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
19735 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
19736 conditionally, etc.
19737
19738 @table @code
19739 @kindex if
19740 @kindex else
19741 @item if
19742 @itemx else
19743 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
19744 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
19745 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
19746 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
19747 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
19748 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
19749 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
19750
19751 @kindex while
19752 @item while
19753 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
19754 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
19755 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
19756 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
19757 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
19758 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
19759
19760 @kindex loop_break
19761 @item loop_break
19762 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
19763 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
19764 line.
19765
19766 @kindex loop_continue
19767 @item loop_continue
19768 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
19769 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
19770 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
19771 the controlling expression.
19772
19773 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
19774 @item end
19775 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
19776 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
19777 @end table
19778
19779
19780 @node Output
19781 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
19782
19783 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
19784 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
19785 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
19786 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
19787 want.
19788
19789 @table @code
19790 @kindex echo
19791 @item echo @var{text}
19792 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
19793 @c because it is not in ANSI.
19794 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
19795 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
19796 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
19797 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
19798 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
19799 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
19800 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
19801 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
19802 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
19803
19804 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
19805 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
19806
19807 @smallexample
19808 echo This is some text\n\
19809 which is continued\n\
19810 onto several lines.\n
19811 @end smallexample
19812
19813 produces the same output as
19814
19815 @smallexample
19816 echo This is some text\n
19817 echo which is continued\n
19818 echo onto several lines.\n
19819 @end smallexample
19820
19821 @kindex output
19822 @item output @var{expression}
19823 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
19824 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
19825 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
19826 on expressions.
19827
19828 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
19829 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
19830 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
19831 Formats}, for more information.
19832
19833 @kindex printf
19834 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
19835 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
19836 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
19837 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
19838 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
19839 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
19840 executing the code below:
19841
19842 @smallexample
19843 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
19844 @end smallexample
19845
19846 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
19847 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
19848 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
19849 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
19850 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
19851 printed.
19852
19853 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
19854
19855 @smallexample
19856 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
19857 @end smallexample
19858
19859 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
19860 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
19861 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
19862
19863 @itemize @bullet
19864 @item
19865 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
19866
19867 @item
19868 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
19869 width.
19870
19871 @item
19872 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
19873 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
19874
19875 @item
19876 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
19877 supported.
19878
19879 @item
19880 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
19881
19882 @item
19883 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
19884 @end itemize
19885
19886 @noindent
19887 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
19888 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
19889 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
19890 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
19891
19892 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
19893 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
19894 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
19895 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
19896 supported.
19897
19898 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
19899 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
19900 together with a floating point specifier.
19901 letters:
19902
19903 @itemize @bullet
19904 @item
19905 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
19906
19907 @item
19908 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
19909
19910 @item
19911 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
19912 @end itemize
19913
19914 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
19915 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
19916 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
19917
19918 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
19919 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
19920
19921 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
19922 @smallexample
19923 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
19924 @end smallexample
19925
19926 @end table
19927
19928 @node Python
19929 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
19930 @cindex python scripting
19931 @cindex scripting with python
19932
19933 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
19934 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
19935 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
19936
19937 @menu
19938 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
19939 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
19940 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
19941 @end menu
19942
19943 @node Python Commands
19944 @subsection Python Commands
19945 @cindex python commands
19946 @cindex commands to access python
19947
19948 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
19949 and one related setting:
19950
19951 @table @code
19952 @kindex python
19953 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
19954 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
19955
19956 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
19957 argument as a Python command. For example:
19958
19959 @smallexample
19960 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
19961 23
19962 @end smallexample
19963
19964 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
19965 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
19966 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
19967 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
19968 containing @code{end}. For example:
19969
19970 @smallexample
19971 (@value{GDBP}) python
19972 Type python script
19973 End with a line saying just "end".
19974 >print 23
19975 >end
19976 23
19977 @end smallexample
19978
19979 @kindex maint set python print-stack
19980 @item maint set python print-stack
19981 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
19982 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
19983 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
19984 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
19985 disabled.
19986 @end table
19987
19988 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
19989 interpreter:
19990
19991 @table @code
19992 @item source @file{script-name}
19993 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
19994 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
19995 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
19996
19997 @item python execfile ("script-name")
19998 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
19999 and thus is always available.
20000 @end table
20001
20002 @node Python API
20003 @subsection Python API
20004 @cindex python api
20005 @cindex programming in python
20006
20007 @cindex python stdout
20008 @cindex python pagination
20009 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
20010 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
20011 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
20012 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
20013 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
20014
20015 @menu
20016 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
20017 * Exception Handling::
20018 * Values From Inferior::
20019 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
20020 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
20021 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
20022 * Disabling Pretty-Printers:: Disabling broken printers.
20023 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
20024 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
20025 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
20026 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
20027 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
20028 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20029 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
20030 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
20031 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
20032 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
20033 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
20034 @end menu
20035
20036 @node Basic Python
20037 @subsubsection Basic Python
20038
20039 @cindex python functions
20040 @cindex python module
20041 @cindex gdb module
20042 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
20043 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
20044 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
20045 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
20046
20047 @findex gdb.execute
20048 @defun execute command [from_tty]
20049 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20050 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
20051 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
20052 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
20053
20054 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
20055 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
20056 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
20057 @end defun
20058
20059 @findex gdb.breakpoints
20060 @defun breakpoints
20061 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
20062 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
20063 @end defun
20064
20065 @findex gdb.parameter
20066 @defun parameter parameter
20067 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
20068 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
20069 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
20070 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
20071
20072 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
20073 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
20074 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
20075 @end defun
20076
20077 @findex gdb.history
20078 @defun history number
20079 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
20080 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
20081 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
20082 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
20083 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
20084 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
20085 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
20086 raised.
20087
20088 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
20089 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
20090 @end defun
20091
20092 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
20093 @defun parse_and_eval expression
20094 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
20095 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20096 @var{expression} must be a string.
20097
20098 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
20099 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
20100 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
20101 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
20102 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20103 @end defun
20104
20105 @findex gdb.write
20106 @defun write string
20107 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
20108 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20109 call this function.
20110 @end defun
20111
20112 @findex gdb.flush
20113 @defun flush
20114 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
20115 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
20116 function.
20117 @end defun
20118
20119 @findex gdb.target_charset
20120 @defun target_charset
20121 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
20122 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
20123 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
20124 @end defun
20125
20126 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
20127 @defun target_wide_charset
20128 Return the name of the current target wide character set
20129 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
20130 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
20131 never returned.
20132 @end defun
20133
20134 @node Exception Handling
20135 @subsubsection Exception Handling
20136 @cindex python exceptions
20137 @cindex exceptions, python
20138
20139 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
20140 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
20141 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
20142 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
20143 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
20144 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
20145 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
20146
20147 @smallexample
20148 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
20149 Traceback (most recent call last):
20150 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
20151 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
20152 @end smallexample
20153
20154 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
20155 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
20156 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
20157 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
20158 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
20159 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
20160 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
20161 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
20162 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
20163 traceback.
20164
20165 @findex gdb.GdbError
20166 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
20167 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
20168 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
20169 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
20170 to handle this case. Example:
20171
20172 @smallexample
20173 (gdb) python
20174 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20175 > """Greet the whole world."""
20176 > def __init__ (self):
20177 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20178 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
20179 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
20180 > if len (argv) != 0:
20181 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
20182 > print "Hello, World!"
20183 >HelloWorld ()
20184 >end
20185 (gdb) hello-world 42
20186 hello-world takes no arguments
20187 @end smallexample
20188
20189 @node Values From Inferior
20190 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
20191 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
20192 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
20193
20194 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
20195 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
20196 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
20197 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
20198 fetching values when necessary.
20199
20200 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
20201 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
20202 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
20203
20204 @smallexample
20205 bar = some_val + 2
20206 @end smallexample
20207
20208 @noindent
20209 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
20210 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
20211
20212 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
20213 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
20214 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
20215 can access its @code{foo} element with:
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 bar = some_val['foo']
20219 @end smallexample
20220
20221 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
20222
20223 The following attributes are provided:
20224
20225 @table @code
20226 @defivar Value address
20227 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
20228 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
20229 this attribute holds @code{None}.
20230 @end defivar
20231
20232 @cindex optimized out value in Python
20233 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
20234 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
20235 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
20236 @end defivar
20237
20238 @defivar Value type
20239 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
20240 @code{gdb.Type} object.
20241 @end defivar
20242 @end table
20243
20244 The following methods are provided:
20245
20246 @table @code
20247 @defmethod Value cast type
20248 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
20249 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
20250 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
20251 reason, this method throws an exception.
20252 @end defmethod
20253
20254 @defmethod Value dereference
20255 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
20256 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
20257 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
20258
20259 @smallexample
20260 int *foo;
20261 @end smallexample
20262
20263 @noindent
20264 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
20265 @code{foo} points to like this:
20266
20267 @smallexample
20268 bar = foo.dereference ()
20269 @end smallexample
20270
20271 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
20272 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
20273 @end defmethod
20274
20275 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
20276 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
20277 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
20278 throw an exception.
20279
20280 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
20281 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
20282 language.
20283
20284 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
20285 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
20286 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
20287 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
20288 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
20289
20290 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
20291 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
20292 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
20293 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
20294 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
20295 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
20296 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
20297 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
20298 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
20299
20300 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
20301 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
20302
20303 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
20304 fetched and converted to the given length.
20305 @end defmethod
20306
20307 @defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
20308 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
20309 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
20310 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
20311
20312 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
20313 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
20314 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
20315 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
20316 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
20317
20318 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
20319 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
20320 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
20321 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
20322 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
20323 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
20324
20325 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
20326 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
20327 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
20328 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
20329 @end defmethod
20330 @end table
20331
20332 @node Types In Python
20333 @subsubsection Types In Python
20334 @cindex types in Python
20335 @cindex Python, working with types
20336
20337 @tindex gdb.Type
20338 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
20339 @code{gdb.Type}.
20340
20341 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
20342 module:
20343
20344 @findex gdb.lookup_type
20345 @defun lookup_type name [block]
20346 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
20347 type to look up. It must be a string.
20348
20349 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
20350 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
20351
20352 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
20353 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
20354 @end defun
20355
20356 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
20357
20358 @table @code
20359 @defivar Type code
20360 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
20361 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
20362 @end defivar
20363
20364 @defivar Type sizeof
20365 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
20366 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
20367 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
20368 @end defivar
20369
20370 @defivar Type tag
20371 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
20372 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
20373 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
20374 @code{None} is returned.
20375 @end defivar
20376 @end table
20377
20378 The following methods are provided:
20379
20380 @table @code
20381 @defmethod Type fields
20382 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
20383 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
20384 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
20385 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
20386 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
20387 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
20388
20389 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
20390 @table @code
20391 @item bitpos
20392 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
20393 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
20394 position of the field.
20395
20396 @item name
20397 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
20398
20399 @item artificial
20400 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
20401 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
20402 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
20403
20404 @item is_base_class
20405 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
20406 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
20407 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
20408 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
20409
20410 @item bitsize
20411 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
20412 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
20413 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
20414
20415 @item type
20416 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
20417 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
20418 @end table
20419 @end defmethod
20420
20421 @defmethod Type const
20422 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
20423 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
20424 @end defmethod
20425
20426 @defmethod Type volatile
20427 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
20428 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
20429 @end defmethod
20430
20431 @defmethod Type unqualified
20432 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
20433 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
20434 @code{volatile}.
20435 @end defmethod
20436
20437 @defmethod Type range
20438 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
20439 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
20440 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
20441 @code{RuntimeError} exception.
20442 @end defmethod
20443
20444 @defmethod Type reference
20445 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
20446 type.
20447 @end defmethod
20448
20449 @defmethod Type pointer
20450 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
20451 type.
20452 @end defmethod
20453
20454 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
20455 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
20456 after removing all layers of typedefs.
20457 @end defmethod
20458
20459 @defmethod Type target
20460 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
20461 of this type.
20462
20463 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
20464 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
20465 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
20466 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
20467 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
20468 target type is the aliased type.
20469
20470 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
20471 exception.
20472 @end defmethod
20473
20474 @defmethod Type template_argument n [block]
20475 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
20476 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
20477 @var{n}th template argument.
20478
20479 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
20480 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
20481
20482 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
20483 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
20484 @end defmethod
20485 @end table
20486
20487
20488 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
20489 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
20490 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20491
20492 @table @code
20493 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
20494 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
20495 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
20496 The type is a pointer.
20497
20498 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
20499 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
20500 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
20501 The type is an array.
20502
20503 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
20504 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
20505 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
20506 The type is a structure.
20507
20508 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
20509 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
20510 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
20511 The type is a union.
20512
20513 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
20514 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
20515 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
20516 The type is an enum.
20517
20518 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
20519 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
20520 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
20521 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
20522
20523 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
20524 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
20525 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
20526 The type is a function.
20527
20528 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
20529 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
20530 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
20531 The type is an integer type.
20532
20533 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
20534 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
20535 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
20536 A floating point type.
20537
20538 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
20539 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
20540 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
20541 The special type @code{void}.
20542
20543 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
20544 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
20545 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
20546 A Pascal set type.
20547
20548 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
20549 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
20550 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
20551 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
20552
20553 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
20554 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
20555 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
20556 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
20557 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
20558
20559 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
20560 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
20561 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
20562 A string of bits.
20563
20564 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
20565 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
20566 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
20567 An unknown or erroneous type.
20568
20569 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
20570 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
20571 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
20572 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
20573
20574 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
20575 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
20576 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
20577 A pointer-to-member-function.
20578
20579 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
20580 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
20581 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
20582 A pointer-to-member.
20583
20584 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
20585 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
20586 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
20587 A reference type.
20588
20589 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
20590 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
20591 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
20592 A character type.
20593
20594 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
20595 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
20596 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
20597 A boolean type.
20598
20599 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
20600 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
20601 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
20602 A complex float type.
20603
20604 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
20605 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
20606 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
20607 A typedef to some other type.
20608
20609 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
20610 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
20611 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
20612 A C@t{++} namespace.
20613
20614 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20615 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20616 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20617 A decimal floating point type.
20618
20619 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20620 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20621 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20622 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
20623 convenience functions.
20624 @end table
20625
20626 @node Pretty Printing API
20627 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
20628
20629 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
20630
20631 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
20632 specific interface, defined here.
20633
20634 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
20635 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
20636 children of the pretty-printer's value.
20637
20638 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
20639 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
20640 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
20641 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
20642 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
20643
20644 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
20645 as though the value has no children.
20646 @end defop
20647
20648 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
20649 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
20650 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
20651 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
20652 printed.
20653
20654 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
20655 string.
20656
20657 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
20658
20659 @table @samp
20660 @item array
20661 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
20662 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
20663 @code{set print array}.
20664
20665 @item map
20666 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
20667 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
20668 values.
20669
20670 @item string
20671 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
20672 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
20673 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
20674 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
20675 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
20676 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
20677 @end table
20678 @end defop
20679
20680 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
20681 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
20682 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
20683
20684 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
20685 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
20686 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
20687 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
20688 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
20689 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
20690 the result of @code{children}.
20691
20692 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
20693
20694 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
20695 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
20696 another pretty-printer.
20697
20698 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
20699 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
20700 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
20701 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
20702 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
20703
20704 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
20705 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
20706
20707 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
20708 @end defop
20709
20710 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
20711 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
20712
20713 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
20714 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
20715 as a pretty-printer.
20716 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
20717 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
20718 attribute.
20719
20720 A function on one of these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
20721 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
20722 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
20723 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
20724 @code{None}.
20725
20726 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
20727 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
20728 each enabled function (@pxref{Disabling Pretty-Printers})
20729 in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile} until it receives
20730 a pretty-printer object.
20731 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
20732 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
20733 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
20734 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
20735 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
20736 object is returned.
20737
20738 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
20739 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
20740 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
20741 object is returned.
20742
20743 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
20744 written:
20745
20746 @smallexample
20747 class StdStringPrinter:
20748 "Print a std::string"
20749
20750 def __init__ (self, val):
20751 self.val = val
20752
20753 def to_string (self):
20754 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
20755
20756 def display_hint (self):
20757 return 'string'
20758 @end smallexample
20759
20760 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
20761 example above might be written.
20762
20763 @smallexample
20764 def str_lookup_function (val):
20765
20766 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
20767 regex = re.compile ("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
20768 if lookup_tag == None:
20769 return None
20770 if regex.match (lookup_tag):
20771 return StdStringPrinter (val)
20772
20773 return None
20774 @end smallexample
20775
20776 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
20777 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
20778 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
20779 returns @code{None}.
20780
20781 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
20782 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
20783 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
20784 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
20785 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
20786 different names.
20787
20788 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
20789 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
20790 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
20791 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
20792 the current objfile.
20793
20794 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
20795 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
20796 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
20797 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
20798 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
20799 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
20800 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
20801 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
20802 inferior.
20803
20804 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
20805 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
20806
20807 @smallexample
20808 def register_printers (objfile):
20809 objfile.pretty_printers.add (str_lookup_function)
20810 @end smallexample
20811
20812 @noindent
20813 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
20814
20815 @smallexample
20816 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
20817 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers (gdb.current_objfile ())
20818 @end smallexample
20819
20820 @node Disabling Pretty-Printers
20821 @subsubsection Disabling Pretty-Printers
20822 @cindex disabling pretty-printers
20823
20824 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
20825 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
20826 the pretty-printer is out of date.
20827
20828 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
20829 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
20830 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
20831 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
20832 with a broken printer.
20833
20834 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
20835 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
20836 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
20837 the printer is enabled.
20838
20839 @node Commands In Python
20840 @subsubsection Commands In Python
20841
20842 @cindex commands in python
20843 @cindex python commands
20844 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
20845 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
20846 class, most commonly using a subclass.
20847
20848 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
20849 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
20850 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
20851 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
20852
20853 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
20854 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
20855 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
20856 an exception is raised.
20857
20858 There is no support for multi-line commands.
20859
20860 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
20861 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
20862 new command in the help system.
20863
20864 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
20865 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
20866 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
20867 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
20868 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
20869 error will occur when completion is attempted.
20870
20871 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
20872 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
20873 registered.
20874
20875 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
20876 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
20877 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
20878 not documented.'' is used.
20879 @end defmethod
20880
20881 @cindex don't repeat Python command
20882 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
20883 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
20884 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
20885 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
20886 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
20887 @end defmethod
20888
20889 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
20890 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
20891
20892 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
20893 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
20894
20895 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
20896 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
20897 that the command came from elsewhere.
20898
20899 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
20900 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
20901
20902 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
20903 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
20904 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
20905 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
20906 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
20907 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
20908 Example:
20909
20910 @smallexample
20911 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
20912 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
20913 @end smallexample
20914
20915 @end defmethod
20916
20917 @cindex completion of Python commands
20918 @defmethod Command complete text word
20919 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
20920 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
20921 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
20922 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
20923 complete}).
20924
20925 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
20926 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
20927 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
20928 using a word-breaking heuristic.
20929
20930 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
20931 @itemize @bullet
20932 @item
20933 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
20934 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
20935 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
20936 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
20937 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
20938 sequence are ignored.
20939
20940 @item
20941 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
20942 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
20943 function is invoked, and its result is used.
20944
20945 @item
20946 All other results are treated as though there were no available
20947 completions.
20948 @end itemize
20949 @end defmethod
20950
20951 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
20952 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
20953 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
20954 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
20955 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
20956 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20957
20958 @table @code
20959 @findex COMMAND_NONE
20960 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
20961 @item COMMAND_NONE
20962 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
20963 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
20964
20965 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
20966 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
20967 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
20968 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
20969 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
20970 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20971 commands in this category.
20972
20973 @findex COMMAND_DATA
20974 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
20975 @item COMMAND_DATA
20976 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
20977 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
20978 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
20979 in this category.
20980
20981 @findex COMMAND_STACK
20982 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
20983 @item COMMAND_STACK
20984 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
20985 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
20986 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
20987 list of commands in this category.
20988
20989 @findex COMMAND_FILES
20990 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
20991 @item COMMAND_FILES
20992 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
20993 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
20994 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20995 commands in this category.
20996
20997 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
20998 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
20999 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
21000 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
21001 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
21002 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
21003 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
21004 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
21005 commands in this category.
21006
21007 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
21008 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
21009 @item COMMAND_STATUS
21010 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
21011 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
21012 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
21013 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
21014
21015 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
21016 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
21017 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
21018 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
21019 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
21020 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
21021 this category.
21022
21023 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
21024 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
21025 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
21026 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
21027 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
21028 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
21029 commands in this category.
21030
21031 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
21032 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
21033 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
21034 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
21035 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
21036 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
21037 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
21038 category.
21039
21040 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
21041 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
21042 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
21043 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
21044 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
21045 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
21046 commands in this category.
21047 @end table
21048
21049 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
21050 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
21051 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
21052 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
21053
21054 @table @code
21055 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
21056 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
21057 @item COMPLETE_NONE
21058 This constant means that no completion should be done.
21059
21060 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
21061 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
21062 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
21063 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
21064
21065 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
21066 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
21067 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
21068 This constant means that location completion should be done.
21069 @xref{Specify Location}.
21070
21071 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
21072 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
21073 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
21074 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
21075 command names.
21076
21077 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
21078 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
21079 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
21080 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
21081 as the source.
21082 @end table
21083
21084 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
21085 implemented in Python:
21086
21087 @smallexample
21088 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
21089 """Greet the whole world."""
21090
21091 def __init__ (self):
21092 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
21093
21094 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
21095 print "Hello, World!"
21096
21097 HelloWorld ()
21098 @end smallexample
21099
21100 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
21101 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
21102 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
21103 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
21104
21105 @node Parameters In Python
21106 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
21107
21108 @cindex parameters in python
21109 @cindex python parameters
21110 @tindex gdb.Parameter
21111 @tindex Parameter
21112 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
21113 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
21114 class.
21115
21116 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
21117 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
21118
21119 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
21120 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
21121 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
21122 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
21123 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
21124
21125 @defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]}
21126 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
21127 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
21128 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
21129
21130 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
21131 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
21132 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
21133 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
21134 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
21135 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
21136 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
21137
21138 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
21139 can be found, an exception is raised.
21140
21141 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
21142 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
21143 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
21144
21145 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
21146 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
21147 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
21148 completion.
21149
21150 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
21151 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
21152 represent the possible values for the parameter.
21153
21154 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
21155 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
21156
21157 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
21158 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
21159 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
21160 @end defmethod
21161
21162 @defivar Parameter set_doc
21163 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
21164 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
21165 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
21166 have no effect.
21167 @end defivar
21168
21169 @defivar Parameter show_doc
21170 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
21171 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
21172 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
21173 have no effect.
21174 @end defivar
21175
21176 @defivar Parameter value
21177 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
21178 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
21179 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
21180 @end defivar
21181
21182
21183 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
21184 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
21185 module:
21186
21187 @table @code
21188 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
21189 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
21190 @item PARAM_BOOLEAN
21191 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
21192 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
21193
21194 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
21195 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
21196 @item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
21197 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
21198 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
21199 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
21200
21201 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
21202 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
21203 @item PARAM_UINTEGER
21204 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
21205 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
21206
21207 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
21208 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
21209 @item PARAM_INTEGER
21210 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
21211 to mean ``unlimited''.
21212
21213 @findex PARAM_STRING
21214 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
21215 @item PARAM_STRING
21216 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
21217 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
21218 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
21219 host charset.
21220
21221 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
21222 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
21223 @item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
21224 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
21225 passed through untranslated.
21226
21227 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
21228 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
21229 @item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
21230 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
21231
21232 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
21233 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
21234 @item PARAM_FILENAME
21235 The value is a filename. This is just like
21236 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
21237
21238 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
21239 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
21240 @item PARAM_ZINTEGER
21241 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
21242 is interpreted as itself.
21243
21244 @findex PARAM_ENUM
21245 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
21246 @item PARAM_ENUM
21247 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
21248 constants provided when the parameter is created.
21249 @end table
21250
21251 @node Functions In Python
21252 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
21253
21254 @cindex writing convenience functions
21255 @cindex convenience functions in python
21256 @cindex python convenience functions
21257 @tindex gdb.Function
21258 @tindex Function
21259 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
21260 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
21261 class @code{gdb.Function}.
21262
21263 @defmethod Function __init__ name
21264 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
21265 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
21266 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
21267 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
21268 the given @var{name}.
21269
21270 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
21271 string for the new class.
21272 @end defmethod
21273
21274 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
21275 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
21276 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
21277 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
21278 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
21279 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
21280 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
21281 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
21282
21283 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
21284 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
21285 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
21286 @end defmethod
21287
21288 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
21289 be implemented in Python:
21290
21291 @smallexample
21292 class Greet (gdb.Function):
21293 """Return string to greet someone.
21294 Takes a name as argument."""
21295
21296 def __init__ (self):
21297 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
21298
21299 def invoke (self, name):
21300 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
21301
21302 Greet ()
21303 @end smallexample
21304
21305 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
21306 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
21307 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
21308 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
21309
21310 @node Progspaces In Python
21311 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
21312
21313 @cindex progspaces in python
21314 @tindex gdb.Progspace
21315 @tindex Progspace
21316 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
21317 of an address space.
21318 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
21319 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
21320 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
21321 about program spaces.
21322
21323 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
21324 @code{gdb} module:
21325
21326 @findex gdb.current_progspace
21327 @defun current_progspace
21328 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
21329 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
21330 @end defun
21331
21332 @findex gdb.progspaces
21333 @defun progspaces
21334 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
21335 @end defun
21336
21337 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
21338 class.
21339
21340 @defivar Progspace filename
21341 The file name of the progspace as a string.
21342 @end defivar
21343
21344 @defivar Progspace pretty_printers
21345 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
21346 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
21347 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
21348 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
21349 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
21350 information.
21351 @end defivar
21352
21353 @node Objfiles In Python
21354 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
21355
21356 @cindex objfiles in python
21357 @tindex gdb.Objfile
21358 @tindex Objfile
21359 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
21360 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
21361 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
21362 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
21363 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
21364
21365 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
21366 @code{gdb} module:
21367
21368 @findex gdb.current_objfile
21369 @defun current_objfile
21370 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
21371 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
21372 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
21373 this function returns @code{None}.
21374 @end defun
21375
21376 @findex gdb.objfiles
21377 @defun objfiles
21378 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
21379 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
21380 @end defun
21381
21382 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
21383 class.
21384
21385 @defivar Objfile filename
21386 The file name of the objfile as a string.
21387 @end defivar
21388
21389 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
21390 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
21391 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
21392 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
21393 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
21394 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
21395 information.
21396 @end defivar
21397
21398 @node Frames In Python
21399 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
21400
21401 @cindex frames in python
21402 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
21403 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
21404 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
21405 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
21406 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
21407 exception.
21408
21409 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
21410 operator, like:
21411
21412 @smallexample
21413 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
21414 True
21415 @end smallexample
21416
21417 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
21418
21419 @findex gdb.selected_frame
21420 @defun selected_frame
21421 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
21422 @end defun
21423
21424 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
21425 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
21426 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
21427 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
21428 @end defun
21429
21430 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
21431
21432 @table @code
21433 @defmethod Frame is_valid
21434 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
21435 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
21436 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
21437 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
21438 @end defmethod
21439
21440 @defmethod Frame name
21441 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
21442 obtained.
21443 @end defmethod
21444
21445 @defmethod Frame type
21446 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
21447 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
21448 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
21449 @end defmethod
21450
21451 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
21452 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
21453 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
21454 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
21455 function to a string.
21456 @end defmethod
21457
21458 @defmethod Frame pc
21459 Returns the frame's resume address.
21460 @end defmethod
21461
21462 @defmethod Frame block
21463 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
21464 @end defmethod
21465
21466 @defmethod Frame function
21467 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
21468 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
21469 @end defmethod
21470
21471 @defmethod Frame older
21472 Return the frame that called this frame.
21473 @end defmethod
21474
21475 @defmethod Frame newer
21476 Return the frame called by this frame.
21477 @end defmethod
21478
21479 @defmethod Frame find_sal
21480 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
21481 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
21482 @end defmethod
21483
21484 @defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]}
21485 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
21486 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
21487 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
21488 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
21489 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
21490 @code{gdb.Block} object.
21491 @end defmethod
21492
21493 @defmethod Frame select
21494 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
21495 Stack}.
21496 @end defmethod
21497 @end table
21498
21499 @node Blocks In Python
21500 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
21501
21502 @cindex blocks in python
21503 @tindex gdb.Block
21504
21505 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
21506 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
21507 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
21508 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
21509 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
21510 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
21511 stack.
21512
21513 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21514 module:
21515
21516 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
21517 @defun block_for_pc pc
21518 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
21519 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
21520 will return @code{None}.
21521 @end defun
21522
21523 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
21524
21525 @table @code
21526 @defivar Block start
21527 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
21528 @end defivar
21529
21530 @defivar Block end
21531 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
21532 @end defivar
21533
21534 @defivar Block function
21535 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
21536 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
21537 attribute is not writable.
21538 @end defivar
21539
21540 @defivar Block superblock
21541 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
21542 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
21543 @end defivar
21544 @end table
21545
21546 @node Symbols In Python
21547 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
21548
21549 @cindex symbols in python
21550 @tindex gdb.Symbol
21551
21552 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
21553 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
21554 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
21555 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
21556
21557 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21558 module:
21559
21560 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
21561 @defun lookup_symbol name [block] [domain]
21562 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
21563 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
21564 arguments.
21565
21566 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
21567 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
21568 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
21569 @code{gdb.Block} object. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
21570 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
21571 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
21572 in this chapter.
21573 @end defun
21574
21575 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
21576
21577 @table @code
21578 @defivar Symbol symtab
21579 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
21580 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
21581 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
21582 @end defivar
21583
21584 @defivar Symbol name
21585 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
21586 @end defivar
21587
21588 @defivar Symbol linkage_name
21589 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
21590 This attribute is not writable.
21591 @end defivar
21592
21593 @defivar Symbol print_name
21594 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
21595 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
21596 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
21597 @end defivar
21598
21599 @defivar Symbol addr_class
21600 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
21601 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
21602 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
21603 @end defivar
21604
21605 @defivar Symbol is_argument
21606 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
21607 @end defivar
21608
21609 @defivar Symbol is_constant
21610 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
21611 @end defivar
21612
21613 @defivar Symbol is_function
21614 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
21615 @end defivar
21616
21617 @defivar Symbol is_variable
21618 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
21619 @end defivar
21620 @end table
21621
21622 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
21623 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
21624
21625 @table @code
21626 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
21627 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
21628 @item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
21629 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
21630 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
21631 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
21632 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
21633 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
21634 @item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
21635 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
21636 type values.
21637 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
21638 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
21639 @item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
21640 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
21641 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
21642 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
21643 @item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
21644 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
21645 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
21646 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
21647 @item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
21648 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
21649 contains everything minus functions and types.
21650 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
21651 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
21652 @item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
21653 This domain contains all functions.
21654 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
21655 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
21656 @item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
21657 This domain contains all types.
21658 @end table
21659
21660 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
21661 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
21662
21663 @table @code
21664 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
21665 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
21666 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
21667 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
21668 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
21669 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
21670 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
21671 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
21672 Value is constant int.
21673 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
21674 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
21675 @item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
21676 Value is at a fixed address.
21677 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
21678 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
21679 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
21680 Value is in a register.
21681 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
21682 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
21683 @item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
21684 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
21685 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
21686 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
21687 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
21688 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
21689 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
21690 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
21691 offset, not the value itself.
21692 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
21693 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
21694 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
21695 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
21696 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
21697 itself.
21698 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
21699 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
21700 @item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
21701 Value is a local variable.
21702 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
21703 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
21704 @item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
21705 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
21706 have this class.
21707 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
21708 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
21709 @item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
21710 Value is a block.
21711 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
21712 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
21713 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
21714 Value is a byte-sequence.
21715 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
21716 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
21717 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
21718 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
21719 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
21720 referenced.
21721 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
21722 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
21723 @item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
21724 The value does not actually exist in the program.
21725 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
21726 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
21727 @item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
21728 The value's address is a computed location.
21729 @end table
21730
21731 @node Symbol Tables In Python
21732 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
21733
21734 @cindex symbol tables in python
21735 @tindex gdb.Symtab
21736 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
21737
21738 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
21739 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
21740 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
21741 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
21742 @xref{Frames In Python}.
21743
21744 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
21745 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
21746
21747 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
21748
21749 @table @code
21750 @defivar Symtab_and_line symtab
21751 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
21752 This attribute is not writable.
21753 @end defivar
21754
21755 @defivar Symtab_and_line pc
21756 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
21757 writable.
21758 @end defivar
21759
21760 @defivar Symtab_and_line line
21761 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
21762 attribute is not writable.
21763 @end defivar
21764 @end table
21765
21766 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
21767
21768 @table @code
21769 @defivar Symtab filename
21770 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
21771 @end defivar
21772
21773 @defivar Symtab objfile
21774 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
21775 This attribute is not writable.
21776 @end defivar
21777 @end table
21778
21779 The following methods are provided:
21780
21781 @table @code
21782 @defmethod Symtab fullname
21783 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
21784 @end defmethod
21785 @end table
21786
21787 @node Breakpoints In Python
21788 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
21789
21790 @cindex breakpoints in python
21791 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
21792
21793 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
21794 class.
21795
21796 @defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]}
21797 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
21798 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
21799 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
21800 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
21801 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
21802 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
21803 either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
21804 defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{wp_class}
21805 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
21806 defined as @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not
21807 provided, it is assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class.
21808 @end defmethod
21809
21810 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
21811 @code{gdb} module:
21812
21813 @table @code
21814 @findex WP_READ
21815 @findex gdb.WP_READ
21816 @item WP_READ
21817 Read only watchpoint.
21818
21819 @findex WP_WRITE
21820 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
21821 @item WP_WRITE
21822 Write only watchpoint.
21823
21824 @findex WP_ACCESS
21825 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
21826 @item WP_ACCESS
21827 Read/Write watchpoint.
21828 @end table
21829
21830 @defmethod Breakpoint is_valid
21831 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
21832 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
21833 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
21834 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
21835 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
21836 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
21837 @end defmethod
21838
21839 @defivar Breakpoint enabled
21840 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
21841 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
21842 @end defivar
21843
21844 @defivar Breakpoint silent
21845 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
21846 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
21847
21848 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
21849 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
21850 @code{silent} attribute.
21851 @end defivar
21852
21853 @defivar Breakpoint thread
21854 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
21855 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
21856 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
21857 @end defivar
21858
21859 @defivar Breakpoint task
21860 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
21861 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
21862 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
21863 is writable.
21864 @end defivar
21865
21866 @defivar Breakpoint ignore_count
21867 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
21868 This attribute is writable.
21869 @end defivar
21870
21871 @defivar Breakpoint number
21872 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
21873 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
21874 @end defivar
21875
21876 @defivar Breakpoint type
21877 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
21878 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
21879 writable.
21880 @end defivar
21881
21882 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
21883 module:
21884
21885 @table @code
21886 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
21887 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
21888 @item BP_BREAKPOINT
21889 Normal code breakpoint.
21890
21891 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
21892 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
21893 @item BP_WATCHPOINT
21894 Watchpoint breakpoint.
21895
21896 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
21897 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
21898 @item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
21899 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
21900
21901 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
21902 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
21903 @item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
21904 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
21905
21906 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
21907 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
21908 @item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
21909 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
21910 @end table
21911
21912 @defivar Breakpoint hit_count
21913 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
21914 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
21915 @end defivar
21916
21917 @defivar Breakpoint location
21918 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
21919 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
21920 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
21921 attribute is not writable.
21922 @end defivar
21923
21924 @defivar Breakpoint expression
21925 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
21926 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
21927 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
21928 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
21929 @end defivar
21930
21931 @defivar Breakpoint condition
21932 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
21933 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
21934 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
21935 @end defivar
21936
21937 @defivar Breakpoint commands
21938 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
21939 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
21940 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
21941 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
21942 @end defivar
21943
21944 @node Lazy Strings In Python
21945 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
21946
21947 @cindex lazy strings in python
21948 @tindex gdb.LazyString
21949
21950 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
21951 encoded until it is needed.
21952
21953 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
21954 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
21955 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
21956 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
21957 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
21958 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
21959 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
21960 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
21961 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
21962
21963 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
21964
21965 @defmethod LazyString value
21966 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
21967 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
21968 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
21969 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
21970 @end defmethod
21971
21972 @defivar LazyString address
21973 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
21974 writable.
21975 @end defivar
21976
21977 @defivar LazyString length
21978 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
21979 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
21980 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
21981 @end defivar
21982
21983 @defivar LazyString encoding
21984 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
21985 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
21986 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
21987 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
21988 is not writable.
21989 @end defivar
21990
21991 @defivar LazyString type
21992 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
21993 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
21994 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
21995 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
21996 writable.
21997 @end defivar
21998
21999 @node Auto-loading
22000 @subsection Auto-loading
22001 @cindex auto-loading, Python
22002
22003 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
22004 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
22005 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
22006 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
22007
22008 @menu
22009 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
22010 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
22011 * Which flavor to choose?::
22012 @end menu
22013
22014 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
22015 debugging commands and scripts.
22016
22017 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled.
22018
22019 @table @code
22020 @kindex maint set python auto-load
22021 @item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
22022 Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
22023
22024 @kindex maint show python auto-load
22025 @item maint show python auto-load
22026 Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
22027 @end table
22028
22029 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
22030 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
22031 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
22032 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
22033
22034 @node objfile-gdb.py file
22035 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
22036 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
22037
22038 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
22039 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
22040 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
22041 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
22042 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
22043 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
22044
22045 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
22046 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
22047 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
22048 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
22049
22050 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
22051 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
22052 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
22053 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
22054 is the object file's real name, as described above.
22055
22056 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
22057 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
22058 @var{objfile} is opened.
22059 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
22060 is evaluated more than once.
22061
22062 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
22063 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
22064 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
22065
22066 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
22067 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
22068 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
22069 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
22070
22071 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
22072 current directory and then along the source search path
22073 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
22074 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
22075 directory is not relevant to scripts.
22076
22077 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
22078 for example, this GCC macro:
22079
22080 @example
22081 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remote duplicates. */
22082 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
22083 asm("\
22084 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
22085 .byte 1\n\
22086 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
22087 .popsection \n\
22088 ");
22089 @end example
22090
22091 @noindent
22092 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
22093
22094 @example
22095 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
22096 @end example
22097
22098 The script name may include directories if desired.
22099
22100 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
22101 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
22102
22103 @node Which flavor to choose?
22104 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
22105
22106 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
22107 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
22108
22109 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
22110
22111 @itemize @bullet
22112 @item
22113 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
22114
22115 @item
22116 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
22117
22118 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
22119 in the source search path.
22120 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
22121 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
22122
22123 @item
22124 Doesn't require source code additions.
22125 @end itemize
22126
22127 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
22128
22129 @itemize @bullet
22130 @item
22131 Works with static linking.
22132
22133 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
22134 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
22135 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
22136 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
22137
22138 @item
22139 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
22140
22141 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
22142 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
22143
22144 @item
22145 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
22146
22147 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
22148 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
22149 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
22150 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
22151 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
22152 top of the source tree to the source search path.
22153 @end itemize
22154
22155 @node Interpreters
22156 @chapter Command Interpreters
22157 @cindex command interpreters
22158
22159 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
22160 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
22161 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
22162
22163 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
22164 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
22165 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
22166 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
22167
22168 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
22169 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
22170 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
22171 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
22172
22173 @table @code
22174 @item console
22175 @cindex console interpreter
22176 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
22177 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
22178 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
22179
22180 @item mi
22181 @cindex mi interpreter
22182 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
22183 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
22184 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
22185 Interface}.
22186
22187 @item mi2
22188 @cindex mi2 interpreter
22189 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
22190
22191 @item mi1
22192 @cindex mi1 interpreter
22193 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
22194
22195 @end table
22196
22197 @cindex invoke another interpreter
22198 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
22199 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
22200 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
22201 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
22202 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
22203 the IDE inoperable!
22204
22205 @kindex interpreter-exec
22206 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
22207 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
22208 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
22209 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
22210
22211 @smallexample
22212 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
22213 @end smallexample
22214
22215 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
22216 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
22217
22218 @node TUI
22219 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
22220 @cindex TUI
22221 @cindex Text User Interface
22222
22223 @menu
22224 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
22225 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
22226 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
22227 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
22228 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
22229 @end menu
22230
22231 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
22232 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
22233 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
22234 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
22235 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
22236 is available.
22237
22238 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
22239 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
22240 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
22241 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
22242 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
22243 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
22244
22245 @node TUI Overview
22246 @section TUI Overview
22247
22248 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
22249
22250 @table @emph
22251 @item command
22252 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
22253 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
22254 managed using readline.
22255
22256 @item source
22257 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
22258 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
22259
22260 @item assembly
22261 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
22262
22263 @item register
22264 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
22265 when their values change.
22266 @end table
22267
22268 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
22269 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
22270 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
22271 indicates the breakpoint type:
22272
22273 @table @code
22274 @item B
22275 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
22276
22277 @item b
22278 Breakpoint which was never hit.
22279
22280 @item H
22281 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
22282
22283 @item h
22284 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
22285 @end table
22286
22287 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
22288
22289 @table @code
22290 @item +
22291 Breakpoint is enabled.
22292
22293 @item -
22294 Breakpoint is disabled.
22295 @end table
22296
22297 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
22298 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
22299 changes.
22300
22301 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
22302 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
22303 layouts:
22304
22305 @itemize @bullet
22306 @item
22307 source only,
22308
22309 @item
22310 assembly only,
22311
22312 @item
22313 source and assembly,
22314
22315 @item
22316 source and registers, or
22317
22318 @item
22319 assembly and registers.
22320 @end itemize
22321
22322 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
22323
22324 @table @emph
22325 @item target
22326 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
22327 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22328
22329 @item process
22330 Gives the current process or thread number.
22331 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
22332
22333 @item function
22334 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
22335 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
22336 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
22337 the string @code{??} is displayed.
22338
22339 @item line
22340 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
22341 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
22342
22343 @item pc
22344 Indicates the current program counter address.
22345 @end table
22346
22347 @node TUI Keys
22348 @section TUI Key Bindings
22349 @cindex TUI key bindings
22350
22351 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
22352 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
22353 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
22354
22355 @table @kbd
22356 @kindex C-x C-a
22357 @item C-x C-a
22358 @kindex C-x a
22359 @itemx C-x a
22360 @kindex C-x A
22361 @itemx C-x A
22362 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
22363 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
22364 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
22365 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
22366 The screen is then refreshed.
22367
22368 @kindex C-x 1
22369 @item C-x 1
22370 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
22371 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
22372 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
22373
22374 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
22375
22376 @kindex C-x 2
22377 @item C-x 2
22378 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
22379 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
22380 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
22381 previous layout and the new one.
22382
22383 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
22384
22385 @kindex C-x o
22386 @item C-x o
22387 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
22388 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
22389 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
22390
22391 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
22392
22393 @kindex C-x s
22394 @item C-x s
22395 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
22396 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
22397 @end table
22398
22399 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
22400
22401 @table @asis
22402 @kindex PgUp
22403 @item @key{PgUp}
22404 Scroll the active window one page up.
22405
22406 @kindex PgDn
22407 @item @key{PgDn}
22408 Scroll the active window one page down.
22409
22410 @kindex Up
22411 @item @key{Up}
22412 Scroll the active window one line up.
22413
22414 @kindex Down
22415 @item @key{Down}
22416 Scroll the active window one line down.
22417
22418 @kindex Left
22419 @item @key{Left}
22420 Scroll the active window one column left.
22421
22422 @kindex Right
22423 @item @key{Right}
22424 Scroll the active window one column right.
22425
22426 @kindex C-L
22427 @item @kbd{C-L}
22428 Refresh the screen.
22429 @end table
22430
22431 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
22432 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
22433 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
22434 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
22435 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
22436
22437 @node TUI Single Key Mode
22438 @section TUI Single Key Mode
22439 @cindex TUI single key mode
22440
22441 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
22442 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
22443 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
22444
22445 @table @kbd
22446 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22447 @item c
22448 continue
22449
22450 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22451 @item d
22452 down
22453
22454 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22455 @item f
22456 finish
22457
22458 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22459 @item n
22460 next
22461
22462 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22463 @item q
22464 exit the SingleKey mode.
22465
22466 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22467 @item r
22468 run
22469
22470 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22471 @item s
22472 step
22473
22474 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22475 @item u
22476 up
22477
22478 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22479 @item v
22480 info locals
22481
22482 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22483 @item w
22484 where
22485 @end table
22486
22487 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
22488 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
22489 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
22490 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
22491 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
22492 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
22493
22494
22495 @node TUI Commands
22496 @section TUI-specific Commands
22497 @cindex TUI commands
22498
22499 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
22500 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
22501 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
22502 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
22503
22504 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
22505 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
22506 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
22507 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
22508 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
22509
22510 @table @code
22511 @item info win
22512 @kindex info win
22513 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
22514
22515 @item layout next
22516 @kindex layout
22517 Display the next layout.
22518
22519 @item layout prev
22520 Display the previous layout.
22521
22522 @item layout src
22523 Display the source window only.
22524
22525 @item layout asm
22526 Display the assembly window only.
22527
22528 @item layout split
22529 Display the source and assembly window.
22530
22531 @item layout regs
22532 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
22533
22534 @item focus next
22535 @kindex focus
22536 Make the next window active for scrolling.
22537
22538 @item focus prev
22539 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
22540
22541 @item focus src
22542 Make the source window active for scrolling.
22543
22544 @item focus asm
22545 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
22546
22547 @item focus regs
22548 Make the register window active for scrolling.
22549
22550 @item focus cmd
22551 Make the command window active for scrolling.
22552
22553 @item refresh
22554 @kindex refresh
22555 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
22556
22557 @item tui reg float
22558 @kindex tui reg
22559 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
22560
22561 @item tui reg general
22562 Show the general registers in the register window.
22563
22564 @item tui reg next
22565 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
22566 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
22567 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
22568 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
22569
22570 @item tui reg system
22571 Show the system registers in the register window.
22572
22573 @item update
22574 @kindex update
22575 Update the source window and the current execution point.
22576
22577 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
22578 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
22579 @kindex winheight
22580 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
22581 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
22582 decrease it.
22583
22584 @item tabset @var{nchars}
22585 @kindex tabset
22586 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
22587 @end table
22588
22589 @node TUI Configuration
22590 @section TUI Configuration Variables
22591 @cindex TUI configuration variables
22592
22593 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
22594
22595 @table @code
22596 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
22597 @kindex set tui border-kind
22598 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
22599 The possible values are the following:
22600 @table @code
22601 @item space
22602 Use a space character to draw the border.
22603
22604 @item ascii
22605 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
22606
22607 @item acs
22608 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
22609 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
22610 @end table
22611
22612 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
22613 @kindex set tui border-mode
22614 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
22615 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
22616 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
22617 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
22618 @table @code
22619 @item normal
22620 Use normal attributes to display the border.
22621
22622 @item standout
22623 Use standout mode.
22624
22625 @item reverse
22626 Use reverse video mode.
22627
22628 @item half
22629 Use half bright mode.
22630
22631 @item half-standout
22632 Use half bright and standout mode.
22633
22634 @item bold
22635 Use extra bright or bold mode.
22636
22637 @item bold-standout
22638 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
22639 @end table
22640 @end table
22641
22642 @node Emacs
22643 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
22644
22645 @cindex Emacs
22646 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
22647 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
22648 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
22649 @value{GDBN}.
22650
22651 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
22652 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
22653 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
22654 created Emacs buffer.
22655 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
22656
22657 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
22658 things:
22659
22660 @itemize @bullet
22661 @item
22662 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
22663 the GUD buffer.
22664
22665 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
22666 and output done by the program you are debugging.
22667
22668 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
22669 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
22670 in this way.
22671
22672 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
22673 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
22674 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
22675 stop.
22676
22677 @item
22678 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
22679
22680 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
22681 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
22682 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
22683 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
22684 and the source.
22685
22686 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
22687 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
22688 @end itemize
22689
22690 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
22691 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
22692 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
22693 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
22694
22695 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
22696 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
22697 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
22698 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
22699 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
22700 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
22701 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
22702 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
22703 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
22704
22705 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
22706 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
22707 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
22708 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22709
22710 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
22711 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
22712 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
22713 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
22714 one you want.
22715
22716 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
22717 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
22718
22719 @table @kbd
22720 @item C-h m
22721 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
22722
22723 @item C-c C-s
22724 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
22725 update the display window to show the current file and location.
22726
22727 @item C-c C-n
22728 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
22729 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
22730 to show the current file and location.
22731
22732 @item C-c C-i
22733 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
22734 display window accordingly.
22735
22736 @item C-c C-f
22737 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
22738 @code{finish} command.
22739
22740 @item C-c C-r
22741 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
22742 command.
22743
22744 @item C-c <
22745 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
22746 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
22747 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
22748
22749 @item C-c >
22750 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
22751 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
22752 @end table
22753
22754 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
22755 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
22756
22757 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
22758 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
22759 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
22760 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
22761 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
22762 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
22763 speedbar displays watch expressions.
22764
22765 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
22766 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
22767 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
22768 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
22769 frame.
22770
22771 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
22772 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
22773 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
22774 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
22775 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
22776 to correspond properly with the code.
22777
22778 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
22779 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
22780 Emacs Manual}).
22781
22782 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
22783 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
22784 @ignore
22785 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
22786 @kindex Epoch
22787 @kindex inspect
22788
22789 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
22790 called the @code{epoch}
22791 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
22792 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
22793 each value is printed in its own window.
22794 @end ignore
22795
22796
22797 @node GDB/MI
22798 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
22799
22800 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
22801
22802 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
22803 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
22804 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
22805 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
22806 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
22807 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
22808
22809 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
22810 in the form of a reference manual.
22811
22812 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
22813 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
22814 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
22815
22816 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
22817
22818 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
22819 This chapter uses the following notation:
22820
22821 @itemize @bullet
22822 @item
22823 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
22824
22825 @item
22826 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
22827 it may or may not be given.
22828
22829 @item
22830 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
22831 may repeat zero or more times.
22832
22833 @item
22834 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
22835 may repeat one or more times.
22836
22837 @item
22838 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
22839 @end itemize
22840
22841 @ignore
22842 @heading Dependencies
22843 @end ignore
22844
22845 @menu
22846 * GDB/MI General Design::
22847 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
22848 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
22849 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
22850 * GDB/MI Output Records::
22851 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
22852 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
22853 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
22854 * GDB/MI Program Context::
22855 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
22856 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
22857 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
22858 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
22859 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
22860 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
22861 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
22862 * GDB/MI File Commands::
22863 @ignore
22864 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
22865 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
22866 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
22867 @end ignore
22868 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
22869 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
22870 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
22871 @end menu
22872
22873 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22874 @node GDB/MI General Design
22875 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
22876 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
22877
22878 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
22879 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
22880 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
22881 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
22882 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
22883 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
22884 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
22885 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
22886 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
22887 a command and reported as part of that command response.
22888
22889 The important examples of notifications are:
22890 @itemize @bullet
22891
22892 @item
22893 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
22894 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
22895 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
22896 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
22897 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
22898 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
22899 command itself was successfully executed.
22900
22901 @item
22902 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
22903 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
22904 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
22905 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
22906 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
22907 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
22908
22909 @item
22910 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
22911 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
22912 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
22913 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
22914 orthogonal frontend design.
22915
22916 @end itemize
22917
22918 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
22919 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
22920 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
22921 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
22922 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
22923 the user interface.
22924
22925
22926 @menu
22927 * Context management::
22928 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
22929 * Thread groups::
22930 @end menu
22931
22932 @node Context management
22933 @subsection Context management
22934
22935 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
22936 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
22937 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
22938 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
22939 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
22940 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
22941 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
22942 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
22943 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
22944
22945 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
22946 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
22947 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
22948 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
22949 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
22950 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
22951 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
22952 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
22953 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
22954 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
22955 for thread and frame to operate on.
22956
22957 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
22958 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
22959 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
22960 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
22961 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
22962 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
22963 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
22964 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
22965 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
22966 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
22967
22968 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
22969 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
22970 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
22971 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
22972 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
22973 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
22974 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
22975 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
22976 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
22977 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
22978 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
22979 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
22980 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
22981 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
22982 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
22983 @samp{--frame} options.
22984
22985 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
22986 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
22987
22988 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
22989 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
22990 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
22991 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
22992 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
22993 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
22994 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
22995 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
22996 @code{-list-target-features} command.
22997
22998 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
22999 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
23000 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
23001 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
23002 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
23003 are running.
23004
23005 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
23006 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
23007 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
23008 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
23009 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
23010 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
23011 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
23012 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
23013 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
23014 @samp{--thread} option).
23015
23016 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
23017 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
23018 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
23019 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
23020
23021 @node Thread groups
23022 @subsection Thread groups
23023 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
23024 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
23025 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
23026 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
23027 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
23028
23029 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
23030 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
23031 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
23032 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
23033 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
23034 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
23035 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
23036 into processes.
23037
23038 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
23039 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
23040 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
23041 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
23042 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
23043 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
23044 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
23045 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
23046 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
23047 the members of specific thread group.
23048
23049 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
23050 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
23051 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
23052 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
23053 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
23054 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
23055 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
23056 after attaching to that thread group.
23057
23058 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
23059 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
23060 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
23061 such thread groups.
23062
23063 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23064 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
23065 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
23066
23067 @menu
23068 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
23069 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
23070 @end menu
23071
23072 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
23073 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
23074
23075 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
23076 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
23077 @table @code
23078 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
23079 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
23080
23081 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
23082 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
23083 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
23084
23085 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
23086 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
23087 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
23088
23089 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
23090 "any sequence of digits"
23091
23092 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
23093 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
23094
23095 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
23096 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
23097
23098 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
23099 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
23100
23101 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
23102 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
23103 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
23104
23105 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
23106 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
23107
23108 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
23109 @code{CR | CR-LF}
23110 @end table
23111
23112 @noindent
23113 Notes:
23114
23115 @itemize @bullet
23116 @item
23117 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
23118 output is described below.
23119
23120 @item
23121 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
23122 finishes.
23123
23124 @item
23125 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
23126 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
23127 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
23128 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
23129 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
23130 @end itemize
23131
23132 Pragmatics:
23133
23134 @itemize @bullet
23135 @item
23136 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
23137
23138 @item
23139 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
23140 @end itemize
23141
23142 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
23143 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
23144
23145 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
23146 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
23147 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
23148 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
23149 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
23150 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
23151
23152 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
23153 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
23154 @var{token}.
23155
23156 @table @code
23157 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
23158 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
23159
23160 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
23161 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
23162
23163 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
23164 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
23165
23166 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
23167 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
23168
23169 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
23170 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
23171
23172 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
23173 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
23174
23175 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
23176 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
23177
23178 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
23179 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
23180
23181 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
23182 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
23183
23184 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
23185 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
23186 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
23187
23188 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
23189 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
23190
23191 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
23192 @code{ @var{string} }
23193
23194 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
23195 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
23196
23197 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
23198 @code{@var{c-string}}
23199
23200 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
23201 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
23202
23203 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
23204 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
23205 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
23206
23207 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
23208 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
23209
23210 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
23211 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
23212
23213 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
23214 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
23215
23216 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
23217 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
23218
23219 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
23220 @code{CR | CR-LF}
23221
23222 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
23223 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
23224 @end table
23225
23226 @noindent
23227 Notes:
23228
23229 @itemize @bullet
23230 @item
23231 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
23232
23233 @item
23234 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
23235 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
23236 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
23237 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
23238 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
23239 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
23240 prior command.
23241
23242 @item
23243 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23244 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
23245 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
23246 prefixed by @samp{+}.
23247
23248 @item
23249 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23250 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
23251 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
23252 @samp{*}.
23253
23254 @item
23255 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23256 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
23257 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
23258 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
23259
23260 @item
23261 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23262 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
23263 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
23264 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
23265
23266 @item
23267 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23268 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
23269 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
23270
23271 @item
23272 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23273 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
23274 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
23275 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
23276
23277 @item
23278 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23279 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
23280 @var{values}.
23281
23282
23283 @end itemize
23284
23285 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
23286 details about the various output records.
23287
23288 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23289 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
23290 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
23291
23292 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
23293 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
23294
23295 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
23296 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
23297 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
23298 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
23299 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
23300 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
23301
23302 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
23303 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
23304 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
23305
23306 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23307 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
23308 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
23309 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
23310
23311 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
23312 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
23313
23314 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
23315 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
23316 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
23317 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
23318 might change.
23319
23320 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
23321 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
23322 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
23323 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
23324
23325 @itemize @bullet
23326 @item
23327 New MI commands may be added.
23328
23329 @item
23330 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
23331
23332 @item
23333 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
23334 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
23335
23336 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
23337 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
23338
23339 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
23340 @c resolve inconsistencies.
23341 @end itemize
23342
23343 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
23344 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
23345 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
23346 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
23347 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
23348
23349 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
23350 @c version?
23351
23352 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
23353 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
23354 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
23355 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
23356 @cindex mailing lists
23357
23358 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23359 @node GDB/MI Output Records
23360 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
23361
23362 @menu
23363 * GDB/MI Result Records::
23364 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
23365 * GDB/MI Async Records::
23366 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
23367 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
23368 @end menu
23369
23370 @node GDB/MI Result Records
23371 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
23372
23373 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
23374 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
23375 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
23376 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
23377
23378 @table @code
23379 @findex ^done
23380 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
23381 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
23382 values.
23383
23384 @item "^running"
23385 @findex ^running
23386 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
23387 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
23388 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
23389 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
23390 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
23391 which threads are resumed.
23392
23393 @item "^connected"
23394 @findex ^connected
23395 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
23396
23397 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
23398 @findex ^error
23399 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
23400 error message.
23401
23402 @item "^exit"
23403 @findex ^exit
23404 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
23405
23406 @end table
23407
23408 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
23409 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
23410
23411 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
23412 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
23413 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
23414 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
23415 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
23416
23417 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
23418 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
23419 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
23420 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
23421 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
23422
23423 @table @code
23424 @item "~" @var{string-output}
23425 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
23426 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
23427
23428 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
23429 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
23430 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
23431 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
23432
23433 @item "&" @var{string-output}
23434 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
23435 internals.
23436 @end table
23437
23438 @node GDB/MI Async Records
23439 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
23440
23441 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
23442 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
23443 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
23444 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
23445 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
23446 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
23447
23448 The following is the list of possible async records:
23449
23450 @table @code
23451
23452 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
23453 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
23454 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
23455 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
23456 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
23457 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
23458 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
23459 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
23460 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
23461 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
23462
23463 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
23464 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
23465 following values:
23466
23467 @table @code
23468 @item breakpoint-hit
23469 A breakpoint was reached.
23470 @item watchpoint-trigger
23471 A watchpoint was triggered.
23472 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
23473 A read watchpoint was triggered.
23474 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
23475 An access watchpoint was triggered.
23476 @item function-finished
23477 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
23478 @item location-reached
23479 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
23480 @item watchpoint-scope
23481 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
23482 @item end-stepping-range
23483 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
23484 similar CLI command was accomplished.
23485 @item exited-signalled
23486 The inferior exited because of a signal.
23487 @item exited
23488 The inferior exited.
23489 @item exited-normally
23490 The inferior exited normally.
23491 @item signal-received
23492 A signal was received by the inferior.
23493 @end table
23494
23495 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
23496 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
23497 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
23498 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
23499 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
23500 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
23501 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
23502 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
23503 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
23504 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
23505 if such information is not available.
23506
23507 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
23508 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
23509 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
23510 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
23511 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
23512 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
23513 cannot be used in any way.
23514
23515 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
23516 A thread group became associated with a running program,
23517 either because the program was just started or the thread group
23518 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
23519 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
23520 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
23521
23522 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
23523 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
23524 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
23525 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
23526 thread group.
23527
23528 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
23529 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
23530 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
23531 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
23532 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
23533
23534 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
23535 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
23536 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
23537 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
23538 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
23539 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
23540 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
23541
23542 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
23543 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
23544 that thread.
23545
23546 @item =library-loaded,...
23547 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
23548 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
23549 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
23550 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
23551 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
23552 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
23553 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
23554 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
23555 library are loaded. The @var{thread-group} field, if present,
23556 specifies the id of the thread group in whose context the library was loaded.
23557 If the field is absent, it means the library was loaded in the context
23558 of all present thread groups.
23559
23560 @item =library-unloaded,...
23561 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
23562 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
23563 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
23564 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
23565 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
23566 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
23567 thread groups.
23568
23569 @end table
23570
23571 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
23572 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
23573
23574 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
23575 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
23576 fields:
23577
23578 @table @code
23579 @item level
23580 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
23581 zero. This field is always present.
23582
23583 @item func
23584 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
23585 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
23586
23587 @item addr
23588 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
23589
23590 @item file
23591 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
23592 address. This field may be absent.
23593
23594 @item line
23595 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
23596 may be absent.
23597
23598 @item from
23599 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
23600 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
23601
23602 @end table
23603
23604 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
23605 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
23606
23607 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
23608 uses a tuple with the following fields:
23609
23610 @table @code
23611 @item id
23612 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
23613 always present.
23614
23615 @item target-id
23616 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
23617
23618 @item details
23619 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
23620 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
23621 frontend. This field is optional.
23622
23623 @item state
23624 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
23625 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
23626
23627 @item core
23628 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
23629 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
23630 @end table
23631
23632
23633 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23634 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
23635 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
23636 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
23637
23638 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
23639 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
23640 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
23641 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
23642
23643 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
23644 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
23645
23646 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
23647
23648 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
23649 information of the breakpoint.
23650
23651 @smallexample
23652 -> -break-insert main
23653 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
23654 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
23655 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
23656 <- (gdb)
23657 @end smallexample
23658
23659 @subheading Program Execution
23660
23661 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
23662 reason that execution stopped.
23663
23664 @smallexample
23665 -> -exec-run
23666 <- ^running
23667 <- (gdb)
23668 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
23669 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
23670 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
23671 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
23672 <- (gdb)
23673 -> -exec-continue
23674 <- ^running
23675 <- (gdb)
23676 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
23677 <- (gdb)
23678 @end smallexample
23679
23680 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
23681
23682 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
23683
23684 @smallexample
23685 -> (gdb)
23686 <- -gdb-exit
23687 <- ^exit
23688 @end smallexample
23689
23690 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
23691 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
23692 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
23693 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
23694 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
23695 fails to exit in reasonable time.
23696
23697 @subheading A Bad Command
23698
23699 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
23700
23701 @smallexample
23702 -> -rubbish
23703 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
23704 <- (gdb)
23705 @end smallexample
23706
23707
23708 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23709 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
23710 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
23711
23712 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
23713 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
23714
23715 @subheading Motivation
23716
23717 The motivation for this collection of commands.
23718
23719 @subheading Introduction
23720
23721 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
23722
23723 @subheading Commands
23724
23725 For each command in the block, the following is described:
23726
23727 @subsubheading Synopsis
23728
23729 @smallexample
23730 -command @var{args}@dots{}
23731 @end smallexample
23732
23733 @subsubheading Result
23734
23735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23736
23737 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
23738
23739 @subsubheading Example
23740
23741 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
23742 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
23743
23744
23745 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23746 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
23747 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
23748
23749 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
23750 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
23751 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
23752 breakpoints.
23753
23754 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
23755 @findex -break-after
23756
23757 @subsubheading Synopsis
23758
23759 @smallexample
23760 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
23761 @end smallexample
23762
23763 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
23764 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
23765 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
23766 @samp{-break-list} command below.
23767
23768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23769
23770 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
23771
23772 @subsubheading Example
23773
23774 @smallexample
23775 (gdb)
23776 -break-insert main
23777 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
23778 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
23779 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
23780 (gdb)
23781 -break-after 1 3
23782 ~
23783 ^done
23784 (gdb)
23785 -break-list
23786 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23787 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23788 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23789 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23790 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23791 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23792 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23793 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23794 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23795 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
23796 (gdb)
23797 @end smallexample
23798
23799 @ignore
23800 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
23801 @findex -break-catch
23802 @end ignore
23803
23804 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
23805 @findex -break-commands
23806
23807 @subsubheading Synopsis
23808
23809 @smallexample
23810 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
23811 @end smallexample
23812
23813 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
23814 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
23815 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
23816 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
23817 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
23818 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
23819
23820 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23821
23822 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
23823
23824 @subsubheading Example
23825
23826 @smallexample
23827 (gdb)
23828 -break-insert main
23829 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
23830 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
23831 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
23832 (gdb)
23833 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
23834 ^done
23835 (gdb)
23836 @end smallexample
23837
23838 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
23839 @findex -break-condition
23840
23841 @subsubheading Synopsis
23842
23843 @smallexample
23844 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
23845 @end smallexample
23846
23847 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
23848 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
23849 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
23850 command below).
23851
23852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23853
23854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
23855
23856 @subsubheading Example
23857
23858 @smallexample
23859 (gdb)
23860 -break-condition 1 1
23861 ^done
23862 (gdb)
23863 -break-list
23864 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23865 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23866 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23867 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23868 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23869 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23870 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23871 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23872 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23873 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
23874 (gdb)
23875 @end smallexample
23876
23877 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
23878 @findex -break-delete
23879
23880 @subsubheading Synopsis
23881
23882 @smallexample
23883 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
23884 @end smallexample
23885
23886 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
23887 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
23888
23889 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23890
23891 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
23892
23893 @subsubheading Example
23894
23895 @smallexample
23896 (gdb)
23897 -break-delete 1
23898 ^done
23899 (gdb)
23900 -break-list
23901 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
23902 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23903 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23904 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23905 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23906 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23907 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23908 body=[]@}
23909 (gdb)
23910 @end smallexample
23911
23912 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
23913 @findex -break-disable
23914
23915 @subsubheading Synopsis
23916
23917 @smallexample
23918 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
23919 @end smallexample
23920
23921 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
23922 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
23923
23924 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23925
23926 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
23927
23928 @subsubheading Example
23929
23930 @smallexample
23931 (gdb)
23932 -break-disable 2
23933 ^done
23934 (gdb)
23935 -break-list
23936 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23937 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23938 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23939 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23940 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23941 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23942 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23943 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
23944 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23945 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
23946 (gdb)
23947 @end smallexample
23948
23949 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
23950 @findex -break-enable
23951
23952 @subsubheading Synopsis
23953
23954 @smallexample
23955 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
23956 @end smallexample
23957
23958 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
23959
23960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23961
23962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
23963
23964 @subsubheading Example
23965
23966 @smallexample
23967 (gdb)
23968 -break-enable 2
23969 ^done
23970 (gdb)
23971 -break-list
23972 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23973 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23974 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23975 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23976 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23977 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23978 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23979 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23980 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23981 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
23982 (gdb)
23983 @end smallexample
23984
23985 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
23986 @findex -break-info
23987
23988 @subsubheading Synopsis
23989
23990 @smallexample
23991 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
23992 @end smallexample
23993
23994 @c REDUNDANT???
23995 Get information about a single breakpoint.
23996
23997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23998
23999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
24000
24001 @subsubheading Example
24002 N.A.
24003
24004 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
24005 @findex -break-insert
24006
24007 @subsubheading Synopsis
24008
24009 @smallexample
24010 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
24011 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
24012 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
24013 @end smallexample
24014
24015 @noindent
24016 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
24017
24018 @itemize @bullet
24019 @item function
24020 @c @item +offset
24021 @c @item -offset
24022 @c @item linenum
24023 @item filename:linenum
24024 @item filename:function
24025 @item *address
24026 @end itemize
24027
24028 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
24029
24030 @table @samp
24031 @item -t
24032 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
24033 @item -h
24034 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
24035 @item -c @var{condition}
24036 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
24037 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
24038 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
24039 @item -f
24040 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
24041 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
24042 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
24043 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
24044 cannot be parsed.
24045 @item -d
24046 Create a disabled breakpoint.
24047 @item -a
24048 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
24049 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
24050 @end table
24051
24052 @subsubheading Result
24053
24054 The result is in the form:
24055
24056 @smallexample
24057 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
24058 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
24059 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
24060 times="@var{times}"@}
24061 @end smallexample
24062
24063 @noindent
24064 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
24065 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
24066 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
24067 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
24068 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
24069 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
24070 which use the same output).
24071
24072 Note: this format is open to change.
24073 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
24074
24075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24076
24077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
24078 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
24079
24080 @subsubheading Example
24081
24082 @smallexample
24083 (gdb)
24084 -break-insert main
24085 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
24086 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
24087 (gdb)
24088 -break-insert -t foo
24089 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
24090 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
24091 (gdb)
24092 -break-list
24093 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
24094 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24095 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24096 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24097 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24098 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24099 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24100 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24101 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
24102 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
24103 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
24104 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
24105 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
24106 (gdb)
24107 -break-insert -r foo.*
24108 ~int foo(int, int);
24109 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
24110 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
24111 (gdb)
24112 @end smallexample
24113
24114 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
24115 @findex -break-list
24116
24117 @subsubheading Synopsis
24118
24119 @smallexample
24120 -break-list
24121 @end smallexample
24122
24123 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
24124
24125 @table @samp
24126 @item Number
24127 number of the breakpoint
24128 @item Type
24129 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
24130 @item Disposition
24131 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
24132 or @samp{nokeep}
24133 @item Enabled
24134 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
24135 @item Address
24136 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
24137 @item What
24138 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
24139 name, line number
24140 @item Times
24141 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
24142 @end table
24143
24144 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
24145 @code{body} field is an empty list.
24146
24147 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24148
24149 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
24150
24151 @subsubheading Example
24152
24153 @smallexample
24154 (gdb)
24155 -break-list
24156 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
24157 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24158 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24159 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24160 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24161 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24162 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24163 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24164 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
24165 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24166 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
24167 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
24168 (gdb)
24169 @end smallexample
24170
24171 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
24172
24173 @smallexample
24174 (gdb)
24175 -break-list
24176 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
24177 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24178 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24179 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24180 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24181 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24182 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24183 body=[]@}
24184 (gdb)
24185 @end smallexample
24186
24187 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
24188 @findex -break-passcount
24189
24190 @subsubheading Synopsis
24191
24192 @smallexample
24193 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
24194 @end smallexample
24195
24196 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
24197 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
24198 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
24199 command @samp{passcount}.
24200
24201 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
24202 @findex -break-watch
24203
24204 @subsubheading Synopsis
24205
24206 @smallexample
24207 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
24208 @end smallexample
24209
24210 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
24211 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
24212 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
24213 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
24214 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
24215 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
24216 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
24217 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
24218
24219 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
24220 breakpoints inserted.
24221
24222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24223
24224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
24225 @samp{rwatch}.
24226
24227 @subsubheading Example
24228
24229 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
24230
24231 @smallexample
24232 (gdb)
24233 -break-watch x
24234 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
24235 (gdb)
24236 -exec-continue
24237 ^running
24238 (gdb)
24239 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
24240 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
24241 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
24242 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
24243 (gdb)
24244 @end smallexample
24245
24246 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
24247 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
24248 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
24249
24250 @smallexample
24251 (gdb)
24252 -break-watch C
24253 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
24254 (gdb)
24255 -exec-continue
24256 ^running
24257 (gdb)
24258 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
24259 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
24260 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
24261 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24262 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
24263 (gdb)
24264 -exec-continue
24265 ^running
24266 (gdb)
24267 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
24268 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
24269 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
24270 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24271 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
24272 (gdb)
24273 @end smallexample
24274
24275 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
24276 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
24277 deleted.
24278
24279 @smallexample
24280 (gdb)
24281 -break-watch C
24282 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
24283 (gdb)
24284 -break-list
24285 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
24286 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24287 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24288 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24289 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24290 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24291 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24292 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24293 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
24294 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24295 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
24296 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
24297 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
24298 (gdb)
24299 -exec-continue
24300 ^running
24301 (gdb)
24302 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
24303 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
24304 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
24305 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24306 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
24307 (gdb)
24308 -break-list
24309 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
24310 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24311 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24312 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24313 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24314 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24315 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24316 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24317 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
24318 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24319 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
24320 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
24321 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
24322 (gdb)
24323 -exec-continue
24324 ^running
24325 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
24326 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
24327 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
24328 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24329 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
24330 (gdb)
24331 -break-list
24332 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
24333 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24334 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24335 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24336 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24337 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24338 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24339 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24340 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
24341 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24342 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
24343 times="1"@}]@}
24344 (gdb)
24345 @end smallexample
24346
24347 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24348 @node GDB/MI Program Context
24349 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
24350
24351 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
24352 @findex -exec-arguments
24353
24354
24355 @subsubheading Synopsis
24356
24357 @smallexample
24358 -exec-arguments @var{args}
24359 @end smallexample
24360
24361 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
24362 @samp{-exec-run}.
24363
24364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24365
24366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
24367
24368 @subsubheading Example
24369
24370 @smallexample
24371 (gdb)
24372 -exec-arguments -v word
24373 ^done
24374 (gdb)
24375 @end smallexample
24376
24377
24378 @ignore
24379 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
24380 @findex -exec-show-arguments
24381
24382 @subsubheading Synopsis
24383
24384 @smallexample
24385 -exec-show-arguments
24386 @end smallexample
24387
24388 Print the arguments of the program.
24389
24390 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24391
24392 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
24393
24394 @subsubheading Example
24395 N.A.
24396 @end ignore
24397
24398
24399 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
24400 @findex -environment-cd
24401
24402 @subsubheading Synopsis
24403
24404 @smallexample
24405 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
24406 @end smallexample
24407
24408 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
24409
24410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24411
24412 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
24413
24414 @subsubheading Example
24415
24416 @smallexample
24417 (gdb)
24418 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
24419 ^done
24420 (gdb)
24421 @end smallexample
24422
24423
24424 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
24425 @findex -environment-directory
24426
24427 @subsubheading Synopsis
24428
24429 @smallexample
24430 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
24431 @end smallexample
24432
24433 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
24434 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
24435 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
24436 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
24437 occurs as normal.
24438 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
24439 multiple directories in a single command
24440 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
24441 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
24442 If blanks are needed as
24443 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
24444 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
24445 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
24446 character must not be used
24447 in any directory name.
24448 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
24449
24450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24451
24452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
24453
24454 @subsubheading Example
24455
24456 @smallexample
24457 (gdb)
24458 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
24459 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
24460 (gdb)
24461 -environment-directory ""
24462 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
24463 (gdb)
24464 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
24465 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
24466 (gdb)
24467 -environment-directory -r
24468 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
24469 (gdb)
24470 @end smallexample
24471
24472
24473 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
24474 @findex -environment-path
24475
24476 @subsubheading Synopsis
24477
24478 @smallexample
24479 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
24480 @end smallexample
24481
24482 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
24483 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
24484 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
24485 supplied in addition to the
24486 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
24487 occurs as normal.
24488 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
24489 multiple directories in a single command
24490 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
24491 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
24492 If blanks are needed as
24493 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
24494 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
24495 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
24496 character must not be used
24497 in any directory name.
24498 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
24499
24500
24501 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24502
24503 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
24504
24505 @subsubheading Example
24506
24507 @smallexample
24508 (gdb)
24509 -environment-path
24510 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
24511 (gdb)
24512 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
24513 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
24514 (gdb)
24515 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
24516 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
24517 (gdb)
24518 @end smallexample
24519
24520
24521 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
24522 @findex -environment-pwd
24523
24524 @subsubheading Synopsis
24525
24526 @smallexample
24527 -environment-pwd
24528 @end smallexample
24529
24530 Show the current working directory.
24531
24532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24533
24534 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
24535
24536 @subsubheading Example
24537
24538 @smallexample
24539 (gdb)
24540 -environment-pwd
24541 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
24542 (gdb)
24543 @end smallexample
24544
24545 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24546 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
24547 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
24548
24549
24550 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
24551 @findex -thread-info
24552
24553 @subsubheading Synopsis
24554
24555 @smallexample
24556 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
24557 @end smallexample
24558
24559 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
24560 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
24561 threads. When printing information about all threads,
24562 also reports the current thread.
24563
24564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24565
24566 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
24567 about all threads.
24568
24569 @subsubheading Example
24570
24571 @smallexample
24572 -thread-info
24573 ^done,threads=[
24574 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
24575 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
24576 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
24577 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
24578 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
24579 current-thread-id="1"
24580 (gdb)
24581 @end smallexample
24582
24583 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
24584
24585 @table @code
24586 @item stopped
24587 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
24588 threads.
24589
24590 @item running
24591 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
24592 threads.
24593
24594 @end table
24595
24596 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
24597 @findex -thread-list-ids
24598
24599 @subsubheading Synopsis
24600
24601 @smallexample
24602 -thread-list-ids
24603 @end smallexample
24604
24605 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
24606 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
24607
24608 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
24609 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
24610
24611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24612
24613 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
24614
24615 @subsubheading Example
24616
24617 @smallexample
24618 (gdb)
24619 -thread-list-ids
24620 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
24621 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
24622 (gdb)
24623 @end smallexample
24624
24625
24626 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
24627 @findex -thread-select
24628
24629 @subsubheading Synopsis
24630
24631 @smallexample
24632 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
24633 @end smallexample
24634
24635 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
24636 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
24637
24638 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
24639 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
24640
24641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24642
24643 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
24644
24645 @subsubheading Example
24646
24647 @smallexample
24648 (gdb)
24649 -exec-next
24650 ^running
24651 (gdb)
24652 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
24653 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
24654 (gdb)
24655 -thread-list-ids
24656 ^done,
24657 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
24658 number-of-threads="3"
24659 (gdb)
24660 -thread-select 3
24661 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
24662 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
24663 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
24664 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
24665 (gdb)
24666 @end smallexample
24667
24668 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24669 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
24670 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
24671
24672 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
24673 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
24674 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
24675 other cases.
24676
24677 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
24678 @findex -exec-continue
24679
24680 @subsubheading Synopsis
24681
24682 @smallexample
24683 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
24684 @end smallexample
24685
24686 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
24687 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
24688 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
24689 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
24690 @itemize @bullet
24691 @item
24692 breakpoints or watchpoints
24693 @item
24694 signals or exceptions
24695 @item
24696 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
24697 @item
24698 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
24699 @end itemize
24700 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
24701 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
24702 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
24703 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
24704 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
24705 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
24706
24707 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24708
24709 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
24710
24711 @subsubheading Example
24712
24713 @smallexample
24714 -exec-continue
24715 ^running
24716 (gdb)
24717 @@Hello world
24718 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
24719 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
24720 line="13"@}
24721 (gdb)
24722 @end smallexample
24723
24724
24725 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
24726 @findex -exec-finish
24727
24728 @subsubheading Synopsis
24729
24730 @smallexample
24731 -exec-finish [--reverse]
24732 @end smallexample
24733
24734 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
24735 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
24736 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
24737 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
24738 function was called.
24739
24740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24741
24742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
24743
24744 @subsubheading Example
24745
24746 Function returning @code{void}.
24747
24748 @smallexample
24749 -exec-finish
24750 ^running
24751 (gdb)
24752 @@hello from foo
24753 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
24754 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
24755 (gdb)
24756 @end smallexample
24757
24758 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
24759 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
24760 value itself.
24761
24762 @smallexample
24763 -exec-finish
24764 ^running
24765 (gdb)
24766 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
24767 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
24768 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
24769 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
24770 (gdb)
24771 @end smallexample
24772
24773
24774 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
24775 @findex -exec-interrupt
24776
24777 @subsubheading Synopsis
24778
24779 @smallexample
24780 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
24781 @end smallexample
24782
24783 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
24784 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
24785 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
24786 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
24787 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
24788
24789 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
24790 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
24791 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
24792 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
24793
24794 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
24795 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
24796 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
24797 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
24798
24799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24800
24801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
24802
24803 @subsubheading Example
24804
24805 @smallexample
24806 (gdb)
24807 111-exec-continue
24808 111^running
24809
24810 (gdb)
24811 222-exec-interrupt
24812 222^done
24813 (gdb)
24814 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
24815 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
24816 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
24817 (gdb)
24818
24819 (gdb)
24820 -exec-interrupt
24821 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
24822 (gdb)
24823 @end smallexample
24824
24825 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
24826 @findex -exec-jump
24827
24828 @subsubheading Synopsis
24829
24830 @smallexample
24831 -exec-jump @var{location}
24832 @end smallexample
24833
24834 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
24835 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
24836 different forms of @var{location}.
24837
24838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24839
24840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
24841
24842 @subsubheading Example
24843
24844 @smallexample
24845 -exec-jump foo.c:10
24846 *running,thread-id="all"
24847 ^running
24848 @end smallexample
24849
24850
24851 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
24852 @findex -exec-next
24853
24854 @subsubheading Synopsis
24855
24856 @smallexample
24857 -exec-next [--reverse]
24858 @end smallexample
24859
24860 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
24861 of the next source line is reached.
24862
24863 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
24864 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
24865 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
24866 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
24867 source line where the function was called.
24868
24869
24870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24871
24872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
24873
24874 @subsubheading Example
24875
24876 @smallexample
24877 -exec-next
24878 ^running
24879 (gdb)
24880 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
24881 (gdb)
24882 @end smallexample
24883
24884
24885 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
24886 @findex -exec-next-instruction
24887
24888 @subsubheading Synopsis
24889
24890 @smallexample
24891 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
24892 @end smallexample
24893
24894 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
24895 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
24896 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
24897 printed as well.
24898
24899 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
24900 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
24901 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
24902 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
24903 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
24904
24905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24906
24907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
24908
24909 @subsubheading Example
24910
24911 @smallexample
24912 (gdb)
24913 -exec-next-instruction
24914 ^running
24915
24916 (gdb)
24917 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
24918 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
24919 (gdb)
24920 @end smallexample
24921
24922
24923 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
24924 @findex -exec-return
24925
24926 @subsubheading Synopsis
24927
24928 @smallexample
24929 -exec-return
24930 @end smallexample
24931
24932 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
24933 Displays the new current frame.
24934
24935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24936
24937 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
24938
24939 @subsubheading Example
24940
24941 @smallexample
24942 (gdb)
24943 200-break-insert callee4
24944 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
24945 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
24946 (gdb)
24947 000-exec-run
24948 000^running
24949 (gdb)
24950 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
24951 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
24952 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24953 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
24954 (gdb)
24955 205-break-delete
24956 205^done
24957 (gdb)
24958 111-exec-return
24959 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
24960 args=[@{name="strarg",
24961 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
24962 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24963 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
24964 (gdb)
24965 @end smallexample
24966
24967
24968 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
24969 @findex -exec-run
24970
24971 @subsubheading Synopsis
24972
24973 @smallexample
24974 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
24975 @end smallexample
24976
24977 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
24978 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
24979 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
24980 the program has exited exceptionally.
24981
24982 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
24983 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
24984 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
24985 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
24986
24987 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24988
24989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
24990
24991 @subsubheading Examples
24992
24993 @smallexample
24994 (gdb)
24995 -break-insert main
24996 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
24997 (gdb)
24998 -exec-run
24999 ^running
25000 (gdb)
25001 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
25002 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
25003 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
25004 (gdb)
25005 @end smallexample
25006
25007 @noindent
25008 Program exited normally:
25009
25010 @smallexample
25011 (gdb)
25012 -exec-run
25013 ^running
25014 (gdb)
25015 x = 55
25016 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25017 (gdb)
25018 @end smallexample
25019
25020 @noindent
25021 Program exited exceptionally:
25022
25023 @smallexample
25024 (gdb)
25025 -exec-run
25026 ^running
25027 (gdb)
25028 x = 55
25029 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
25030 (gdb)
25031 @end smallexample
25032
25033 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
25034 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
25035
25036 @smallexample
25037 (gdb)
25038 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
25039 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
25040 @end smallexample
25041
25042
25043 @c @subheading -exec-signal
25044
25045
25046 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
25047 @findex -exec-step
25048
25049 @subsubheading Synopsis
25050
25051 @smallexample
25052 -exec-step [--reverse]
25053 @end smallexample
25054
25055 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
25056 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
25057 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
25058 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
25059 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
25060 previously executed source line.
25061
25062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25063
25064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
25065
25066 @subsubheading Example
25067
25068 Stepping into a function:
25069
25070 @smallexample
25071 -exec-step
25072 ^running
25073 (gdb)
25074 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
25075 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
25076 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
25077 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
25078 (gdb)
25079 @end smallexample
25080
25081 Regular stepping:
25082
25083 @smallexample
25084 -exec-step
25085 ^running
25086 (gdb)
25087 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
25088 (gdb)
25089 @end smallexample
25090
25091
25092 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
25093 @findex -exec-step-instruction
25094
25095 @subsubheading Synopsis
25096
25097 @smallexample
25098 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
25099 @end smallexample
25100
25101 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
25102 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
25103 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
25104 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
25105 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
25106 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
25107 as well.
25108
25109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25110
25111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
25112
25113 @subsubheading Example
25114
25115 @smallexample
25116 (gdb)
25117 -exec-step-instruction
25118 ^running
25119
25120 (gdb)
25121 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
25122 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
25123 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
25124 (gdb)
25125 -exec-step-instruction
25126 ^running
25127
25128 (gdb)
25129 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
25130 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
25131 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
25132 (gdb)
25133 @end smallexample
25134
25135
25136 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
25137 @findex -exec-until
25138
25139 @subsubheading Synopsis
25140
25141 @smallexample
25142 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
25143 @end smallexample
25144
25145 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
25146 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
25147 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
25148 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
25149
25150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25151
25152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
25153
25154 @subsubheading Example
25155
25156 @smallexample
25157 (gdb)
25158 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
25159 ^running
25160 (gdb)
25161 x = 55
25162 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
25163 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
25164 (gdb)
25165 @end smallexample
25166
25167 @ignore
25168 @subheading -file-clear
25169 Is this going away????
25170 @end ignore
25171
25172 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25173 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
25174 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
25175
25176
25177 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
25178 @findex -stack-info-frame
25179
25180 @subsubheading Synopsis
25181
25182 @smallexample
25183 -stack-info-frame
25184 @end smallexample
25185
25186 Get info on the selected frame.
25187
25188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25189
25190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
25191 (without arguments).
25192
25193 @subsubheading Example
25194
25195 @smallexample
25196 (gdb)
25197 -stack-info-frame
25198 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
25199 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25200 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
25201 (gdb)
25202 @end smallexample
25203
25204 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
25205 @findex -stack-info-depth
25206
25207 @subsubheading Synopsis
25208
25209 @smallexample
25210 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
25211 @end smallexample
25212
25213 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
25214 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
25215
25216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25217
25218 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
25219
25220 @subsubheading Example
25221
25222 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
25223
25224 @smallexample
25225 (gdb)
25226 -stack-info-depth
25227 ^done,depth="12"
25228 (gdb)
25229 -stack-info-depth 4
25230 ^done,depth="4"
25231 (gdb)
25232 -stack-info-depth 12
25233 ^done,depth="12"
25234 (gdb)
25235 -stack-info-depth 11
25236 ^done,depth="11"
25237 (gdb)
25238 -stack-info-depth 13
25239 ^done,depth="12"
25240 (gdb)
25241 @end smallexample
25242
25243 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
25244 @findex -stack-list-arguments
25245
25246 @subsubheading Synopsis
25247
25248 @smallexample
25249 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
25250 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
25251 @end smallexample
25252
25253 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
25254 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
25255 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
25256 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
25257 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
25258 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
25259 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
25260 which case only existing frames will be returned.
25261
25262 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
25263 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
25264 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
25265 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
25266 structures and unions.
25267
25268 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
25269 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
25270
25271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25272
25273 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
25274 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
25275 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
25276
25277 @subsubheading Example
25278
25279 @smallexample
25280 (gdb)
25281 -stack-list-frames
25282 ^done,
25283 stack=[
25284 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25285 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25286 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
25287 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
25288 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25289 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
25290 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
25291 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25292 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
25293 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
25294 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25295 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
25296 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
25297 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25298 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
25299 (gdb)
25300 -stack-list-arguments 0
25301 ^done,
25302 stack-args=[
25303 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
25304 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
25305 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
25306 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
25307 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
25308 (gdb)
25309 -stack-list-arguments 1
25310 ^done,
25311 stack-args=[
25312 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
25313 frame=@{level="1",
25314 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
25315 frame=@{level="2",args=[
25316 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
25317 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
25318 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
25319 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
25320 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
25321 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
25322 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
25323 (gdb)
25324 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
25325 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
25326 (gdb)
25327 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
25328 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
25329 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
25330 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
25331 (gdb)
25332 @end smallexample
25333
25334 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
25335
25336
25337 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
25338 @findex -stack-list-frames
25339
25340 @subsubheading Synopsis
25341
25342 @smallexample
25343 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
25344 @end smallexample
25345
25346 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
25347 following info:
25348
25349 @table @samp
25350 @item @var{level}
25351 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
25352 @item @var{addr}
25353 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
25354 @item @var{func}
25355 Function name.
25356 @item @var{file}
25357 File name of the source file where the function lives.
25358 @item @var{line}
25359 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
25360 @end table
25361
25362 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
25363 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
25364 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
25365 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
25366 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
25367 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
25368 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
25369
25370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25371
25372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
25373
25374 @subsubheading Example
25375
25376 Full stack backtrace:
25377
25378 @smallexample
25379 (gdb)
25380 -stack-list-frames
25381 ^done,stack=
25382 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
25383 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
25384 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25385 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25386 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25387 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25388 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25389 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25390 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25391 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25392 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25393 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25394 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25395 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25396 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25397 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25398 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25399 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25400 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25401 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25402 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25403 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25404 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
25405 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
25406 (gdb)
25407 @end smallexample
25408
25409 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
25410
25411 @smallexample
25412 (gdb)
25413 -stack-list-frames 3 5
25414 ^done,stack=
25415 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25416 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25417 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25418 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25419 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25420 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
25421 (gdb)
25422 @end smallexample
25423
25424 Show a single frame:
25425
25426 @smallexample
25427 (gdb)
25428 -stack-list-frames 3 3
25429 ^done,stack=
25430 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25431 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
25432 (gdb)
25433 @end smallexample
25434
25435
25436 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
25437 @findex -stack-list-locals
25438
25439 @subsubheading Synopsis
25440
25441 @smallexample
25442 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
25443 @end smallexample
25444
25445 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
25446 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
25447 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
25448 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
25449 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
25450 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
25451 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
25452 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
25453 more detail.
25454
25455 This command is deprecated in favor of the
25456 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
25457
25458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25459
25460 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
25461
25462 @subsubheading Example
25463
25464 @smallexample
25465 (gdb)
25466 -stack-list-locals 0
25467 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
25468 (gdb)
25469 -stack-list-locals --all-values
25470 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
25471 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
25472 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
25473 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
25474 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
25475 (gdb)
25476 @end smallexample
25477
25478 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
25479 @findex -stack-list-variables
25480
25481 @subsubheading Synopsis
25482
25483 @smallexample
25484 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
25485 @end smallexample
25486
25487 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
25488 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
25489 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
25490 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
25491 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
25492 structures and unions.
25493
25494 @subsubheading Example
25495
25496 @smallexample
25497 (gdb)
25498 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
25499 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
25500 (gdb)
25501 @end smallexample
25502
25503
25504 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
25505 @findex -stack-select-frame
25506
25507 @subsubheading Synopsis
25508
25509 @smallexample
25510 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
25511 @end smallexample
25512
25513 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
25514 the stack.
25515
25516 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
25517 option to every command.
25518
25519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25520
25521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
25522 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
25523
25524 @subsubheading Example
25525
25526 @smallexample
25527 (gdb)
25528 -stack-select-frame 2
25529 ^done
25530 (gdb)
25531 @end smallexample
25532
25533 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25534 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
25535 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
25536
25537 @ignore
25538
25539 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
25540
25541 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
25542 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
25543 used by @code{Insight}.
25544
25545 The two main reasons for that are:
25546
25547 @enumerate 1
25548 @item
25549 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
25550
25551 @item
25552 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
25553 now).
25554 @end enumerate
25555
25556 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
25557 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
25558 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
25559 hints about their use.
25560
25561 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
25562 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
25563 least, the following operations:
25564
25565 @itemize @bullet
25566 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
25567 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
25568 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
25569 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
25570 @end itemize
25571
25572 @end ignore
25573
25574 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
25575
25576 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
25577
25578 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
25579 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
25580 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
25581 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
25582 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
25583 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
25584 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
25585 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
25586 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
25587 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
25588 object, or to change display format.
25589
25590 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
25591 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
25592 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
25593 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
25594 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
25595 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
25596 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
25597 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
25598 child will be created.
25599
25600 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
25601 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
25602 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
25603 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
25604 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
25605
25606 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
25607 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
25608 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
25609 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
25610 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
25611 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
25612 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
25613 variables that frontend has created.
25614
25615 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
25616 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
25617 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
25618 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
25619 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
25620 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
25621 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
25622 implicitly updated.
25623
25624 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
25625 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
25626 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
25627 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
25628 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
25629 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
25630 frame. Consider this example:
25631
25632 @smallexample
25633 void do_work(...)
25634 @{
25635 struct work_state state;
25636
25637 if (...)
25638 do_work(...);
25639 @}
25640 @end smallexample
25641
25642 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
25643 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
25644 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
25645 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
25646 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
25647
25648 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
25649 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
25650 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
25651 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
25652 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
25653 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
25654
25655 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
25656 access this functionality:
25657
25658 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
25659 @item @strong{Operation}
25660 @tab @strong{Description}
25661
25662 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
25663 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
25664 @item @code{-var-create}
25665 @tab create a variable object
25666 @item @code{-var-delete}
25667 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
25668 @item @code{-var-set-format}
25669 @tab set the display format of this variable
25670 @item @code{-var-show-format}
25671 @tab show the display format of this variable
25672 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
25673 @tab tells how many children this object has
25674 @item @code{-var-list-children}
25675 @tab return a list of the object's children
25676 @item @code{-var-info-type}
25677 @tab show the type of this variable object
25678 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
25679 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
25680 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
25681 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
25682 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
25683 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
25684 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
25685 @tab get the value of this variable
25686 @item @code{-var-assign}
25687 @tab set the value of this variable
25688 @item @code{-var-update}
25689 @tab update the variable and its children
25690 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
25691 @tab set frozeness attribute
25692 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
25693 @tab set range of children to display on update
25694 @end multitable
25695
25696 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
25697 how it can be used.
25698
25699 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
25700
25701 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
25702 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
25703
25704 @smallexample
25705 -enable-pretty-printing
25706 @end smallexample
25707
25708 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
25709 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
25710 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
25711 request that this functionality be enabled.
25712
25713 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
25714
25715 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
25716 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
25717
25718 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
25719 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
25720
25721 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
25722 @findex -var-create
25723
25724 @subsubheading Synopsis
25725
25726 @smallexample
25727 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
25728 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
25729 @end smallexample
25730
25731 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
25732 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
25733 register.
25734
25735 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
25736 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
25737 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
25738 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
25739 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
25740
25741 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
25742 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
25743 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
25744 object must be created.
25745
25746 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
25747 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
25748
25749 @itemize @bullet
25750 @item
25751 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
25752
25753 @item
25754 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
25755
25756 @item
25757 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
25758 @end itemize
25759
25760 @cindex dynamic varobj
25761 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
25762 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
25763 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
25764 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
25765 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
25766 compatibility for existing clients.
25767
25768 @subsubheading Result
25769
25770 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
25771 are:
25772
25773 @table @samp
25774 @item name
25775 The name of the varobj.
25776
25777 @item numchild
25778 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
25779 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
25780 @samp{has_more} attribute.
25781
25782 @item value
25783 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
25784 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
25785 will not be interesting.
25786
25787 @item type
25788 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
25789 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
25790
25791 @item thread-id
25792 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
25793 thread's identifier.
25794
25795 @item has_more
25796 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
25797 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
25798
25799 @item dynamic
25800 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
25801 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
25802 then this attribute will not be present.
25803
25804 @item displayhint
25805 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
25806 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
25807 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
25808 @end table
25809
25810 Typical output will look like this:
25811
25812 @smallexample
25813 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
25814 has_more="@var{has_more}"
25815 @end smallexample
25816
25817
25818 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
25819 @findex -var-delete
25820
25821 @subsubheading Synopsis
25822
25823 @smallexample
25824 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
25825 @end smallexample
25826
25827 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
25828 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
25829
25830 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
25831
25832
25833 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
25834 @findex -var-set-format
25835
25836 @subsubheading Synopsis
25837
25838 @smallexample
25839 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
25840 @end smallexample
25841
25842 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
25843 @var{format-spec}.
25844
25845 @anchor{-var-set-format}
25846 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
25847
25848 @smallexample
25849 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
25850 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
25851 @end smallexample
25852
25853 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
25854 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
25855 for pointers, etc.).
25856
25857 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
25858 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
25859
25860 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
25861 @findex -var-show-format
25862
25863 @subsubheading Synopsis
25864
25865 @smallexample
25866 -var-show-format @var{name}
25867 @end smallexample
25868
25869 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
25870
25871 @smallexample
25872 @var{format} @expansion{}
25873 @var{format-spec}
25874 @end smallexample
25875
25876
25877 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
25878 @findex -var-info-num-children
25879
25880 @subsubheading Synopsis
25881
25882 @smallexample
25883 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
25884 @end smallexample
25885
25886 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
25887
25888 @smallexample
25889 numchild=@var{n}
25890 @end smallexample
25891
25892 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
25893 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
25894 be available.
25895
25896
25897 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
25898 @findex -var-list-children
25899
25900 @subsubheading Synopsis
25901
25902 @smallexample
25903 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
25904 @end smallexample
25905 @anchor{-var-list-children}
25906
25907 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
25908 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
25909 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
25910 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
25911 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
25912 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
25913 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
25914 and unions.
25915
25916 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
25917 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
25918 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
25919 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
25920 reported.
25921
25922 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
25923 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
25924 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
25925 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
25926 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
25927 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
25928 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
25929 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
25930 the visible items.
25931
25932 For each child the following results are returned:
25933
25934 @table @var
25935
25936 @item name
25937 Name of the variable object created for this child.
25938
25939 @item exp
25940 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
25941 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
25942
25943 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
25944 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
25945
25946 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
25947 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
25948 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
25949 type and value are not present.
25950
25951 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
25952 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
25953 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
25954
25955 @item numchild
25956 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
25957 0.
25958
25959 @item type
25960 The type of the child.
25961
25962 @item value
25963 If values were requested, this is the value.
25964
25965 @item thread-id
25966 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
25967 Otherwise this result is not present.
25968
25969 @item frozen
25970 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
25971 @end table
25972
25973 The result may have its own attributes:
25974
25975 @table @samp
25976 @item displayhint
25977 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
25978 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
25979 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
25980
25981 @item has_more
25982 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
25983 remaining after the end of the selected range.
25984 @end table
25985
25986 @subsubheading Example
25987
25988 @smallexample
25989 (gdb)
25990 -var-list-children n
25991 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
25992 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
25993 (gdb)
25994 -var-list-children --all-values n
25995 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
25996 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
25997 @end smallexample
25998
25999
26000 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
26001 @findex -var-info-type
26002
26003 @subsubheading Synopsis
26004
26005 @smallexample
26006 -var-info-type @var{name}
26007 @end smallexample
26008
26009 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
26010 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
26011 @value{GDBN} CLI:
26012
26013 @smallexample
26014 type=@var{typename}
26015 @end smallexample
26016
26017
26018 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
26019 @findex -var-info-expression
26020
26021 @subsubheading Synopsis
26022
26023 @smallexample
26024 -var-info-expression @var{name}
26025 @end smallexample
26026
26027 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
26028 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
26029 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
26030
26031 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
26032 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
26033
26034 @smallexample
26035 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
26036 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
26037 @end smallexample
26038
26039 @noindent
26040 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
26041
26042 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
26043 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
26044 is of limited use.
26045
26046 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
26047 @findex -var-info-path-expression
26048
26049 @subsubheading Synopsis
26050
26051 @smallexample
26052 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
26053 @end smallexample
26054
26055 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
26056 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
26057 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
26058 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
26059 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
26060 watchpoint from a variable object.
26061
26062 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
26063 and will give an error when invoked on one.
26064
26065 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
26066 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
26067 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
26068 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
26069 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
26070 @smallexample
26071 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
26072 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
26073 @end smallexample
26074
26075 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
26076 @findex -var-show-attributes
26077
26078 @subsubheading Synopsis
26079
26080 @smallexample
26081 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
26082 @end smallexample
26083
26084 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
26085
26086 @smallexample
26087 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
26088 @end smallexample
26089
26090 @noindent
26091 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
26092
26093 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
26094 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
26095
26096 @subsubheading Synopsis
26097
26098 @smallexample
26099 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
26100 @end smallexample
26101
26102 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
26103 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
26104 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
26105 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
26106 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
26107 the current display format will be used. The current display format
26108 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
26109
26110 @smallexample
26111 value=@var{value}
26112 @end smallexample
26113
26114 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
26115 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
26116
26117 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
26118 @findex -var-assign
26119
26120 @subsubheading Synopsis
26121
26122 @smallexample
26123 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
26124 @end smallexample
26125
26126 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
26127 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
26128 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
26129 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
26130
26131 @subsubheading Example
26132
26133 @smallexample
26134 (gdb)
26135 -var-assign var1 3
26136 ^done,value="3"
26137 (gdb)
26138 -var-update *
26139 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
26140 (gdb)
26141 @end smallexample
26142
26143 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
26144 @findex -var-update
26145
26146 @subsubheading Synopsis
26147
26148 @smallexample
26149 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
26150 @end smallexample
26151
26152 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
26153 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
26154 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
26155 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
26156 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
26157 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
26158 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
26159 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
26160 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
26161 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
26162 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
26163 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
26164 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
26165
26166 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
26167 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
26168 diagnostic.
26169
26170 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
26171 only the selected range of children will be reported.
26172
26173 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
26174 @samp{changelist}.
26175
26176 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
26177
26178 @table @samp
26179 @item name
26180 The name of the varobj.
26181
26182 @item value
26183 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
26184 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
26185
26186 @item in_scope
26187 @anchor{-var-update}
26188 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
26189
26190 @table @code
26191 @item "true"
26192 The variable object's current value is valid.
26193
26194 @item "false"
26195 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
26196 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
26197 scope.
26198
26199 @item "invalid"
26200 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
26201 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
26202 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
26203 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
26204 objects.
26205 @end table
26206
26207 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
26208 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
26209
26210 @item type_changed
26211 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
26212 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
26213 be @samp{false}.
26214
26215 @item new_type
26216 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
26217 hold the new type.
26218
26219 @item new_num_children
26220 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
26221 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
26222
26223 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
26224 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
26225 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
26226 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
26227 children which may be available.
26228
26229 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
26230 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
26231 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
26232 only happen at the end of the update range).
26233
26234 @item displayhint
26235 The display hint, if any.
26236
26237 @item has_more
26238 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
26239 available outside the varobj's update range.
26240
26241 @item dynamic
26242 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
26243 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
26244 then this attribute will not be present.
26245
26246 @item new_children
26247 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
26248 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
26249 be listed in this attribute.
26250 @end table
26251
26252 @subsubheading Example
26253
26254 @smallexample
26255 (gdb)
26256 -var-assign var1 3
26257 ^done,value="3"
26258 (gdb)
26259 -var-update --all-values var1
26260 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
26261 type_changed="false"@}]
26262 (gdb)
26263 @end smallexample
26264
26265 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
26266 @findex -var-set-frozen
26267 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
26268
26269 @subsubheading Synopsis
26270
26271 @smallexample
26272 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
26273 @end smallexample
26274
26275 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
26276 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
26277 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
26278 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
26279 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
26280 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
26281 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
26282 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
26283 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
26284 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
26285 @code{-var-update} does.
26286
26287 @subsubheading Example
26288
26289 @smallexample
26290 (gdb)
26291 -var-set-frozen V 1
26292 ^done
26293 (gdb)
26294 @end smallexample
26295
26296 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
26297 @findex -var-set-update-range
26298 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
26299
26300 @subsubheading Synopsis
26301
26302 @smallexample
26303 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
26304 @end smallexample
26305
26306 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
26307 @code{-var-update}.
26308
26309 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
26310 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
26311 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
26312 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
26313
26314 @subsubheading Example
26315
26316 @smallexample
26317 (gdb)
26318 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
26319 ^done
26320 @end smallexample
26321
26322 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
26323 @findex -var-set-visualizer
26324 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
26325
26326 @subsubheading Synopsis
26327
26328 @smallexample
26329 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
26330 @end smallexample
26331
26332 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
26333
26334 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
26335 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
26336
26337 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
26338 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
26339 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
26340 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
26341 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
26342 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
26343 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
26344
26345 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
26346 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
26347 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
26348 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
26349
26350 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
26351 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
26352 can be used to check this.
26353
26354 @subsubheading Example
26355
26356 Resetting the visualizer:
26357
26358 @smallexample
26359 (gdb)
26360 -var-set-visualizer V None
26361 ^done
26362 @end smallexample
26363
26364 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
26365
26366 @smallexample
26367 (gdb)
26368 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
26369 ^done
26370 @end smallexample
26371
26372 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
26373 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
26374
26375 @smallexample
26376 (gdb)
26377 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
26378 ^done
26379 @end smallexample
26380
26381 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26382 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
26383 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
26384
26385 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
26386 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
26387 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
26388 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
26389
26390 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
26391 @c @subheading -data-assign
26392 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
26393 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
26394 @c set variable
26395 @c @subsubheading Example
26396 @c N.A.
26397
26398 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
26399 @findex -data-disassemble
26400
26401 @subsubheading Synopsis
26402
26403 @smallexample
26404 -data-disassemble
26405 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
26406 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
26407 -- @var{mode}
26408 @end smallexample
26409
26410 @noindent
26411 Where:
26412
26413 @table @samp
26414 @item @var{start-addr}
26415 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
26416 @item @var{end-addr}
26417 is the end address
26418 @item @var{filename}
26419 is the name of the file to disassemble
26420 @item @var{linenum}
26421 is the line number to disassemble around
26422 @item @var{lines}
26423 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
26424 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
26425 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
26426 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
26427 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
26428 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
26429 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
26430 are displayed.
26431 @item @var{mode}
26432 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
26433 disassembly).
26434 @end table
26435
26436 @subsubheading Result
26437
26438 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
26439
26440 @itemize @bullet
26441 @item Address
26442 @item Func-name
26443 @item Offset
26444 @item Instruction
26445 @end itemize
26446
26447 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
26448 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
26449
26450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26451
26452 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
26453
26454 @subsubheading Example
26455
26456 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
26457
26458 @smallexample
26459 (gdb)
26460 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
26461 ^done,
26462 asm_insns=[
26463 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26464 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26465 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26466 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
26467 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
26468 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
26469 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
26470 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
26471 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
26472 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
26473 (gdb)
26474 @end smallexample
26475
26476 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
26477 @code{main}.
26478
26479 @smallexample
26480 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
26481 ^done,asm_insns=[
26482 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
26483 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
26484 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26485 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26486 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26487 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
26488 [@dots{}]
26489 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
26490 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
26491 (gdb)
26492 @end smallexample
26493
26494 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
26495
26496 @smallexample
26497 (gdb)
26498 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
26499 ^done,asm_insns=[
26500 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
26501 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
26502 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26503 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26504 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26505 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
26506 (gdb)
26507 @end smallexample
26508
26509 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
26510
26511 @smallexample
26512 (gdb)
26513 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
26514 ^done,asm_insns=[
26515 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
26516 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
26517 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
26518 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
26519 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
26520 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
26521 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
26522 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
26523 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26524 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26525 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26526 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
26527 (gdb)
26528 @end smallexample
26529
26530
26531 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
26532 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
26533
26534 @subsubheading Synopsis
26535
26536 @smallexample
26537 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
26538 @end smallexample
26539
26540 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
26541 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
26542 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
26543
26544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26545
26546 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
26547 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
26548 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
26549
26550 @subsubheading Example
26551
26552 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
26553 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
26554 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
26555 output.
26556
26557 @smallexample
26558 211-data-evaluate-expression A
26559 211^done,value="1"
26560 (gdb)
26561 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
26562 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
26563 (gdb)
26564 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
26565 411^done,value="4"
26566 (gdb)
26567 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
26568 511^done,value="4"
26569 (gdb)
26570 @end smallexample
26571
26572
26573 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
26574 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
26575
26576 @subsubheading Synopsis
26577
26578 @smallexample
26579 -data-list-changed-registers
26580 @end smallexample
26581
26582 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
26583
26584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26585
26586 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
26587 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
26588
26589 @subsubheading Example
26590
26591 On a PPC MBX board:
26592
26593 @smallexample
26594 (gdb)
26595 -exec-continue
26596 ^running
26597
26598 (gdb)
26599 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
26600 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
26601 line="5"@}
26602 (gdb)
26603 -data-list-changed-registers
26604 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
26605 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
26606 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
26607 (gdb)
26608 @end smallexample
26609
26610
26611 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
26612 @findex -data-list-register-names
26613
26614 @subsubheading Synopsis
26615
26616 @smallexample
26617 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
26618 @end smallexample
26619
26620 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
26621 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
26622 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
26623 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
26624 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
26625 include empty register names.
26626
26627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26628
26629 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
26630 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
26631 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
26632
26633 @subsubheading Example
26634
26635 For the PPC MBX board:
26636 @smallexample
26637 (gdb)
26638 -data-list-register-names
26639 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
26640 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
26641 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
26642 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
26643 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
26644 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
26645 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
26646 (gdb)
26647 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
26648 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
26649 (gdb)
26650 @end smallexample
26651
26652 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
26653 @findex -data-list-register-values
26654
26655 @subsubheading Synopsis
26656
26657 @smallexample
26658 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
26659 @end smallexample
26660
26661 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
26662 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
26663 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
26664 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
26665
26666 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
26667
26668 @table @code
26669 @item x
26670 Hexadecimal
26671 @item o
26672 Octal
26673 @item t
26674 Binary
26675 @item d
26676 Decimal
26677 @item r
26678 Raw
26679 @item N
26680 Natural
26681 @end table
26682
26683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26684
26685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
26686 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
26687
26688 @subsubheading Example
26689
26690 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
26691 don't appear in the actual output):
26692
26693 @smallexample
26694 (gdb)
26695 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
26696 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
26697 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
26698 (gdb)
26699 -data-list-register-values x
26700 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
26701 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
26702 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
26703 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
26704 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
26705 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
26706 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
26707 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
26708 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
26709 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
26710 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
26711 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
26712 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
26713 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
26714 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
26715 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
26716 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
26717 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
26718 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
26719 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
26720 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
26721 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
26722 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
26723 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
26724 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
26725 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
26726 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
26727 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
26728 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
26729 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
26730 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
26731 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
26732 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
26733 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
26734 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
26735 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
26736 (gdb)
26737 @end smallexample
26738
26739
26740 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
26741 @findex -data-read-memory
26742
26743 @subsubheading Synopsis
26744
26745 @smallexample
26746 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
26747 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
26748 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
26749 @end smallexample
26750
26751 @noindent
26752 where:
26753
26754 @table @samp
26755 @item @var{address}
26756 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
26757 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
26758 quoted using the C convention.
26759
26760 @item @var{word-format}
26761 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
26762 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
26763 ,Output Formats}).
26764
26765 @item @var{word-size}
26766 The size of each memory word in bytes.
26767
26768 @item @var{nr-rows}
26769 The number of rows in the output table.
26770
26771 @item @var{nr-cols}
26772 The number of columns in the output table.
26773
26774 @item @var{aschar}
26775 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
26776 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
26777 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
26778 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
26779
26780 @item @var{byte-offset}
26781 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
26782 @end table
26783
26784 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
26785 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
26786 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
26787 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
26788 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
26789 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
26790 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
26791 @samp{addr}.
26792
26793 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
26794 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
26795 @samp{prev-page}.
26796
26797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26798
26799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
26800 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
26801
26802 @subsubheading Example
26803
26804 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
26805 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
26806 word. Display each word in hex.
26807
26808 @smallexample
26809 (gdb)
26810 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
26811 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
26812 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
26813 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
26814 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
26815 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
26816 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
26817 (gdb)
26818 @end smallexample
26819
26820 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
26821 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
26822
26823 @smallexample
26824 (gdb)
26825 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
26826 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
26827 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
26828 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
26829 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
26830 (gdb)
26831 @end smallexample
26832
26833 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
26834 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
26835 used as the non-printable character.
26836
26837 @smallexample
26838 (gdb)
26839 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
26840 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
26841 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
26842 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
26843 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26844 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26845 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26846 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26847 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
26848 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
26849 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
26850 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
26851 (gdb)
26852 @end smallexample
26853
26854 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26855 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
26856 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
26857
26858 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
26859 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
26860
26861 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
26862 @findex -trace-find
26863
26864 @subsubheading Synopsis
26865
26866 @smallexample
26867 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
26868 @end smallexample
26869
26870 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
26871 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
26872 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
26873
26874 @table @samp
26875
26876 @item none
26877 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
26878
26879 @item frame-number
26880 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
26881 that index.
26882
26883 @item tracepoint-number
26884 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
26885 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
26886
26887 @item pc
26888 An address is required as parameter. Finds
26889 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
26890 address.
26891
26892 @item pc-inside-range
26893 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
26894 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
26895 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
26896
26897 @item pc-outside-range
26898 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
26899 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
26900 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
26901
26902 @item line
26903 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
26904 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
26905 the specified location.
26906
26907 @end table
26908
26909 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
26910 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
26911
26912 @table @samp
26913 @item found
26914 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
26915 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
26916
26917 @item traceframe
26918 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
26919 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
26920
26921 @item tracepoint
26922 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
26923 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
26924
26925 @item frame
26926 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
26927 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
26928 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
26929
26930 @end table
26931
26932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26933
26934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
26935
26936 @subheading -trace-define-variable
26937 @findex -trace-define-variable
26938
26939 @subsubheading Synopsis
26940
26941 @smallexample
26942 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
26943 @end smallexample
26944
26945 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
26946 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
26947 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
26948 with the @samp{$} character.
26949
26950 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26951
26952 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
26953
26954 @subheading -trace-list-variables
26955 @findex -trace-list-variables
26956
26957 @subsubheading Synopsis
26958
26959 @smallexample
26960 -trace-list-variables
26961 @end smallexample
26962
26963 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
26964 table has the following fields:
26965
26966 @table @samp
26967 @item name
26968 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
26969
26970 @item initial
26971 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
26972 field is always present.
26973
26974 @item current
26975 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
26976 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
26977 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
26978 presently running.
26979
26980 @end table
26981
26982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26983
26984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
26985
26986 @subsubheading Example
26987
26988 @smallexample
26989 (gdb)
26990 -trace-list-variables
26991 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
26992 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
26993 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
26994 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
26995 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
26996 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
26997 (gdb)
26998 @end smallexample
26999
27000 @subheading -trace-save
27001 @findex -trace-save
27002
27003 @subsubheading Synopsis
27004
27005 @smallexample
27006 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
27007 @end smallexample
27008
27009 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
27010 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
27011 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
27012 to perform the save.
27013
27014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27015
27016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
27017
27018
27019 @subheading -trace-start
27020 @findex -trace-start
27021
27022 @subsubheading Synopsis
27023
27024 @smallexample
27025 -trace-start
27026 @end smallexample
27027
27028 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
27029 have any fields.
27030
27031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27032
27033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
27034
27035 @subheading -trace-status
27036 @findex -trace-status
27037
27038 @subsubheading Synopsis
27039
27040 @smallexample
27041 -trace-status
27042 @end smallexample
27043
27044 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
27045 the following fields:
27046
27047 @table @samp
27048
27049 @item supported
27050 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
27051 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
27052 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
27053 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
27054 started. This field is always present.
27055
27056 @item running
27057 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
27058 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
27059 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
27060
27061 @item stop-reason
27062 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
27063 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
27064 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
27065 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
27066 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
27067 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
27068 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
27069 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
27070 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
27071
27072 @item stopping-tracepoint
27073 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
27074 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
27075 @samp{passcount}.
27076
27077 @item frames
27078 @itemx frames-created
27079 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
27080 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
27081 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
27082 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
27083
27084 @item buffer-size
27085 @itemx buffer-free
27086 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
27087 remaining space. These fields are optional.
27088
27089 @item circular
27090 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
27091 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
27092 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
27093 and may fill up.
27094
27095 @item disconnected
27096 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
27097 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
27098 that the trace run will stop.
27099
27100 @end table
27101
27102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27103
27104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
27105
27106 @subheading -trace-stop
27107 @findex -trace-stop
27108
27109 @subsubheading Synopsis
27110
27111 @smallexample
27112 -trace-stop
27113 @end smallexample
27114
27115 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
27116 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
27117 @samp{running} fields are not output.
27118
27119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27120
27121 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
27122
27123
27124 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27125 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
27126 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
27127
27128
27129 @ignore
27130 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
27131 @findex -symbol-info-address
27132
27133 @subsubheading Synopsis
27134
27135 @smallexample
27136 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
27137 @end smallexample
27138
27139 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
27140
27141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27142
27143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
27144
27145 @subsubheading Example
27146 N.A.
27147
27148
27149 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
27150 @findex -symbol-info-file
27151
27152 @subsubheading Synopsis
27153
27154 @smallexample
27155 -symbol-info-file
27156 @end smallexample
27157
27158 Show the file for the symbol.
27159
27160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27161
27162 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
27163 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
27164
27165 @subsubheading Example
27166 N.A.
27167
27168
27169 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
27170 @findex -symbol-info-function
27171
27172 @subsubheading Synopsis
27173
27174 @smallexample
27175 -symbol-info-function
27176 @end smallexample
27177
27178 Show which function the symbol lives in.
27179
27180 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27181
27182 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
27183
27184 @subsubheading Example
27185 N.A.
27186
27187
27188 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
27189 @findex -symbol-info-line
27190
27191 @subsubheading Synopsis
27192
27193 @smallexample
27194 -symbol-info-line
27195 @end smallexample
27196
27197 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
27198
27199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27200
27201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
27202 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
27203
27204 @subsubheading Example
27205 N.A.
27206
27207
27208 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
27209 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
27210
27211 @subsubheading Synopsis
27212
27213 @smallexample
27214 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
27215 @end smallexample
27216
27217 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
27218
27219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27220
27221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
27222
27223 @subsubheading Example
27224 N.A.
27225
27226
27227 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
27228 @findex -symbol-list-functions
27229
27230 @subsubheading Synopsis
27231
27232 @smallexample
27233 -symbol-list-functions
27234 @end smallexample
27235
27236 List the functions in the executable.
27237
27238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27239
27240 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
27241 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
27242
27243 @subsubheading Example
27244 N.A.
27245 @end ignore
27246
27247
27248 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
27249 @findex -symbol-list-lines
27250
27251 @subsubheading Synopsis
27252
27253 @smallexample
27254 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
27255 @end smallexample
27256
27257 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
27258 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
27259 ascending PC order.
27260
27261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27262
27263 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
27264
27265 @subsubheading Example
27266 @smallexample
27267 (gdb)
27268 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
27269 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
27270 (gdb)
27271 @end smallexample
27272
27273
27274 @ignore
27275 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
27276 @findex -symbol-list-types
27277
27278 @subsubheading Synopsis
27279
27280 @smallexample
27281 -symbol-list-types
27282 @end smallexample
27283
27284 List all the type names.
27285
27286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27287
27288 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
27289 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
27290
27291 @subsubheading Example
27292 N.A.
27293
27294
27295 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
27296 @findex -symbol-list-variables
27297
27298 @subsubheading Synopsis
27299
27300 @smallexample
27301 -symbol-list-variables
27302 @end smallexample
27303
27304 List all the global and static variable names.
27305
27306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27307
27308 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
27309
27310 @subsubheading Example
27311 N.A.
27312
27313
27314 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
27315 @findex -symbol-locate
27316
27317 @subsubheading Synopsis
27318
27319 @smallexample
27320 -symbol-locate
27321 @end smallexample
27322
27323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27324
27325 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
27326
27327 @subsubheading Example
27328 N.A.
27329
27330
27331 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
27332 @findex -symbol-type
27333
27334 @subsubheading Synopsis
27335
27336 @smallexample
27337 -symbol-type @var{variable}
27338 @end smallexample
27339
27340 Show type of @var{variable}.
27341
27342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27343
27344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
27345 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
27346
27347 @subsubheading Example
27348 N.A.
27349 @end ignore
27350
27351
27352 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27353 @node GDB/MI File Commands
27354 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
27355
27356 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
27357 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
27358
27359 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
27360 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
27361
27362 @subsubheading Synopsis
27363
27364 @smallexample
27365 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
27366 @end smallexample
27367
27368 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
27369 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
27370 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
27371 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
27372 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
27373 notification.
27374
27375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27376
27377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
27378
27379 @subsubheading Example
27380
27381 @smallexample
27382 (gdb)
27383 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
27384 ^done
27385 (gdb)
27386 @end smallexample
27387
27388
27389 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
27390 @findex -file-exec-file
27391
27392 @subsubheading Synopsis
27393
27394 @smallexample
27395 -file-exec-file @var{file}
27396 @end smallexample
27397
27398 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
27399 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
27400 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
27401 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
27402 notification.
27403
27404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27405
27406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
27407
27408 @subsubheading Example
27409
27410 @smallexample
27411 (gdb)
27412 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
27413 ^done
27414 (gdb)
27415 @end smallexample
27416
27417
27418 @ignore
27419 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
27420 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
27421
27422 @subsubheading Synopsis
27423
27424 @smallexample
27425 -file-list-exec-sections
27426 @end smallexample
27427
27428 List the sections of the current executable file.
27429
27430 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27431
27432 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
27433 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
27434 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
27435
27436 @subsubheading Example
27437 N.A.
27438 @end ignore
27439
27440
27441 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
27442 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
27443
27444 @subsubheading Synopsis
27445
27446 @smallexample
27447 -file-list-exec-source-file
27448 @end smallexample
27449
27450 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
27451 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
27452 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
27453 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
27454
27455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27456
27457 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
27458
27459 @subsubheading Example
27460
27461 @smallexample
27462 (gdb)
27463 123-file-list-exec-source-file
27464 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
27465 (gdb)
27466 @end smallexample
27467
27468
27469 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
27470 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
27471
27472 @subsubheading Synopsis
27473
27474 @smallexample
27475 -file-list-exec-source-files
27476 @end smallexample
27477
27478 List the source files for the current executable.
27479
27480 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
27481 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
27482
27483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27484
27485 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
27486 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
27487
27488 @subsubheading Example
27489 @smallexample
27490 (gdb)
27491 -file-list-exec-source-files
27492 ^done,files=[
27493 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
27494 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
27495 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
27496 (gdb)
27497 @end smallexample
27498
27499 @ignore
27500 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
27501 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
27502
27503 @subsubheading Synopsis
27504
27505 @smallexample
27506 -file-list-shared-libraries
27507 @end smallexample
27508
27509 List the shared libraries in the program.
27510
27511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27512
27513 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
27514
27515 @subsubheading Example
27516 N.A.
27517
27518
27519 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
27520 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
27521
27522 @subsubheading Synopsis
27523
27524 @smallexample
27525 -file-list-symbol-files
27526 @end smallexample
27527
27528 List symbol files.
27529
27530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27531
27532 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
27533
27534 @subsubheading Example
27535 N.A.
27536 @end ignore
27537
27538
27539 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
27540 @findex -file-symbol-file
27541
27542 @subsubheading Synopsis
27543
27544 @smallexample
27545 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
27546 @end smallexample
27547
27548 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
27549 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
27550 produced, except for a completion notification.
27551
27552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27553
27554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
27555
27556 @subsubheading Example
27557
27558 @smallexample
27559 (gdb)
27560 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
27561 ^done
27562 (gdb)
27563 @end smallexample
27564
27565 @ignore
27566 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27567 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
27568 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
27569
27570 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
27571
27572 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
27573
27574 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
27575
27576 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
27577
27578 @c @subheading -overlay-map
27579
27580 @c @subheading -overlay-off
27581
27582 @c @subheading -overlay-on
27583
27584 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
27585
27586 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27587 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
27588 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
27589
27590 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
27591
27592 @c @subheading -signal-handle
27593
27594 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
27595
27596 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
27597 @end ignore
27598
27599
27600 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27601 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
27602 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
27603
27604
27605 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
27606 @findex -target-attach
27607
27608 @subsubheading Synopsis
27609
27610 @smallexample
27611 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
27612 @end smallexample
27613
27614 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
27615 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
27616 group, the id previously returned by
27617 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
27618
27619 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27620
27621 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
27622
27623 @subsubheading Example
27624 @smallexample
27625 (gdb)
27626 -target-attach 34
27627 =thread-created,id="1"
27628 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
27629 ^done
27630 (gdb)
27631 @end smallexample
27632
27633 @ignore
27634 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
27635 @findex -target-compare-sections
27636
27637 @subsubheading Synopsis
27638
27639 @smallexample
27640 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
27641 @end smallexample
27642
27643 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
27644 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
27645
27646 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27647
27648 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
27649
27650 @subsubheading Example
27651 N.A.
27652 @end ignore
27653
27654
27655 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
27656 @findex -target-detach
27657
27658 @subsubheading Synopsis
27659
27660 @smallexample
27661 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
27662 @end smallexample
27663
27664 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
27665 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
27666 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
27667
27668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27669
27670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
27671
27672 @subsubheading Example
27673
27674 @smallexample
27675 (gdb)
27676 -target-detach
27677 ^done
27678 (gdb)
27679 @end smallexample
27680
27681
27682 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
27683 @findex -target-disconnect
27684
27685 @subsubheading Synopsis
27686
27687 @smallexample
27688 -target-disconnect
27689 @end smallexample
27690
27691 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
27692 generally not resumed.
27693
27694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27695
27696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
27697
27698 @subsubheading Example
27699
27700 @smallexample
27701 (gdb)
27702 -target-disconnect
27703 ^done
27704 (gdb)
27705 @end smallexample
27706
27707
27708 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
27709 @findex -target-download
27710
27711 @subsubheading Synopsis
27712
27713 @smallexample
27714 -target-download
27715 @end smallexample
27716
27717 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
27718 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
27719
27720 @table @samp
27721 @item section
27722 The name of the section.
27723 @item section-sent
27724 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
27725 @item section-size
27726 The size of the section.
27727 @item total-sent
27728 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
27729 @item total-size
27730 The size of the overall executable to download.
27731 @end table
27732
27733 @noindent
27734 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
27735 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
27736
27737 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
27738 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
27739
27740 @table @samp
27741 @item section
27742 The name of the section.
27743 @item section-size
27744 The size of the section.
27745 @item total-size
27746 The size of the overall executable to download.
27747 @end table
27748
27749 @noindent
27750 At the end, a summary is printed.
27751
27752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27753
27754 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
27755
27756 @subsubheading Example
27757
27758 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
27759 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
27760
27761 @smallexample
27762 (gdb)
27763 -target-download
27764 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
27765 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
27766 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
27767 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
27768 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
27769 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
27770 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
27771 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
27772 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
27773 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
27774 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
27775 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
27776 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
27777 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
27778 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
27779 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
27780 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
27781 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
27782 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
27783 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
27784 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
27785 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
27786 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
27787 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
27788 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
27789 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
27790 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
27791 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
27792 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
27793 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
27794 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
27795 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
27796 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
27797 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
27798 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
27799 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
27800 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
27801 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
27802 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
27803 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
27804 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
27805 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
27806 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
27807 write-rate="429"
27808 (gdb)
27809 @end smallexample
27810
27811
27812 @ignore
27813 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
27814 @findex -target-exec-status
27815
27816 @subsubheading Synopsis
27817
27818 @smallexample
27819 -target-exec-status
27820 @end smallexample
27821
27822 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
27823 not, for instance).
27824
27825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27826
27827 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27828
27829 @subsubheading Example
27830 N.A.
27831
27832
27833 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
27834 @findex -target-list-available-targets
27835
27836 @subsubheading Synopsis
27837
27838 @smallexample
27839 -target-list-available-targets
27840 @end smallexample
27841
27842 List the possible targets to connect to.
27843
27844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27845
27846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
27847
27848 @subsubheading Example
27849 N.A.
27850
27851
27852 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
27853 @findex -target-list-current-targets
27854
27855 @subsubheading Synopsis
27856
27857 @smallexample
27858 -target-list-current-targets
27859 @end smallexample
27860
27861 Describe the current target.
27862
27863 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27864
27865 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
27866 other things).
27867
27868 @subsubheading Example
27869 N.A.
27870
27871
27872 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
27873 @findex -target-list-parameters
27874
27875 @subsubheading Synopsis
27876
27877 @smallexample
27878 -target-list-parameters
27879 @end smallexample
27880
27881 @c ????
27882 @end ignore
27883
27884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27885
27886 No equivalent.
27887
27888 @subsubheading Example
27889 N.A.
27890
27891
27892 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
27893 @findex -target-select
27894
27895 @subsubheading Synopsis
27896
27897 @smallexample
27898 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
27899 @end smallexample
27900
27901 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
27902
27903 @table @samp
27904 @item @var{type}
27905 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
27906 @item @var{parameters}
27907 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
27908 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
27909 @end table
27910
27911 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
27912 which the target program is, in the following form:
27913
27914 @smallexample
27915 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
27916 args=[@var{arg list}]
27917 @end smallexample
27918
27919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27920
27921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
27922
27923 @subsubheading Example
27924
27925 @smallexample
27926 (gdb)
27927 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
27928 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
27929 (gdb)
27930 @end smallexample
27931
27932 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27933 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
27934 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
27935
27936
27937 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
27938 @findex -target-file-put
27939
27940 @subsubheading Synopsis
27941
27942 @smallexample
27943 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
27944 @end smallexample
27945
27946 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
27947 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
27948
27949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27950
27951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
27952
27953 @subsubheading Example
27954
27955 @smallexample
27956 (gdb)
27957 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
27958 ^done
27959 (gdb)
27960 @end smallexample
27961
27962
27963 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
27964 @findex -target-file-get
27965
27966 @subsubheading Synopsis
27967
27968 @smallexample
27969 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
27970 @end smallexample
27971
27972 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
27973 on the host system.
27974
27975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27976
27977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
27978
27979 @subsubheading Example
27980
27981 @smallexample
27982 (gdb)
27983 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
27984 ^done
27985 (gdb)
27986 @end smallexample
27987
27988
27989 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
27990 @findex -target-file-delete
27991
27992 @subsubheading Synopsis
27993
27994 @smallexample
27995 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
27996 @end smallexample
27997
27998 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
27999
28000 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28001
28002 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
28003
28004 @subsubheading Example
28005
28006 @smallexample
28007 (gdb)
28008 -target-file-delete remotefile
28009 ^done
28010 (gdb)
28011 @end smallexample
28012
28013
28014 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28015 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
28016 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
28017
28018 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
28019
28020 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
28021 @findex -gdb-exit
28022
28023 @subsubheading Synopsis
28024
28025 @smallexample
28026 -gdb-exit
28027 @end smallexample
28028
28029 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
28030
28031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28032
28033 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
28034
28035 @subsubheading Example
28036
28037 @smallexample
28038 (gdb)
28039 -gdb-exit
28040 ^exit
28041 @end smallexample
28042
28043
28044 @ignore
28045 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
28046 @findex -exec-abort
28047
28048 @subsubheading Synopsis
28049
28050 @smallexample
28051 -exec-abort
28052 @end smallexample
28053
28054 Kill the inferior running program.
28055
28056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28057
28058 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
28059
28060 @subsubheading Example
28061 N.A.
28062 @end ignore
28063
28064
28065 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
28066 @findex -gdb-set
28067
28068 @subsubheading Synopsis
28069
28070 @smallexample
28071 -gdb-set
28072 @end smallexample
28073
28074 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
28075 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
28076
28077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28078
28079 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
28080
28081 @subsubheading Example
28082
28083 @smallexample
28084 (gdb)
28085 -gdb-set $foo=3
28086 ^done
28087 (gdb)
28088 @end smallexample
28089
28090
28091 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
28092 @findex -gdb-show
28093
28094 @subsubheading Synopsis
28095
28096 @smallexample
28097 -gdb-show
28098 @end smallexample
28099
28100 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
28101
28102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28103
28104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
28105
28106 @subsubheading Example
28107
28108 @smallexample
28109 (gdb)
28110 -gdb-show annotate
28111 ^done,value="0"
28112 (gdb)
28113 @end smallexample
28114
28115 @c @subheading -gdb-source
28116
28117
28118 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
28119 @findex -gdb-version
28120
28121 @subsubheading Synopsis
28122
28123 @smallexample
28124 -gdb-version
28125 @end smallexample
28126
28127 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
28128
28129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28130
28131 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
28132 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
28133
28134 @subsubheading Example
28135
28136 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
28137 @c box in TeX.
28138 @smallexample
28139 (gdb)
28140 -gdb-version
28141 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
28142 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
28143 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
28144 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
28145 ~ certain conditions.
28146 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
28147 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
28148 ~ details.
28149 ~This GDB was configured as
28150 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
28151 ^done
28152 (gdb)
28153 @end smallexample
28154
28155 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
28156 @findex -list-features
28157
28158 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
28159 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
28160 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
28161 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
28162 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
28163 startup.
28164
28165 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
28166 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
28167 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
28168 is given below.
28169
28170 Example output:
28171
28172 @smallexample
28173 (gdb) -list-features
28174 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
28175 @end smallexample
28176
28177 The current list of features is:
28178
28179 @table @samp
28180 @item frozen-varobjs
28181 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
28182 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
28183 of @code{-varobj-create}.
28184 @item pending-breakpoints
28185 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
28186 @item python
28187 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
28188 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
28189 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
28190 @item thread-info
28191 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
28192
28193 @end table
28194
28195 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
28196 @findex -list-target-features
28197
28198 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
28199 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
28200 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
28201 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
28202 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
28203 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
28204 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
28205 Example output:
28206
28207 @smallexample
28208 (gdb) -list-features
28209 ^done,result=["async"]
28210 @end smallexample
28211
28212 The current list of features is:
28213
28214 @table @samp
28215 @item async
28216 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
28217 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
28218 while the target is running.
28219
28220 @end table
28221
28222 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
28223 @findex -list-thread-groups
28224
28225 @subheading Synopsis
28226
28227 @smallexample
28228 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
28229 @end smallexample
28230
28231 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
28232 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
28233 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
28234 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
28235 top-level thread groups.
28236
28237 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
28238 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
28239 available on the target.
28240
28241 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
28242 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
28243 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
28244 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
28245 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
28246 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
28247 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
28248 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
28249
28250 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
28251 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
28252 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
28253 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
28254 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
28255 @samp{threads} field.
28256
28257 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
28258 the following caveats:
28259
28260 @itemize @bullet
28261 @item
28262 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
28263 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
28264 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
28265
28266 @item
28267 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
28268 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
28269 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
28270 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
28271 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
28272 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
28273
28274 @end itemize
28275
28276 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
28277 have the following fields:
28278
28279 @table @code
28280 @item id
28281 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
28282 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
28283 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
28284
28285 @item type
28286 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
28287 valid type.
28288
28289 @item pid
28290 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
28291 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
28292
28293 @item num_children
28294 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
28295 absent for an available thread group.
28296
28297 @item threads
28298 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
28299 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
28300 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
28301
28302 @item cores
28303 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
28304 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
28305 such information is not available.
28306
28307 @item executable
28308 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
28309 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
28310 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
28311
28312 @end table
28313
28314 @subheading Example
28315
28316 @smallexample
28317 @value{GDBP}
28318 -list-thread-groups
28319 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
28320 -list-thread-groups 17
28321 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28322 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
28323 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28324 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28325 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
28326 -list-thread-groups --available
28327 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
28328 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
28329 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
28330 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
28331 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
28332 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
28333 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
28334 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
28335 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
28336 @end smallexample
28337
28338
28339 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
28340 @findex -add-inferior
28341
28342 @subheading Synopsis
28343
28344 @smallexample
28345 -add-inferior
28346 @end smallexample
28347
28348 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
28349 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
28350 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
28351 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
28352 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
28353 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
28354
28355 @subheading Example
28356
28357 @smallexample
28358 @value{GDBP}
28359 -add-inferior
28360 ^done,thread-group="i3"
28361 @end smallexample
28362
28363 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
28364 @findex -interpreter-exec
28365
28366 @subheading Synopsis
28367
28368 @smallexample
28369 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
28370 @end smallexample
28371 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
28372
28373 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
28374
28375 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28376
28377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
28378
28379 @subheading Example
28380
28381 @smallexample
28382 (gdb)
28383 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
28384 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
28385 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
28386 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
28387 ^done
28388 (gdb)
28389 @end smallexample
28390
28391 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
28392 @findex -inferior-tty-set
28393
28394 @subheading Synopsis
28395
28396 @smallexample
28397 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
28398 @end smallexample
28399
28400 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
28401
28402 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28403
28404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
28405
28406 @subheading Example
28407
28408 @smallexample
28409 (gdb)
28410 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
28411 ^done
28412 (gdb)
28413 @end smallexample
28414
28415 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
28416 @findex -inferior-tty-show
28417
28418 @subheading Synopsis
28419
28420 @smallexample
28421 -inferior-tty-show
28422 @end smallexample
28423
28424 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
28425
28426 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28427
28428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
28429
28430 @subheading Example
28431
28432 @smallexample
28433 (gdb)
28434 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
28435 ^done
28436 (gdb)
28437 -inferior-tty-show
28438 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
28439 (gdb)
28440 @end smallexample
28441
28442 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
28443 @findex -enable-timings
28444
28445 @subheading Synopsis
28446
28447 @smallexample
28448 -enable-timings [yes | no]
28449 @end smallexample
28450
28451 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
28452 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
28453 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
28454 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
28455
28456 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28457
28458 No equivalent.
28459
28460 @subheading Example
28461
28462 @smallexample
28463 (gdb)
28464 -enable-timings
28465 ^done
28466 (gdb)
28467 -break-insert main
28468 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28469 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28470 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
28471 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
28472 (gdb)
28473 -enable-timings no
28474 ^done
28475 (gdb)
28476 -exec-run
28477 ^running
28478 (gdb)
28479 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28480 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
28481 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
28482 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
28483 (gdb)
28484 @end smallexample
28485
28486 @node Annotations
28487 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
28488
28489 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
28490 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
28491 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
28492 relatively high level.
28493
28494 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
28495 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
28496
28497 @ignore
28498 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
28499 @end ignore
28500
28501 @menu
28502 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
28503 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
28504 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
28505 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
28506 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
28507 * Annotations for Running::
28508 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
28509 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
28510 @end menu
28511
28512 @node Annotations Overview
28513 @section What is an Annotation?
28514 @cindex annotations
28515
28516 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
28517 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
28518 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
28519 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
28520 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
28521 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
28522 cannot contain newline characters.
28523
28524 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
28525 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
28526 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
28527 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
28528 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
28529 means those three characters as output.
28530
28531 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
28532 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
28533 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
28534 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
28535 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
28536 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
28537 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
28538 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
28539 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
28540
28541 @table @code
28542 @kindex set annotate
28543 @item set annotate @var{level}
28544 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
28545 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
28546
28547 @item show annotate
28548 @kindex show annotate
28549 Show the current annotation level.
28550 @end table
28551
28552 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
28553
28554 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
28555
28556 @smallexample
28557 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
28558 GNU gdb 6.0
28559 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
28560 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
28561 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
28562 under certain conditions.
28563 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
28564 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
28565 for details.
28566 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
28567
28568 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
28569 (@value{GDBP})
28570 ^Z^Zprompt
28571 @kbd{quit}
28572
28573 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
28574 $
28575 @end smallexample
28576
28577 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
28578 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
28579 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
28580 output from @value{GDBN}.
28581
28582 @node Server Prefix
28583 @section The Server Prefix
28584 @cindex server prefix
28585
28586 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
28587 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
28588 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
28589 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
28590 a transparent manner.
28591
28592 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
28593 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
28594 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
28595 @code{print} command.
28596
28597 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
28598 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
28599
28600 @node Prompting
28601 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
28602
28603 @cindex annotations for prompts
28604 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
28605 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
28606 over, etc.
28607
28608 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
28609 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
28610 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
28611 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
28612 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
28613 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
28614 features the following annotations:
28615
28616 @smallexample
28617 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
28618 ^Z^Zprompt
28619 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
28620 @end smallexample
28621
28622 The input types are
28623
28624 @table @code
28625 @findex pre-prompt annotation
28626 @findex prompt annotation
28627 @findex post-prompt annotation
28628 @item prompt
28629 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
28630
28631 @findex pre-commands annotation
28632 @findex commands annotation
28633 @findex post-commands annotation
28634 @item commands
28635 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
28636 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
28637
28638 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
28639 @findex overload-choice annotation
28640 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
28641 @item overload-choice
28642 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
28643
28644 @findex pre-query annotation
28645 @findex query annotation
28646 @findex post-query annotation
28647 @item query
28648 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
28649
28650 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
28651 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
28652 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
28653 @item prompt-for-continue
28654 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
28655 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
28656 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
28657 presence of annotations.
28658 @end table
28659
28660 @node Errors
28661 @section Errors
28662 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
28663
28664 @findex quit annotation
28665 @smallexample
28666 ^Z^Zquit
28667 @end smallexample
28668
28669 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
28670
28671 @findex error annotation
28672 @smallexample
28673 ^Z^Zerror
28674 @end smallexample
28675
28676 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
28677
28678 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
28679 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
28680 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
28681 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
28682 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
28683 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
28684 to the top level.
28685
28686 @findex error-begin annotation
28687 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
28688
28689 @smallexample
28690 ^Z^Zerror-begin
28691 @end smallexample
28692
28693 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
28694 message.
28695
28696 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
28697 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
28698 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
28699
28700 @node Invalidation
28701 @section Invalidation Notices
28702
28703 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
28704 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
28705 changed.
28706
28707 @table @code
28708 @findex frames-invalid annotation
28709 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
28710
28711 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
28712 have changed.
28713
28714 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
28715 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
28716
28717 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
28718 deleted a breakpoint.
28719 @end table
28720
28721 @node Annotations for Running
28722 @section Running the Program
28723 @cindex annotations for running programs
28724
28725 @findex starting annotation
28726 @findex stopping annotation
28727 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
28728 @code{step} or @code{continue},
28729
28730 @smallexample
28731 ^Z^Zstarting
28732 @end smallexample
28733
28734 is output. When the program stops,
28735
28736 @smallexample
28737 ^Z^Zstopped
28738 @end smallexample
28739
28740 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
28741 annotations describe how the program stopped.
28742
28743 @table @code
28744 @findex exited annotation
28745 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
28746 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
28747 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
28748
28749 @findex signalled annotation
28750 @findex signal-name annotation
28751 @findex signal-name-end annotation
28752 @findex signal-string annotation
28753 @findex signal-string-end annotation
28754 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
28755 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
28756 annotation continues:
28757
28758 @smallexample
28759 @var{intro-text}
28760 ^Z^Zsignal-name
28761 @var{name}
28762 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
28763 @var{middle-text}
28764 ^Z^Zsignal-string
28765 @var{string}
28766 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
28767 @var{end-text}
28768 @end smallexample
28769
28770 @noindent
28771 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
28772 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
28773 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
28774 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
28775 user's benefit and have no particular format.
28776
28777 @findex signal annotation
28778 @item ^Z^Zsignal
28779 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
28780 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
28781 terminated with it.
28782
28783 @findex breakpoint annotation
28784 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
28785 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
28786
28787 @findex watchpoint annotation
28788 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
28789 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
28790 @end table
28791
28792 @node Source Annotations
28793 @section Displaying Source
28794 @cindex annotations for source display
28795
28796 @findex source annotation
28797 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
28798
28799 @smallexample
28800 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
28801 @end smallexample
28802
28803 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
28804 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
28805 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
28806 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
28807 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
28808 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
28809 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
28810 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
28811 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
28812 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
28813 depend on the language).
28814
28815 @node JIT Interface
28816 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
28817 @cindex just-in-time compilation
28818 @cindex JIT compilation interface
28819
28820 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
28821 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
28822 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
28823 performance while maintaining platform independence.
28824
28825 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
28826 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
28827 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
28828 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
28829 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
28830 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
28831
28832 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
28833 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
28834 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
28835 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
28836 LLVM JIT.
28837
28838 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
28839 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
28840 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
28841 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
28842 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
28843 out about additional code.
28844
28845 @menu
28846 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
28847 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
28848 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
28849 @end menu
28850
28851 @node Declarations
28852 @section JIT Declarations
28853
28854 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
28855 implement the interface:
28856
28857 @smallexample
28858 typedef enum
28859 @{
28860 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
28861 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
28862 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
28863 @} jit_actions_t;
28864
28865 struct jit_code_entry
28866 @{
28867 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
28868 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
28869 const char *symfile_addr;
28870 uint64_t symfile_size;
28871 @};
28872
28873 struct jit_descriptor
28874 @{
28875 uint32_t version;
28876 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
28877 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
28878 uint32_t action_flag;
28879 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
28880 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
28881 @};
28882
28883 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
28884 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
28885
28886 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
28887 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
28888 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
28889 @end smallexample
28890
28891 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
28892 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
28893 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
28894
28895 @node Registering Code
28896 @section Registering Code
28897
28898 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
28899
28900 @itemize @bullet
28901 @item
28902 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
28903 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
28904
28905 @item
28906 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
28907 file.
28908
28909 @item
28910 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
28911
28912 @item
28913 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
28914
28915 @item
28916 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
28917 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
28918 @end itemize
28919
28920 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
28921 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
28922 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
28923 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
28924
28925 @node Unregistering Code
28926 @section Unregistering Code
28927
28928 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
28929
28930 @itemize @bullet
28931 @item
28932 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
28933
28934 @item
28935 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
28936
28937 @item
28938 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
28939 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
28940 @end itemize
28941
28942 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
28943 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
28944
28945 @node GDB Bugs
28946 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
28947 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
28948 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
28949
28950 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
28951
28952 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
28953 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
28954 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
28955 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
28956
28957 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
28958 information that enables us to fix the bug.
28959
28960 @menu
28961 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
28962 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
28963 @end menu
28964
28965 @node Bug Criteria
28966 @section Have You Found a Bug?
28967 @cindex bug criteria
28968
28969 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
28970
28971 @itemize @bullet
28972 @cindex fatal signal
28973 @cindex debugger crash
28974 @cindex crash of debugger
28975 @item
28976 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
28977 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
28978
28979 @cindex error on valid input
28980 @item
28981 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
28982 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
28983 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
28984
28985 @cindex invalid input
28986 @item
28987 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
28988 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
28989 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
28990 for traditional practice''.
28991
28992 @item
28993 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
28994 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
28995 @end itemize
28996
28997 @node Bug Reporting
28998 @section How to Report Bugs
28999 @cindex bug reports
29000 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
29001
29002 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
29003 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
29004 contact that organization first.
29005
29006 You can find contact information for many support companies and
29007 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
29008 distribution.
29009 @c should add a web page ref...
29010
29011 @ifset BUGURL
29012 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
29013 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
29014 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
29015 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
29016 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
29017 be used.
29018
29019 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
29020 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
29021 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
29022 @samp{bug-gdb}.
29023
29024 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
29025 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
29026 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
29027 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
29028 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
29029 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
29030 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
29031 bug reports to the mailing list.
29032 @end ifset
29033 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
29034 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
29035 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
29036 @end ifclear
29037 @end ifset
29038
29039 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
29040 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
29041 fact or leave it out, state it!
29042
29043 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
29044 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
29045 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
29046 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
29047 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
29048 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
29049 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
29050 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
29051 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
29052
29053 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
29054 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
29055 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
29056 self-contained.
29057
29058 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
29059 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
29060 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
29061 bugs properly.
29062
29063 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
29064
29065 @itemize @bullet
29066 @item
29067 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
29068 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
29069 version}.
29070
29071 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
29072 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
29073
29074 @item
29075 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
29076 version number.
29077
29078 @item
29079 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
29080 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
29081
29082 @item
29083 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
29084 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
29085 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
29086 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
29087 those compilers.
29088
29089 @item
29090 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
29091 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
29092 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
29093 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
29094
29095 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
29096 and then we might not encounter the bug.
29097
29098 @item
29099 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
29100 reproduce the bug.
29101
29102 @item
29103 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
29104 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
29105
29106 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
29107 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
29108 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
29109 a chance to make a mistake.
29110
29111 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
29112 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
29113 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
29114 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
29115 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
29116 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
29117 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
29118 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
29119
29120 @pindex script
29121 @cindex recording a session script
29122 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
29123 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
29124 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
29125 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
29126
29127 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
29128 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
29129
29130 @item
29131 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
29132 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
29133 it by context, not by line number.
29134
29135 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
29136 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
29137
29138 @end itemize
29139
29140 Here are some things that are not necessary:
29141
29142 @itemize @bullet
29143 @item
29144 A description of the envelope of the bug.
29145
29146 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
29147 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
29148 changes will not affect it.
29149
29150 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
29151 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
29152 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
29153 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
29154
29155 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
29156 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
29157 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
29158 less time, and so on.
29159
29160 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
29161 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
29162
29163 @item
29164 A patch for the bug.
29165
29166 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
29167 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
29168 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
29169 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
29170
29171 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
29172 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
29173 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
29174 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
29175
29176 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
29177 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
29178 help us to understand.
29179
29180 @item
29181 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
29182
29183 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
29184 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
29185 @end itemize
29186
29187 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
29188 @c and consists of the two following files:
29189 @c rluser.texinfo
29190 @c inc-hist.texinfo
29191 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
29192 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
29193 @include rluser.texi
29194 @include inc-hist.texinfo
29195
29196
29197 @node Formatting Documentation
29198 @appendix Formatting Documentation
29199
29200 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
29201 @cindex reference card
29202 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
29203 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
29204 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
29205 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
29206 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
29207 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
29208
29209 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
29210 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
29211
29212 @smallexample
29213 make refcard.dvi
29214 @end smallexample
29215
29216 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
29217 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
29218 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
29219 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
29220 your @sc{dvi} output program.
29221
29222 @cindex documentation
29223
29224 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
29225 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
29226 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
29227 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
29228 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
29229 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
29230
29231 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
29232 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
29233 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
29234 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
29235 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
29236 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
29237 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
29238 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
29239
29240 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
29241 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
29242 @code{makeinfo}.
29243
29244 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
29245 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
29246 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
29247
29248 @smallexample
29249 cd gdb
29250 make gdb.info
29251 @end smallexample
29252
29253 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
29254 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
29255 Texinfo definitions file.
29256
29257 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
29258 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
29259 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
29260 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
29261 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
29262 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
29263 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
29264
29265 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
29266 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
29267 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
29268 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
29269 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
29270 directory.
29271
29272 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
29273 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
29274 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
29275 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
29276
29277 @smallexample
29278 make gdb.dvi
29279 @end smallexample
29280
29281 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
29282
29283 @node Installing GDB
29284 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
29285 @cindex installation
29286
29287 @menu
29288 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
29289 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
29290 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
29291 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
29292 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
29293 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
29294 @end menu
29295
29296 @node Requirements
29297 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
29298 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
29299
29300 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
29301 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
29302
29303 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
29304 @table @asis
29305 @item ISO C90 compiler
29306 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
29307 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
29308
29309 @end table
29310
29311 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
29312 @table @asis
29313 @item Expat
29314 @anchor{Expat}
29315 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
29316 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
29317 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
29318 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
29319 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
29320 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
29321
29322 Expat is used for:
29323
29324 @itemize @bullet
29325 @item
29326 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
29327 @item
29328 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
29329 @item
29330 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
29331 @item
29332 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
29333 @end itemize
29334
29335 @item zlib
29336 @cindex compressed debug sections
29337 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
29338 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
29339 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
29340 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
29341 information in such binaries.
29342
29343 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
29344 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
29345 @url{http://zlib.net}.
29346
29347 @item iconv
29348 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
29349 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
29350 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
29351 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
29352
29353 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
29354 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
29355 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
29356
29357 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
29358 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
29359 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
29360 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
29361 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
29362 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
29363 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
29364 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
29365 @end table
29366
29367 @node Running Configure
29368 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
29369 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
29370 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
29371 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
29372 build the @code{gdb} program.
29373 @iftex
29374 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
29375 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
29376 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
29377 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
29378 @end iftex
29379
29380 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
29381 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
29382 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
29383
29384 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
29385 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
29386
29387 @table @code
29388 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
29389 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
29390
29391 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
29392 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
29393
29394 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
29395 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
29396
29397 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
29398 @sc{gnu} include files
29399
29400 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
29401 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
29402
29403 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
29404 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
29405
29406 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
29407 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
29408
29409 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
29410 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
29411
29412 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
29413 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
29414 @end table
29415
29416 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
29417 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
29418 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
29419
29420 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
29421 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
29422 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
29423 argument.
29424
29425 For example:
29426
29427 @smallexample
29428 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
29429 ./configure @var{host}
29430 make
29431 @end smallexample
29432
29433 @noindent
29434 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
29435 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
29436 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
29437 correct value by examining your system.)
29438
29439 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
29440 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
29441 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
29442 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
29443
29444 @need 750
29445 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
29446 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
29447 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
29448
29449 @smallexample
29450 sh configure @var{host}
29451 @end smallexample
29452
29453 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
29454 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
29455 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
29456 @file{configure}
29457 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
29458 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
29459
29460 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
29461 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
29462 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
29463 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
29464 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
29465 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
29466 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
29467 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
29468 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
29469
29470 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
29471 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
29472 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
29473 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
29474 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
29475
29476 @node Separate Objdir
29477 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
29478
29479 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
29480 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
29481 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
29482 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
29483 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
29484 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
29485 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
29486 program specified there.
29487
29488 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
29489 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
29490 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
29491 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
29492 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
29493 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
29494
29495 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
29496 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
29497
29498 @smallexample
29499 @group
29500 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
29501 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
29502 cd ../gdb-sun4
29503 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
29504 make
29505 @end group
29506 @end smallexample
29507
29508 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
29509 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
29510 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
29511 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
29512 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
29513 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
29514
29515 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
29516 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
29517 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
29518 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
29519 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
29520
29521 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
29522 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
29523 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
29524 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
29525 You specify a cross-debugging target by
29526 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
29527
29528 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
29529 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
29530 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
29531
29532 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
29533 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
29534 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
29535 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
29536 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
29537
29538 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
29539 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
29540 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
29541 with each other.
29542
29543 @node Config Names
29544 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
29545
29546 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
29547 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
29548 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
29549 of information in the following pattern:
29550
29551 @smallexample
29552 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
29553 @end smallexample
29554
29555 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
29556 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
29557 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
29558
29559 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
29560 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
29561 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
29562 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
29563 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
29564 abbreviations---for example:
29565
29566 @smallexample
29567 % sh config.sub i386-linux
29568 i386-pc-linux-gnu
29569 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
29570 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
29571 % sh config.sub hp9k700
29572 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
29573 % sh config.sub sun4
29574 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
29575 % sh config.sub sun3
29576 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
29577 % sh config.sub i986v
29578 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
29579 @end smallexample
29580
29581 @noindent
29582 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
29583 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
29584
29585 @node Configure Options
29586 @section @file{configure} Options
29587
29588 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
29589 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
29590 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
29591 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
29592
29593 @smallexample
29594 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
29595 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
29596 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
29597 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
29598 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
29599 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
29600 @var{host}
29601 @end smallexample
29602
29603 @noindent
29604 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
29605 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
29606 @samp{--}.
29607
29608 @table @code
29609 @item --help
29610 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
29611
29612 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
29613 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
29614 @file{@var{dir}}.
29615
29616 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
29617 Configure the source to install programs under directory
29618 @file{@var{dir}}.
29619
29620 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
29621 @need 2000
29622 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
29623 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
29624 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
29625 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
29626 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
29627 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
29628 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
29629 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
29630 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
29631 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
29632 @var{dirname}.
29633
29634 @item --norecursion
29635 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
29636 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
29637
29638 @item --target=@var{target}
29639 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
29640 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
29641 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
29642
29643 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
29644
29645 @item @var{host} @dots{}
29646 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
29647
29648 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
29649 @end table
29650
29651 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
29652 needed for special purposes only.
29653
29654 @node System-wide configuration
29655 @section System-wide configuration and settings
29656 @cindex system-wide init file
29657
29658 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
29659 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
29660 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
29661
29662 Here is the corresponding configure option:
29663
29664 @table @code
29665 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
29666 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
29667 @var{file}.
29668 @end table
29669
29670 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
29671 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
29672
29673 @itemize @bullet
29674 @item
29675 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
29676 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
29677 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
29678 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
29679 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
29680 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
29681
29682 @item
29683 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
29684 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
29685 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
29686 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
29687 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
29688 @end itemize
29689
29690 @node Maintenance Commands
29691 @appendix Maintenance Commands
29692 @cindex maintenance commands
29693 @cindex internal commands
29694
29695 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
29696 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
29697 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
29698 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
29699 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
29700
29701 @table @code
29702 @kindex maint agent
29703 @kindex maint agent-eval
29704 @item maint agent @var{expression}
29705 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
29706 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
29707 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
29708 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
29709 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
29710 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
29711 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
29712 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
29713 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
29714 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
29715 addition and return the sum.
29716
29717 @kindex maint info breakpoints
29718 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
29719 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
29720 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
29721 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
29722 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
29723 is shown:
29724
29725 @table @code
29726 @item breakpoint
29727 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
29728
29729 @item watchpoint
29730 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
29731
29732 @item longjmp
29733 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
29734 @code{longjmp} calls.
29735
29736 @item longjmp resume
29737 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
29738
29739 @item until
29740 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
29741
29742 @item finish
29743 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
29744
29745 @item shlib events
29746 Shared library events.
29747
29748 @end table
29749
29750 @kindex set displaced-stepping
29751 @kindex show displaced-stepping
29752 @cindex displaced stepping support
29753 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
29754 @item set displaced-stepping
29755 @itemx show displaced-stepping
29756 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
29757 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
29758 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
29759 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
29760 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
29761
29762 @table @code
29763 @item set displaced-stepping on
29764 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
29765 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
29766
29767 @item set displaced-stepping off
29768 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
29769 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
29770
29771 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
29772 @item set displaced-stepping auto
29773 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
29774 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
29775 architecture supports displaced stepping.
29776 @end table
29777
29778 @kindex maint check-symtabs
29779 @item maint check-symtabs
29780 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
29781
29782 @kindex maint cplus first_component
29783 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
29784 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
29785
29786 @kindex maint cplus namespace
29787 @item maint cplus namespace
29788 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
29789
29790 @kindex maint demangle
29791 @item maint demangle @var{name}
29792 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
29793
29794 @kindex maint deprecate
29795 @kindex maint undeprecate
29796 @cindex deprecated commands
29797 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
29798 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
29799 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
29800 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
29801 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
29802 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
29803 the replacement as part of the warning.
29804
29805 @kindex maint dump-me
29806 @item maint dump-me
29807 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
29808 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
29809 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
29810 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
29811
29812 @kindex maint internal-error
29813 @kindex maint internal-warning
29814 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
29815 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
29816 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
29817 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
29818 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
29819 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
29820 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
29821 @value{GDBN} session.
29822
29823 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
29824 used as the text of the error or warning message.
29825
29826 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
29827
29828 @smallexample
29829 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
29830 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
29831 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
29832 debugging may prove unreliable.
29833 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
29834 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
29835 (@value{GDBP})
29836 @end smallexample
29837
29838 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
29839 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
29840
29841 @kindex maint set internal-error
29842 @kindex maint show internal-error
29843 @kindex maint set internal-warning
29844 @kindex maint show internal-warning
29845 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
29846 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
29847 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
29848 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
29849 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
29850 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
29851 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
29852 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
29853 described in the table below.
29854
29855 @table @samp
29856 @item quit
29857 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
29858 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
29859
29860 @item corefile
29861 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
29862 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
29863 @end table
29864
29865 @kindex maint packet
29866 @item maint packet @var{text}
29867 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
29868 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
29869 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
29870 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
29871 checksum.
29872
29873 @kindex maint print architecture
29874 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29875 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
29876 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
29877
29878 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
29879 @item maint print c-tdesc
29880 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
29881 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
29882 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
29883
29884 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
29885 @item maint print dummy-frames
29886 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
29887
29888 @smallexample
29889 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
29890 @dots{}
29891 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
29892 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
29893 58 return (a + b);
29894 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
29895 @dots{}
29896 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
29897 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
29898 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
29899 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
29900 (@value{GDBP})
29901 @end smallexample
29902
29903 Takes an optional file parameter.
29904
29905 @kindex maint print registers
29906 @kindex maint print raw-registers
29907 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
29908 @kindex maint print register-groups
29909 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29910 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29911 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29912 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29913 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
29914
29915 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
29916 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
29917 includes the (cooked) value of all registers, including registers which
29918 aren't available on the target nor visible to user; and the
29919 command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
29920 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
29921 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
29922
29923 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
29924 write the information.
29925
29926 @kindex maint print reggroups
29927 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29928 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
29929 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
29930 information.
29931
29932 The register groups info looks like this:
29933
29934 @smallexample
29935 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
29936 Group Type
29937 general user
29938 float user
29939 all user
29940 vector user
29941 system user
29942 save internal
29943 restore internal
29944 @end smallexample
29945
29946 @kindex flushregs
29947 @item flushregs
29948 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
29949
29950 @kindex maint print objfiles
29951 @cindex info for known object files
29952 @item maint print objfiles
29953 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
29954 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
29955 and symtabs.
29956
29957 @kindex maint print section-scripts
29958 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
29959 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
29960 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
29961 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
29962 matching @var{regexp}.
29963 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
29964 and the full path if known.
29965 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
29966
29967 @kindex maint print statistics
29968 @cindex bcache statistics
29969 @item maint print statistics
29970 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
29971 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
29972 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
29973 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
29974 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
29975 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
29976 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
29977 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
29978 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
29979 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
29980 lengths.
29981
29982 @kindex maint print target-stack
29983 @cindex target stack description
29984 @item maint print target-stack
29985 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
29986 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
29987 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
29988 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
29989 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
29990 address.
29991
29992 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
29993 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
29994
29995 @kindex maint print type
29996 @cindex type chain of a data type
29997 @item maint print type @var{expr}
29998 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
29999 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
30000 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
30001 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
30002 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
30003
30004 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
30005 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
30006 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
30007 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
30008 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
30009 information.
30010
30011 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
30012 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
30013 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
30014 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
30015 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
30016 always see the disassembly form.
30017
30018 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
30019
30020 @smallexample
30021 (gdb) info addr argc
30022 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
30023 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
30024 @end smallexample
30025
30026 For more information on these expressions, see
30027 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
30028
30029 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
30030 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
30031 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
30032 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
30033 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
30034
30035 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
30036 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
30037 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
30038 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
30039 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
30040 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
30041 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
30042 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
30043 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
30044
30045 @kindex maint set profile
30046 @kindex maint show profile
30047 @cindex profiling GDB
30048 @item maint set profile
30049 @itemx maint show profile
30050 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
30051
30052 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
30053 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
30054 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
30055 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
30056 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
30057 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
30058 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
30059
30060 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
30061 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
30062
30063 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
30064 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
30065 @cindex hardware debug registers
30066 @item maint set show-debug-regs
30067 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
30068 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
30069 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
30070 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
30071 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
30072 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
30073
30074 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
30075 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
30076 @item maint set show-all-tib
30077 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
30078 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
30079 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
30080 command.
30081
30082 @kindex maint space
30083 @cindex memory used by commands
30084 @item maint space
30085 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
30086 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
30087 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
30088 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
30089 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
30090
30091 @kindex maint time
30092 @cindex time of command execution
30093 @item maint time
30094 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
30095 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
30096 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
30097 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
30098 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
30099 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
30100 it's not possibly currently
30101 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
30102 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
30103
30104 @kindex maint translate-address
30105 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
30106 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
30107 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
30108 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
30109 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
30110 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
30111 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
30112
30113 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
30114 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
30115 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
30116
30117 @end table
30118
30119 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
30120 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
30121
30122 @table @code
30123 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
30124 @kindex set watchdog
30125 @cindex watchdog timer
30126 @cindex timeout for commands
30127 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
30128 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
30129 reports and error and the command is aborted.
30130
30131 @item show watchdog
30132 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
30133 @end table
30134
30135 @node Remote Protocol
30136 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
30137
30138 @menu
30139 * Overview::
30140 * Packets::
30141 * Stop Reply Packets::
30142 * General Query Packets::
30143 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
30144 * Tracepoint Packets::
30145 * Host I/O Packets::
30146 * Interrupts::
30147 * Notification Packets::
30148 * Remote Non-Stop::
30149 * Packet Acknowledgment::
30150 * Examples::
30151 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
30152 * Library List Format::
30153 * Memory Map Format::
30154 * Thread List Format::
30155 @end menu
30156
30157 @node Overview
30158 @section Overview
30159
30160 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
30161 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
30162 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
30163 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
30164
30165 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
30166 transmitted and received data, respectively.
30167
30168 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
30169 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
30170 @cindex remote serial protocol
30171 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
30172 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
30173 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
30174 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
30175 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
30176
30177 @smallexample
30178 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
30179 @end smallexample
30180 @noindent
30181
30182 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
30183 @noindent
30184 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
30185 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
30186 eight bit unsigned checksum).
30187
30188 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
30189 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
30190
30191 @smallexample
30192 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
30193 @end smallexample
30194
30195 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
30196 @noindent
30197 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
30198 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
30199 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
30200
30201 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
30202 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
30203 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
30204 retransmission):
30205
30206 @smallexample
30207 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
30208 <- @code{+}
30209 @end smallexample
30210 @noindent
30211
30212 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
30213 once a connection is established.
30214 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
30215
30216 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
30217 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
30218 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
30219 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
30220 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
30221 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
30222 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
30223
30224 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
30225 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
30226 exceptions).
30227
30228 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
30229 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
30230 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
30231 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
30232
30233 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
30234 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
30235 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
30236
30237 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
30238 @anchor{Binary Data}
30239 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
30240 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
30241 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
30242 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
30243 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
30244 binary data.
30245
30246 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
30247 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
30248 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
30249 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
30250 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
30251 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
30252 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
30253 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
30254 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
30255 (described next).
30256
30257 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
30258 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
30259 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
30260 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
30261 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
30262 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
30263 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
30264 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
30265 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
30266 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
30267 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
30268 3}} more times.
30269
30270 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
30271 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
30272 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
30273 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
30274 @samp{0*"00}.
30275
30276 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
30277 error number. That number is not well defined.
30278
30279 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
30280 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
30281 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
30282 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
30283 on that response.
30284
30285 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
30286 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
30287 optional.
30288
30289 @node Packets
30290 @section Packets
30291
30292 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
30293 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
30294 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
30295 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
30296
30297 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
30298 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
30299 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
30300 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
30301 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
30302 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
30303 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
30304 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
30305 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
30306 @var{baz}.
30307
30308 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
30309 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
30310 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
30311 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
30312 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
30313 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
30314 pick any thread.
30315
30316 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
30317 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
30318 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
30319 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
30320 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
30321 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
30322 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
30323 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
30324 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
30325 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
30326 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
30327 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
30328 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
30329
30330 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
30331 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
30332 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
30333 more information.
30334
30335 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
30336 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
30337
30338 Here are the packet descriptions.
30339
30340 @table @samp
30341
30342 @item !
30343 @cindex @samp{!} packet
30344 @anchor{extended mode}
30345 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
30346 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
30347 debugged.
30348
30349 Reply:
30350 @table @samp
30351 @item OK
30352 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
30353 @end table
30354
30355 @item ?
30356 @cindex @samp{?} packet
30357 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
30358 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
30359 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
30360
30361 Reply:
30362 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30363
30364 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
30365 @cindex @samp{A} packet
30366 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
30367 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
30368 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
30369
30370 Reply:
30371 @table @samp
30372 @item OK
30373 The arguments were set.
30374 @item E @var{NN}
30375 An error occurred.
30376 @end table
30377
30378 @item b @var{baud}
30379 @cindex @samp{b} packet
30380 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
30381 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
30382
30383 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
30384 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
30385 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
30386
30387 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
30388 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
30389 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
30390 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
30391 of view, nothing actually happened.}
30392
30393 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
30394 @cindex @samp{B} packet
30395 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
30396 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
30397
30398 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
30399 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
30400
30401 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
30402 @anchor{bc}
30403 @item bc
30404 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
30405 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30406
30407 Reply:
30408 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30409
30410 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
30411 @anchor{bs}
30412 @item bs
30413 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
30414 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30415
30416 Reply:
30417 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30418
30419 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
30420 @cindex @samp{c} packet
30421 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
30422 resume at current address.
30423
30424 Reply:
30425 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30426
30427 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
30428 @cindex @samp{C} packet
30429 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
30430 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
30431
30432 Reply:
30433 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30434
30435 @item d
30436 @cindex @samp{d} packet
30437 Toggle debug flag.
30438
30439 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
30440 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
30441
30442 @item D
30443 @itemx D;@var{pid}
30444 @cindex @samp{D} packet
30445 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
30446 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
30447 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
30448
30449 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
30450 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
30451 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
30452 big-endian hex string.
30453
30454 Reply:
30455 @table @samp
30456 @item OK
30457 for success
30458 @item E @var{NN}
30459 for an error
30460 @end table
30461
30462 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
30463 @cindex @samp{F} packet
30464 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
30465 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
30466 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
30467
30468 @item g
30469 @anchor{read registers packet}
30470 @cindex @samp{g} packet
30471 Read general registers.
30472
30473 Reply:
30474 @table @samp
30475 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
30476 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
30477 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
30478 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
30479 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
30480 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
30481 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
30482 @item E @var{NN}
30483 for an error.
30484 @end table
30485
30486 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
30487 @cindex @samp{G} packet
30488 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
30489 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
30490
30491 Reply:
30492 @table @samp
30493 @item OK
30494 for success
30495 @item E @var{NN}
30496 for an error
30497 @end table
30498
30499 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
30500 @cindex @samp{H} packet
30501 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
30502 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
30503 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
30504 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
30505 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
30506
30507 Reply:
30508 @table @samp
30509 @item OK
30510 for success
30511 @item E @var{NN}
30512 for an error
30513 @end table
30514
30515 @c FIXME: JTC:
30516 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
30517 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
30518 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
30519 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
30520 @c described. For example:
30521 @c
30522 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
30523 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
30524 @c otherwise returns current registers.
30525 @c
30526 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
30527 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
30528 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
30529
30530 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
30531 @anchor{cycle step packet}
30532 @cindex @samp{i} packet
30533 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
30534 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
30535 step starting at that address.
30536
30537 @item I
30538 @cindex @samp{I} packet
30539 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
30540 step packet}.
30541
30542 @item k
30543 @cindex @samp{k} packet
30544 Kill request.
30545
30546 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
30547 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
30548 thread?)}.
30549
30550 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
30551 @cindex @samp{m} packet
30552 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
30553 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
30554
30555 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
30556 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
30557 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
30558 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
30559 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
30560 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
30561 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
30562 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
30563
30564 Reply:
30565 @table @samp
30566 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
30567 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
30568 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
30569 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
30570 @item E @var{NN}
30571 @var{NN} is errno
30572 @end table
30573
30574 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
30575 @cindex @samp{M} packet
30576 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
30577 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
30578 hexadecimal number.
30579
30580 Reply:
30581 @table @samp
30582 @item OK
30583 for success
30584 @item E @var{NN}
30585 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
30586 written).
30587 @end table
30588
30589 @item p @var{n}
30590 @cindex @samp{p} packet
30591 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
30592 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
30593 register value is encoded.
30594
30595 Reply:
30596 @table @samp
30597 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
30598 the register's value
30599 @item E @var{NN}
30600 for an error
30601 @item
30602 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
30603 @end table
30604
30605 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
30606 @anchor{write register packet}
30607 @cindex @samp{P} packet
30608 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
30609 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
30610 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
30611
30612 Reply:
30613 @table @samp
30614 @item OK
30615 for success
30616 @item E @var{NN}
30617 for an error
30618 @end table
30619
30620 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
30621 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
30622 @cindex @samp{q} packet
30623 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
30624 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
30625 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
30626
30627 @item r
30628 @cindex @samp{r} packet
30629 Reset the entire system.
30630
30631 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
30632
30633 @item R @var{XX}
30634 @cindex @samp{R} packet
30635 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
30636 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
30637
30638 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
30639
30640 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
30641 @cindex @samp{s} packet
30642 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
30643 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
30644
30645 Reply:
30646 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30647
30648 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
30649 @anchor{step with signal packet}
30650 @cindex @samp{S} packet
30651 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
30652 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
30653
30654 Reply:
30655 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30656
30657 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
30658 @cindex @samp{t} packet
30659 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
30660 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
30661 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
30662
30663 @item T @var{thread-id}
30664 @cindex @samp{T} packet
30665 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
30666
30667 Reply:
30668 @table @samp
30669 @item OK
30670 thread is still alive
30671 @item E @var{NN}
30672 thread is dead
30673 @end table
30674
30675 @item v
30676 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
30677 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
30678
30679 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
30680 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
30681 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
30682 The process ID is a
30683 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
30684 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
30685 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
30686
30687 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
30688 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
30689 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
30690 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
30691 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
30692 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
30693 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
30694 @c stopping or restarting threads.
30695
30696 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
30697
30698 Reply:
30699 @table @samp
30700 @item E @var{nn}
30701 for an error
30702 @item @r{Any stop packet}
30703 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
30704 @item OK
30705 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
30706 @end table
30707
30708 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
30709 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
30710 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
30711 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
30712 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
30713 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
30714 in their current state in non-stop mode.
30715 Specifying multiple
30716 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
30717 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
30718
30719 Currently supported actions are:
30720
30721 @table @samp
30722 @item c
30723 Continue.
30724 @item C @var{sig}
30725 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
30726 @item s
30727 Step.
30728 @item S @var{sig}
30729 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
30730 @item t
30731 Stop.
30732 @end table
30733
30734 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
30735 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
30736 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
30737
30738 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
30739 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
30740 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
30741 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
30742 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
30743 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
30744 as an implementation detail.
30745
30746 Reply:
30747 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30748
30749 @item vCont?
30750 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
30751 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
30752
30753 Reply:
30754 @table @samp
30755 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
30756 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
30757 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
30758 @item
30759 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
30760 @end table
30761
30762 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
30763 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
30764 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
30765 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
30766
30767 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
30768 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
30769 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
30770 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
30771 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
30772 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
30773 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
30774 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
30775 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
30776 packet is received.
30777
30778 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
30779 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
30780 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
30781 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
30782 @var{thread-id}.
30783
30784 Reply:
30785 @table @samp
30786 @item OK
30787 for success
30788 @item E @var{NN}
30789 for an error
30790 @end table
30791
30792 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
30793 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
30794 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
30795 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
30796 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
30797 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
30798 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
30799 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
30800 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
30801 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
30802 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
30803 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
30804
30805
30806 Reply:
30807 @table @samp
30808 @item OK
30809 for success
30810 @item E.memtype
30811 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
30812 @item E @var{NN}
30813 for an error
30814 @end table
30815
30816 @item vFlashDone
30817 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
30818 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
30819 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
30820 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
30821 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
30822 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
30823 request is completed.
30824
30825 @item vKill;@var{pid}
30826 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
30827 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
30828 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
30829 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
30830 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
30831
30832 Reply:
30833 @table @samp
30834 @item E @var{nn}
30835 for an error
30836 @item OK
30837 for success
30838 @end table
30839
30840 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
30841 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
30842 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
30843 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
30844 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
30845 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
30846 state.
30847
30848 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
30849
30850 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
30851
30852 Reply:
30853 @table @samp
30854 @item E @var{nn}
30855 for an error
30856 @item @r{Any stop packet}
30857 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
30858 @end table
30859
30860 @item vStopped
30861 @anchor{vStopped packet}
30862 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
30863
30864 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
30865 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
30866
30867 Reply:
30868 @table @samp
30869 @item @r{Any stop packet}
30870 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
30871 @item OK
30872 if there are no unreported stop events
30873 @end table
30874
30875 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
30876 @anchor{X packet}
30877 @cindex @samp{X} packet
30878 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
30879 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
30880 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
30881
30882 Reply:
30883 @table @samp
30884 @item OK
30885 for success
30886 @item E @var{NN}
30887 for an error
30888 @end table
30889
30890 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
30891 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
30892 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
30893 @cindex @samp{z} packet
30894 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
30895 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
30896 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
30897
30898 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
30899 separately.
30900
30901 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
30902 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
30903 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
30904 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
30905 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
30906 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
30907
30908 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30909 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30910 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
30911 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
30912 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
30913 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
30914
30915 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
30916 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
30917 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
30918 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
30919 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
30920 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
30921 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
30922
30923 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
30924 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
30925 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
30926 target, is not defined.}
30927
30928 Reply:
30929 @table @samp
30930 @item OK
30931 success
30932 @item
30933 not supported
30934 @item E @var{NN}
30935 for an error
30936 @end table
30937
30938 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30939 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30940 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
30941 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
30942 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
30943 address @var{addr}.
30944
30945 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
30946 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
30947 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
30948
30949 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
30950 movement.}
30951
30952 Reply:
30953 @table @samp
30954 @item OK
30955 success
30956 @item
30957 not supported
30958 @item E @var{NN}
30959 for an error
30960 @end table
30961
30962 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30963 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30964 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
30965 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
30966 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
30967 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
30968
30969 Reply:
30970 @table @samp
30971 @item OK
30972 success
30973 @item
30974 not supported
30975 @item E @var{NN}
30976 for an error
30977 @end table
30978
30979 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30980 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30981 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
30982 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
30983 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
30984 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
30985
30986 Reply:
30987 @table @samp
30988 @item OK
30989 success
30990 @item
30991 not supported
30992 @item E @var{NN}
30993 for an error
30994 @end table
30995
30996 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30997 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30998 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
30999 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
31000 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
31001 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
31002
31003 Reply:
31004 @table @samp
31005 @item OK
31006 success
31007 @item
31008 not supported
31009 @item E @var{NN}
31010 for an error
31011 @end table
31012
31013 @end table
31014
31015 @node Stop Reply Packets
31016 @section Stop Reply Packets
31017 @cindex stop reply packets
31018
31019 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
31020 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
31021 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
31022 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
31023 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
31024 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
31025 @value{GDBN} source code.
31026
31027 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
31028 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
31029 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
31030 components.
31031
31032 @table @samp
31033
31034 @item S @var{AA}
31035 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
31036 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
31037 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
31038
31039 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
31040 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
31041 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
31042 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
31043 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
31044 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
31045 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
31046 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
31047
31048 @itemize @bullet
31049 @item
31050 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
31051 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
31052 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
31053 two-digit hex number.
31054
31055 @item
31056 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
31057 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
31058
31059 @item
31060 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
31061 the core on which the stop event was detected.
31062
31063 @item
31064 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
31065 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
31066 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
31067 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
31068
31069 @item
31070 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
31071 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
31072 future.
31073 @end itemize
31074
31075 The currently defined stop reasons are:
31076
31077 @table @samp
31078 @item watch
31079 @itemx rwatch
31080 @itemx awatch
31081 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
31082 hex.
31083
31084 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
31085 @item library
31086 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
31087 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
31088 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
31089
31090 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
31091 @item replaylog
31092 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
31093 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
31094 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
31095 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
31096 for more information.
31097 @end table
31098
31099 @item W @var{AA}
31100 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
31101 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
31102 applicable to certain targets.
31103
31104 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
31105 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
31106 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
31107 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
31108
31109 @item X @var{AA}
31110 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
31111 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
31112
31113 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
31114 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
31115 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
31116 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
31117
31118 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
31119 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
31120 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
31121 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
31122 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
31123
31124 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
31125 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
31126 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
31127 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
31128 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
31129 system calls.
31130
31131 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
31132 this very system call.
31133
31134 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
31135 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
31136 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
31137 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
31138 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
31139 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
31140
31141 @end table
31142
31143 @node General Query Packets
31144 @section General Query Packets
31145 @cindex remote query requests
31146
31147 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
31148 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
31149 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
31150 sending information to and from the stub.
31151
31152 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
31153 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
31154 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
31155 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
31156 conventions:
31157
31158 @itemize @bullet
31159 @item
31160 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
31161 @item
31162 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
31163 letter.
31164 @item
31165 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
31166 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
31167 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
31168 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
31169 @end itemize
31170
31171 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
31172 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
31173 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
31174 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
31175 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
31176 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
31177 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
31178 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
31179 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
31180 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
31181 packet.}.
31182
31183 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
31184 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
31185 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
31186 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
31187 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
31188
31189 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
31190
31191 @table @samp
31192
31193 @item qC
31194 @cindex current thread, remote request
31195 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
31196 Return the current thread ID.
31197
31198 Reply:
31199 @table @samp
31200 @item QC @var{thread-id}
31201 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
31202 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
31203 @item @r{(anything else)}
31204 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
31205 @end table
31206
31207 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
31208 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
31209 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
31210 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
31211 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
31212 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
31213 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
31214
31215 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
31216 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
31217 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
31218 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
31219 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
31220 detect trailing zeros.
31221
31222 Reply:
31223 @table @samp
31224 @item E @var{NN}
31225 An error (such as memory fault)
31226 @item C @var{crc32}
31227 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
31228 @end table
31229
31230 @item qfThreadInfo
31231 @itemx qsThreadInfo
31232 @cindex list active threads, remote request
31233 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
31234 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
31235 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
31236 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
31237 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
31238 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
31239 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
31240 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
31241
31242 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
31243
31244 Reply:
31245 @table @samp
31246 @item m @var{thread-id}
31247 A single thread ID
31248 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
31249 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
31250 @item l
31251 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
31252 @end table
31253
31254 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
31255 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
31256 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
31257 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
31258 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
31259 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
31260 fields.
31261
31262 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
31263 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
31264 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
31265 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
31266 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
31267
31268 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
31269 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
31270
31271 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
31272 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
31273 information associated with the variable.)
31274
31275 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
31276 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
31277 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
31278 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
31279 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
31280 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
31281
31282 Reply:
31283 @table @samp
31284 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
31285 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
31286 local storage requested.
31287
31288 @item E @var{nn}
31289 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
31290
31291 @item
31292 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
31293 @end table
31294
31295 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
31296 @cindex get thread information block address
31297 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
31298 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
31299
31300 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
31301
31302 Reply:
31303 @table @samp
31304 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
31305 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
31306 thread information block.
31307
31308 @item E @var{nn}
31309 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
31310 address could not be retrieved.
31311
31312 @item
31313 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
31314 @end table
31315
31316 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
31317 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
31318 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
31319 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
31320 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
31321 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
31322 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
31323
31324 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
31325
31326 Reply:
31327 @table @samp
31328 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
31329 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
31330 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
31331 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
31332 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
31333 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
31334 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
31335 @end table
31336
31337 @item qOffsets
31338 @cindex section offsets, remote request
31339 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
31340 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
31341 image.
31342
31343 Reply:
31344 @table @samp
31345 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
31346 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
31347 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
31348 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
31349 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
31350 segments by the supplied offsets.
31351
31352 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
31353 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
31354 to the @code{Bss} section.}
31355
31356 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
31357 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
31358 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
31359 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
31360 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
31361 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
31362 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
31363 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
31364 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
31365 @end table
31366
31367 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
31368 @cindex thread information, remote request
31369 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
31370 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
31371 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
31372 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
31373
31374 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
31375 (see below).
31376
31377 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
31378
31379 @item QNonStop:1
31380 @item QNonStop:0
31381 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
31382 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
31383 @anchor{QNonStop}
31384 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
31385 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
31386
31387 Reply:
31388 @table @samp
31389 @item OK
31390 The request succeeded.
31391
31392 @item E @var{nn}
31393 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
31394
31395 @item
31396 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
31397 the stub.
31398 @end table
31399
31400 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31401 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31402 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
31403 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
31404
31405 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
31406 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
31407 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
31408 @anchor{QPassSignals}
31409 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
31410 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
31411 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
31412 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
31413 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
31414 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
31415 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
31416 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
31417 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
31418
31419 Reply:
31420 @table @samp
31421 @item OK
31422 The request succeeded.
31423
31424 @item E @var{nn}
31425 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
31426
31427 @item
31428 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
31429 the stub.
31430 @end table
31431
31432 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
31433 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
31434 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31435 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31436
31437 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
31438 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
31439 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
31440 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
31441 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
31442 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
31443 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
31444 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
31445 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
31446
31447 Reply:
31448 @table @samp
31449 @item OK
31450 A command response with no output.
31451 @item @var{OUTPUT}
31452 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
31453 @item E @var{NN}
31454 Indicate a badly formed request.
31455 @item
31456 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
31457 @end table
31458
31459 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
31460 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
31461 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
31462 packets.)
31463
31464 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
31465 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
31466 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
31467 @anchor{qSearch memory}
31468 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
31469 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
31470 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
31471
31472 Reply:
31473 @table @samp
31474 @item 0
31475 The pattern was not found.
31476 @item 1,address
31477 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
31478 @item E @var{NN}
31479 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
31480 @item
31481 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
31482 @end table
31483
31484 @item QStartNoAckMode
31485 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
31486 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
31487 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
31488 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
31489
31490 Reply:
31491 @table @samp
31492 @item OK
31493 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
31494 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
31495 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
31496 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
31497 @item
31498 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
31499 @end table
31500
31501 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
31502 @cindex supported packets, remote query
31503 @cindex features of the remote protocol
31504 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
31505 @anchor{qSupported}
31506 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
31507 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
31508 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
31509 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
31510 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
31511 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
31512 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
31513 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
31514 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
31515 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
31516 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
31517 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
31518 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
31519 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
31520
31521 Reply:
31522 @table @samp
31523 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
31524 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
31525 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
31526 possible forms).
31527 @item
31528 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
31529 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
31530 @end table
31531
31532 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
31533 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
31534 are:
31535
31536 @table @samp
31537 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
31538 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
31539 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
31540 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
31541 @item @var{name}+
31542 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
31543 need an associated value.
31544 @item @var{name}-
31545 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
31546 @item @var{name}?
31547 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
31548 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
31549 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
31550 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
31551 @end table
31552
31553 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
31554 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
31555 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
31556 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
31557 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
31558
31559 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
31560 are defined:
31561
31562 @table @samp
31563 @item multiprocess
31564 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
31565 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
31566 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
31567 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
31568 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
31569
31570 @item xmlRegisters
31571 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
31572 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
31573 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
31574 description.
31575
31576 @item qRelocInsn
31577 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
31578 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
31579 instruction reply packet}).
31580 @end table
31581
31582 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
31583 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
31584 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
31585 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
31586 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
31587 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
31588 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
31589 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
31590 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
31591 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
31592 all the features it supports.
31593
31594 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
31595 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
31596
31597 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
31598 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
31599 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
31600 form response.
31601
31602 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
31603 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
31604 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
31605 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
31606
31607 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
31608 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
31609 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
31610 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
31611 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
31612
31613 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
31614
31615 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
31616 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
31617 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
31618 @item Feature Name
31619 @tab Value Required
31620 @tab Default
31621 @tab Probe Allowed
31622
31623 @item @samp{PacketSize}
31624 @tab Yes
31625 @tab @samp{-}
31626 @tab No
31627
31628 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
31629 @tab No
31630 @tab @samp{-}
31631 @tab Yes
31632
31633 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
31634 @tab No
31635 @tab @samp{-}
31636 @tab Yes
31637
31638 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
31639 @tab No
31640 @tab @samp{-}
31641 @tab Yes
31642
31643 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
31644 @tab No
31645 @tab @samp{-}
31646 @tab Yes
31647
31648 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
31649 @tab No
31650 @tab @samp{-}
31651 @tab Yes
31652
31653 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
31654 @tab No
31655 @tab @samp{-}
31656 @tab Yes
31657
31658 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
31659 @tab No
31660 @tab @samp{-}
31661 @tab Yes
31662
31663 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
31664 @tab No
31665 @tab @samp{-}
31666 @tab Yes
31667
31668 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
31669 @tab No
31670 @tab @samp{-}
31671 @tab Yes
31672
31673
31674 @item @samp{QNonStop}
31675 @tab No
31676 @tab @samp{-}
31677 @tab Yes
31678
31679 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
31680 @tab No
31681 @tab @samp{-}
31682 @tab Yes
31683
31684 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
31685 @tab No
31686 @tab @samp{-}
31687 @tab Yes
31688
31689 @item @samp{multiprocess}
31690 @tab No
31691 @tab @samp{-}
31692 @tab No
31693
31694 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
31695 @tab No
31696 @tab @samp{-}
31697 @tab No
31698
31699 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
31700 @tab No
31701 @tab @samp{-}
31702 @tab No
31703
31704 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
31705 @tab No
31706 @tab @samp{-}
31707 @tab No
31708
31709 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
31710 @tab No
31711 @tab @samp{-}
31712 @tab No
31713
31714 @end multitable
31715
31716 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
31717
31718 @table @samp
31719 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
31720 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
31721 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
31722 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
31723 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
31724 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
31725 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
31726 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
31727 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
31728 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
31729
31730 @item qXfer:auxv:read
31731 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
31732 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
31733
31734 @item qXfer:features:read
31735 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
31736 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
31737
31738 @item qXfer:libraries:read
31739 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
31740 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
31741
31742 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
31743 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
31744 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
31745
31746 @item qXfer:spu:read
31747 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
31748 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
31749
31750 @item qXfer:spu:write
31751 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
31752 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
31753
31754 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
31755 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
31756 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
31757
31758 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
31759 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
31760 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
31761
31762 @item qXfer:threads:read
31763 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
31764 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
31765
31766 @item QNonStop
31767 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
31768 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
31769
31770 @item QPassSignals
31771 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
31772 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
31773
31774 @item QStartNoAckMode
31775 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
31776 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
31777
31778 @item multiprocess
31779 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
31780 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
31781 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
31782 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
31783 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
31784 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
31785 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
31786 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
31787 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
31788 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
31789 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
31790
31791 @item qXfer:osdata:read
31792 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
31793 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
31794
31795 @item ConditionalTracepoints
31796 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
31797 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
31798
31799 @item ReverseContinue
31800 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
31801 (@pxref{bc}).
31802
31803 @item ReverseStep
31804 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
31805 (@pxref{bs}).
31806
31807 @item TracepointSource
31808 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
31809 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
31810
31811 @end table
31812
31813 @item qSymbol::
31814 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
31815 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
31816 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
31817 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
31818
31819 Reply:
31820 @table @samp
31821 @item OK
31822 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
31823 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
31824 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
31825 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
31826 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
31827 below.
31828 @end table
31829
31830 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
31831 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
31832
31833 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
31834 target has previously requested.
31835
31836 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
31837 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
31838 will be empty.
31839
31840 Reply:
31841 @table @samp
31842 @item OK
31843 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
31844 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
31845 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
31846 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
31847 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
31848 @end table
31849
31850 @item qTBuffer
31851 @item QTBuffer
31852 @item QTDisconnected
31853 @itemx QTDP
31854 @itemx QTDPsrc
31855 @itemx QTDV
31856 @itemx qTfP
31857 @itemx qTfV
31858 @itemx QTFrame
31859 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
31860
31861 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
31862 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
31863 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
31864 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
31865 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
31866 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
31867 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
31868 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
31869 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
31870 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
31871 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
31872
31873 Reply:
31874 @table @samp
31875 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
31876 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
31877 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
31878 the thread's attributes.
31879 @end table
31880
31881 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
31882 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
31883 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
31884 packets.)
31885
31886 @item QTSave
31887 @item qTsP
31888 @item qTsV
31889 @itemx QTStart
31890 @itemx QTStop
31891 @itemx QTinit
31892 @itemx QTro
31893 @itemx qTStatus
31894 @itemx qTV
31895 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
31896
31897 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31898 @cindex read special object, remote request
31899 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
31900 @anchor{qXfer read}
31901 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
31902 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
31903 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
31904 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
31905 additional details about what data to access.
31906
31907 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
31908 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
31909 formats, listed below.
31910
31911 @table @samp
31912 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31913 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
31914 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
31915 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
31916
31917 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31918 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31919
31920 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31921 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
31922 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
31923 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
31924 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
31925
31926 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31927 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31928
31929 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31930 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
31931 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
31932 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
31933 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
31934
31935 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
31936 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
31937 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
31938
31939 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31940 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31941
31942 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31943 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
31944 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
31945 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
31946 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
31947
31948 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31949 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31950
31951 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31952 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
31953 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
31954 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
31955 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
31956
31957 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31958 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
31959 (@pxref{qSupported}).
31960
31961 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31962 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
31963 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
31964 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
31965 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
31966 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
31967 in that context to be accessed.
31968
31969 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31970 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
31971 (@pxref{qSupported}).
31972
31973 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31974 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
31975 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
31976 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
31977 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
31978
31979 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31980 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31981
31982 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31983 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
31984 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
31985 @xref{Operating System Information}.
31986
31987 @end table
31988
31989 Reply:
31990 @table @samp
31991 @item m @var{data}
31992 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
31993 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
31994 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
31995 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
31996 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
31997 request.
31998
31999 @item l @var{data}
32000 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
32001 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
32002 than the @var{length} in the request.
32003
32004 @item l
32005 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
32006 There is no more data to be read.
32007
32008 @item E00
32009 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
32010
32011 @item E @var{nn}
32012 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
32013 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
32014
32015 @item
32016 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
32017 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
32018 @end table
32019
32020 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
32021 @cindex write data into object, remote request
32022 @anchor{qXfer write}
32023 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
32024 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
32025 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
32026 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
32027 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
32028 to access.
32029
32030 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
32031 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
32032 formats, listed below.
32033
32034 @table @samp
32035 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
32036 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
32037 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
32038 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
32039 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
32040
32041 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32042 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
32043 (@pxref{qSupported}).
32044
32045 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
32046 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
32047 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
32048 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
32049 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
32050 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
32051 in that context to be accessed.
32052
32053 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32054 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32055 @end table
32056
32057 Reply:
32058 @table @samp
32059 @item @var{nn}
32060 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
32061 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
32062
32063 @item E00
32064 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
32065
32066 @item E @var{nn}
32067 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
32068 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
32069
32070 @item
32071 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
32072 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
32073 @end table
32074
32075 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
32076 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
32077 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
32078 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
32079 must respond with an empty packet.
32080
32081 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
32082 @cindex query attached, remote request
32083 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
32084 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
32085 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
32086 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
32087 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
32088 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
32089 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
32090
32091 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
32092 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
32093 the @code{quit} command.
32094
32095 Reply:
32096 @table @samp
32097 @item 1
32098 The remote server attached to an existing process.
32099 @item 0
32100 The remote server created a new process.
32101 @item E @var{NN}
32102 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
32103 @end table
32104
32105 @end table
32106
32107 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
32108 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
32109
32110 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
32111 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
32112 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
32113
32114 @subsection ARM
32115
32116 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
32117
32118 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
32119
32120 @table @r
32121
32122 @item 2
32123 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
32124
32125 @item 3
32126 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
32127
32128 @item 4
32129 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
32130
32131 @end table
32132
32133 @subsection MIPS
32134
32135 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
32136
32137 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
32138 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
32139 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
32140 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
32141 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
32142 most-significant - least-significant.
32143
32144 @table @r
32145
32146 @item MIPS32
32147
32148 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
32149 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
32150 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
32151
32152 @item MIPS64
32153
32154 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
32155 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
32156 as @code{MIPS32}.
32157
32158 @end table
32159
32160 @node Tracepoint Packets
32161 @section Tracepoint Packets
32162 @cindex tracepoint packets
32163 @cindex packets, tracepoint
32164
32165 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
32166 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32167
32168 @table @samp
32169
32170 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
32171 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
32172 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
32173 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
32174 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
32175 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
32176 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
32177 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
32178 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
32179 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
32180 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
32181 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
32182 actions.
32183
32184 Replies:
32185 @table @samp
32186 @item OK
32187 The packet was understood and carried out.
32188 @item qRelocInsn
32189 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
32190 @item
32191 The packet was not recognized.
32192 @end table
32193
32194 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
32195 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
32196 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
32197 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
32198 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
32199 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
32200 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
32201
32202 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
32203 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
32204 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
32205 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
32206 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
32207 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
32208 tracepoint actions.
32209
32210 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
32211 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
32212 following forms:
32213
32214 @table @samp
32215
32216 @item R @var{mask}
32217 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
32218 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
32219 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
32220 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
32221 not fit in a 32-bit word.
32222
32223 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
32224 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
32225 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
32226 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
32227 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
32228 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
32229 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
32230
32231 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
32232 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
32233 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
32234 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
32235 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
32236 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
32237 packet).
32238
32239 @end table
32240
32241 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
32242 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
32243 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
32244 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
32245 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
32246 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
32247 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
32248 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
32249
32250 Replies:
32251 @table @samp
32252 @item OK
32253 The packet was understood and carried out.
32254 @item qRelocInsn
32255 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
32256 @item
32257 The packet was not recognized.
32258 @end table
32259
32260 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
32261 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
32262 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
32263 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
32264 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
32265 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
32266 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
32267 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
32268
32269 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
32270 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
32271 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
32272 fit in a single packet.
32273 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
32274 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
32275
32276 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
32277 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
32278 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
32279 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
32280
32281 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
32282 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
32283 query packets.
32284
32285 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
32286 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
32287 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
32288 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
32289 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
32290 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
32291 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
32292 be found.
32293
32294 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
32295 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
32296 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
32297 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
32298 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
32299 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
32300 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
32301 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
32302 mentioned in expressions.
32303
32304 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
32305 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
32306 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
32307 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
32308
32309 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
32310 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
32311 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
32312 one of the following forms:
32313
32314 @table @samp
32315 @item F @var{f}
32316 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
32317 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
32318 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
32319
32320 @item T @var{t}
32321 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
32322 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
32323
32324 @end table
32325
32326 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
32327 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
32328 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
32329 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
32330
32331 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
32332 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
32333 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
32334 is a hexadecimal number.
32335
32336 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
32337 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
32338 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
32339 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
32340 numbers.
32341
32342 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
32343 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
32344 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
32345
32346 @item QTStart
32347 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
32348 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
32349 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
32350 instruction reply packet}).
32351
32352 @item QTStop
32353 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
32354
32355 @item QTinit
32356 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
32357
32358 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
32359 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
32360 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
32361 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
32362
32363 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
32364 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
32365 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
32366 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
32367
32368 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
32369 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
32370 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
32371 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
32372 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
32373
32374 @item qTStatus
32375 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
32376
32377 The reply has the form:
32378
32379 @table @samp
32380
32381 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
32382 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
32383 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
32384 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
32385
32386 @end table
32387
32388 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
32389 explanations as one of the optional fields:
32390
32391 @table @samp
32392
32393 @item tnotrun:0
32394 No trace has been run yet.
32395
32396 @item tstop:0
32397 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
32398
32399 @item tfull:0
32400 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
32401
32402 @item tdisconnected:0
32403 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
32404
32405 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
32406 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
32407
32408 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
32409 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
32410 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
32411 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
32412 @var{text} is hex encoded.
32413
32414 @item tunknown:0
32415 The trace stopped for some other reason.
32416
32417 @end table
32418
32419 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
32420 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
32421 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
32422 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
32423 trace.
32424
32425 @table @samp
32426
32427 @item tframes:@var{n}
32428 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
32429
32430 @item tcreated:@var{n}
32431 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
32432 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
32433
32434 @item tsize:@var{n}
32435 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
32436
32437 @item tfree:@var{n}
32438 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
32439
32440 @item circular:@var{n}
32441 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32442 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32443 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32444 and may fill up.
32445
32446 @item disconn:@var{n}
32447 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32448 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32449 that the trace run will stop.
32450
32451 @end table
32452
32453 @item qTV:@var{var}
32454 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
32455 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
32456 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
32457
32458 Replies:
32459 @table @samp
32460 @item V@var{value}
32461 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
32462 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
32463 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
32464 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
32465 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
32466 program is running.
32467
32468 @item U
32469 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
32470 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
32471 was not collected.
32472 @end table
32473
32474 @item qTfP
32475 @itemx qTsP
32476 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
32477 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
32478 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
32479 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
32480 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
32481
32482 @item qTfV
32483 @itemx qTsV
32484 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
32485 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
32486 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
32487 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
32488 trace state variables.
32489
32490 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
32491 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
32492 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
32493 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
32494 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
32495
32496 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
32497 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
32498 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
32499 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
32500 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
32501 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
32502 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
32503 available.
32504
32505 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
32506 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
32507 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
32508
32509 @end table
32510
32511 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
32512 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
32513 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
32514 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
32515 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
32516 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
32517 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
32518 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
32519 it had executed in the original location.
32520
32521 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
32522 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
32523 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
32524 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
32525 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
32526 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
32527 format of the request is:
32528
32529 @table @samp
32530 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
32531
32532 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
32533 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
32534 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
32535 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
32536 memory starting at @var{to}.
32537 @end table
32538
32539 Replies:
32540 @table @samp
32541 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
32542 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
32543 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
32544 @item E @var{NN}
32545 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
32546 relocating the instruction.
32547 @end table
32548
32549 @node Host I/O Packets
32550 @section Host I/O Packets
32551 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
32552 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
32553
32554 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
32555 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
32556 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
32557 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
32558 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
32559 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
32560 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
32561 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
32562 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
32563 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
32564
32565 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
32566 its arguments. They have this format:
32567
32568 @table @samp
32569
32570 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
32571 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
32572 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
32573 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
32574 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
32575 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
32576 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
32577 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
32578 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
32579
32580 @end table
32581
32582 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
32583
32584 @table @samp
32585
32586 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
32587 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
32588 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
32589 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
32590 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
32591 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
32592 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
32593 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
32594 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
32595 @var{attachment}.
32596
32597 @item
32598 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
32599
32600 @end table
32601
32602 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
32603
32604 @table @samp
32605 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
32606 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
32607 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
32608 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
32609 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
32610 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
32611 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
32612
32613 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
32614 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
32615 -1 if an error occurs.
32616
32617 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
32618 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
32619 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
32620 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
32621 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
32622 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
32623 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
32624 @var{count} was zero.
32625
32626 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
32627 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
32628 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
32629 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
32630 some characters were escaped.
32631
32632 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
32633 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
32634 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
32635 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
32636 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
32637 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
32638 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
32639 error occurred.
32640
32641 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
32642 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
32643 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
32644
32645 @end table
32646
32647 @node Interrupts
32648 @section Interrupts
32649 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
32650
32651 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
32652 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
32653 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
32654 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
32655
32656 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
32657 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
32658 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
32659 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
32660 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
32661
32662 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
32663 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
32664 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
32665 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
32666 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
32667 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
32668 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
32669 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
32670
32671 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
32672 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
32673 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
32674
32675 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
32676 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
32677 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
32678 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
32679 currently-executing threads and processes.
32680 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
32681 running program, it should send one of the stop
32682 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
32683 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
32684 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
32685 Interrupts received while the
32686 program is stopped are discarded.
32687
32688 @node Notification Packets
32689 @section Notification Packets
32690 @cindex notification packets
32691 @cindex packets, notification
32692
32693 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
32694 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
32695 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
32696 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
32697 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
32698 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
32699 is not a problem.
32700
32701 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
32702 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
32703 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
32704 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
32705 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
32706 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
32707 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
32708
32709 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
32710 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
32711
32712 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
32713 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
32714 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
32715 not they understand it.
32716
32717 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
32718 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
32719 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
32720 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
32721 recipients.
32722
32723 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
32724 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
32725 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
32726 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
32727 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
32728
32729 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
32730 defined:
32731
32732 @table @samp
32733 @item Stop: @var{reply}
32734 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
32735 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
32736 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
32737 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
32738 @value{GDBN}.
32739 @end table
32740
32741 @node Remote Non-Stop
32742 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
32743
32744 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
32745 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
32746 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
32747 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32748
32749 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
32750 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
32751 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
32752 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
32753 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
32754 probe the target state after a mode change.
32755
32756 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
32757 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
32758 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
32759 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
32760 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
32761 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
32762 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
32763 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
32764 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
32765 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
32766 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
32767
32768 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
32769 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
32770 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
32771 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
32772 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
32773 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
32774 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
32775 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
32776 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
32777 sending any queued stop events.
32778
32779 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
32780 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
32781 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
32782 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
32783 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
32784 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
32785 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
32786
32787 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
32788 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
32789 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
32790 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
32791 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
32792 process normally.
32793
32794 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
32795 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
32796 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
32797 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
32798 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
32799 should process normally.
32800
32801 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
32802 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
32803 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
32804 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
32805 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
32806
32807 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
32808 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
32809 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
32810 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
32811 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
32812 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
32813 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
32814 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
32815 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
32816 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
32817 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
32818 @samp{OK}.
32819
32820 @node Packet Acknowledgment
32821 @section Packet Acknowledgment
32822
32823 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
32824 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
32825 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
32826 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
32827 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
32828 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
32829 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
32830
32831 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
32832 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
32833 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
32834 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
32835 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
32836
32837 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
32838 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
32839 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
32840 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
32841
32842 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
32843 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
32844 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
32845 @pxref{qSupported}.
32846 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
32847 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
32848 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
32849 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
32850 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
32851 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
32852 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
32853
32854 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
32855 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
32856 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
32857 connection.
32858 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
32859 new connection is established,
32860 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
32861 for the current connection, once disabled.
32862
32863 @node Examples
32864 @section Examples
32865
32866 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
32867 does not get any direct output:
32868
32869 @smallexample
32870 -> @code{R00}
32871 <- @code{+}
32872 @emph{target restarts}
32873 -> @code{?}
32874 <- @code{+}
32875 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
32876 -> @code{+}
32877 @end smallexample
32878
32879 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
32880
32881 @smallexample
32882 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
32883 <- @code{+}
32884 -> @code{s}
32885 <- @code{+}
32886 @emph{time passes}
32887 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
32888 -> @code{+}
32889 -> @code{g}
32890 <- @code{+}
32891 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
32892 -> @code{+}
32893 @end smallexample
32894
32895 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
32896 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
32897 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
32898
32899 @menu
32900 * File-I/O Overview::
32901 * Protocol Basics::
32902 * The F Request Packet::
32903 * The F Reply Packet::
32904 * The Ctrl-C Message::
32905 * Console I/O::
32906 * List of Supported Calls::
32907 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
32908 * Constants::
32909 * File-I/O Examples::
32910 @end menu
32911
32912 @node File-I/O Overview
32913 @subsection File-I/O Overview
32914 @cindex file-i/o overview
32915
32916 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
32917 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
32918 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
32919 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
32920 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
32921 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
32922
32923 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
32924 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
32925 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
32926 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
32927 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
32928
32929 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
32930 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
32931 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
32932 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
32933 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
32934 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
32935 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
32936
32937 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
32938 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
32939 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
32940 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
32941 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
32942
32943 @smallexample
32944 (@value{GDBP}) continue
32945 <- target requests 'system call X'
32946 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
32947 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
32948 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
32949 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
32950 @end smallexample
32951
32952 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
32953 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
32954 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
32955 system are not supported by this protocol.
32956
32957 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
32958
32959 @node Protocol Basics
32960 @subsection Protocol Basics
32961 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
32962
32963 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
32964 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
32965 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
32966 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
32967 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
32968 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
32969 to call the appropriate host system call:
32970
32971 @itemize @bullet
32972 @item
32973 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
32974
32975 @item
32976 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
32977 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
32978 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
32979 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
32980
32981 @end itemize
32982
32983 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
32984
32985 @itemize @bullet
32986 @item
32987 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
32988 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
32989 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
32990 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
32991 packet.
32992
32993 @item
32994 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
32995 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
32996
32997 @item
32998 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
32999
33000 @item
33001 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
33002
33003 @item
33004 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
33005 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
33006 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
33007 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
33008 packet.
33009
33010 @end itemize
33011
33012 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
33013 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
33014
33015 @itemize @bullet
33016 @item
33017 Return value.
33018
33019 @item
33020 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
33021
33022 @item
33023 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
33024
33025 @end itemize
33026
33027 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
33028 the latest continue or step action.
33029
33030 @node The F Request Packet
33031 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
33032 @cindex file-i/o request packet
33033 @cindex @code{F} request packet
33034
33035 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
33036
33037 @table @samp
33038 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
33039
33040 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
33041 This is just the name of the function.
33042
33043 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
33044 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
33045 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
33046 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
33047 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
33048 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
33049 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
33050
33051 @end table
33052
33053
33054
33055 @node The F Reply Packet
33056 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
33057 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
33058 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
33059
33060 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
33061
33062 @table @samp
33063
33064 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
33065
33066 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
33067
33068 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
33069 representation.
33070 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
33071
33072 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
33073 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
33074 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
33075
33076 @smallexample
33077 F0,0,C
33078 @end smallexample
33079
33080 @noindent
33081 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
33082
33083 @smallexample
33084 F-1,4,C
33085 @end smallexample
33086
33087 @noindent
33088 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
33089
33090 @end table
33091
33092
33093 @node The Ctrl-C Message
33094 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
33095 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
33096
33097 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
33098 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
33099 the target should behave as if it had
33100 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
33101 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
33102 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
33103 packet.
33104
33105 It's important for the target to know in which
33106 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
33107
33108 @itemize @bullet
33109 @item
33110 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
33111
33112 @item
33113 The system call on the host has been finished.
33114
33115 @end itemize
33116
33117 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
33118 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
33119 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
33120 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
33121 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
33122 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
33123
33124 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
33125 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
33126 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
33127 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
33128 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
33129 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
33130 or the full action has been completed.
33131
33132 @node Console I/O
33133 @subsection Console I/O
33134 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
33135
33136 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
33137 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
33138 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
33139 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
33140 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
33141 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
33142 conditions is met:
33143
33144 @itemize @bullet
33145 @item
33146 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
33147 @code{read}
33148 system call is treated as finished.
33149
33150 @item
33151 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
33152 newline.
33153
33154 @item
33155 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
33156 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
33157
33158 @end itemize
33159
33160 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
33161 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
33162 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
33163 is stopped at the user's request.
33164
33165
33166 @node List of Supported Calls
33167 @subsection List of Supported Calls
33168 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
33169
33170 @menu
33171 * open::
33172 * close::
33173 * read::
33174 * write::
33175 * lseek::
33176 * rename::
33177 * unlink::
33178 * stat/fstat::
33179 * gettimeofday::
33180 * isatty::
33181 * system::
33182 @end menu
33183
33184 @node open
33185 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
33186 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
33187
33188 @table @asis
33189 @item Synopsis:
33190 @smallexample
33191 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
33192 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
33193 @end smallexample
33194
33195 @item Request:
33196 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
33197
33198 @noindent
33199 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
33200
33201 @table @code
33202 @item O_CREAT
33203 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
33204 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
33205 are concerned.
33206
33207 @item O_EXCL
33208 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
33209 an error and open() fails.
33210
33211 @item O_TRUNC
33212 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
33213 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
33214 truncated to zero length.
33215
33216 @item O_APPEND
33217 The file is opened in append mode.
33218
33219 @item O_RDONLY
33220 The file is opened for reading only.
33221
33222 @item O_WRONLY
33223 The file is opened for writing only.
33224
33225 @item O_RDWR
33226 The file is opened for reading and writing.
33227 @end table
33228
33229 @noindent
33230 Other bits are silently ignored.
33231
33232
33233 @noindent
33234 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
33235
33236 @table @code
33237 @item S_IRUSR
33238 User has read permission.
33239
33240 @item S_IWUSR
33241 User has write permission.
33242
33243 @item S_IRGRP
33244 Group has read permission.
33245
33246 @item S_IWGRP
33247 Group has write permission.
33248
33249 @item S_IROTH
33250 Others have read permission.
33251
33252 @item S_IWOTH
33253 Others have write permission.
33254 @end table
33255
33256 @noindent
33257 Other bits are silently ignored.
33258
33259
33260 @item Return value:
33261 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
33262 occurred.
33263
33264 @item Errors:
33265
33266 @table @code
33267 @item EEXIST
33268 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
33269
33270 @item EISDIR
33271 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
33272
33273 @item EACCES
33274 The requested access is not allowed.
33275
33276 @item ENAMETOOLONG
33277 @var{pathname} was too long.
33278
33279 @item ENOENT
33280 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
33281
33282 @item ENODEV
33283 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
33284
33285 @item EROFS
33286 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
33287 write access was requested.
33288
33289 @item EFAULT
33290 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
33291
33292 @item ENOSPC
33293 No space on device to create the file.
33294
33295 @item EMFILE
33296 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
33297
33298 @item ENFILE
33299 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
33300 has been reached.
33301
33302 @item EINTR
33303 The call was interrupted by the user.
33304 @end table
33305
33306 @end table
33307
33308 @node close
33309 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
33310 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
33311
33312 @table @asis
33313 @item Synopsis:
33314 @smallexample
33315 int close(int fd);
33316 @end smallexample
33317
33318 @item Request:
33319 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
33320
33321 @item Return value:
33322 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
33323
33324 @item Errors:
33325
33326 @table @code
33327 @item EBADF
33328 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
33329
33330 @item EINTR
33331 The call was interrupted by the user.
33332 @end table
33333
33334 @end table
33335
33336 @node read
33337 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
33338 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
33339
33340 @table @asis
33341 @item Synopsis:
33342 @smallexample
33343 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
33344 @end smallexample
33345
33346 @item Request:
33347 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
33348
33349 @item Return value:
33350 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
33351 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
33352 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
33353
33354 @item Errors:
33355
33356 @table @code
33357 @item EBADF
33358 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
33359 reading.
33360
33361 @item EFAULT
33362 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33363
33364 @item EINTR
33365 The call was interrupted by the user.
33366 @end table
33367
33368 @end table
33369
33370 @node write
33371 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
33372 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
33373
33374 @table @asis
33375 @item Synopsis:
33376 @smallexample
33377 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
33378 @end smallexample
33379
33380 @item Request:
33381 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
33382
33383 @item Return value:
33384 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
33385 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
33386 is returned.
33387
33388 @item Errors:
33389
33390 @table @code
33391 @item EBADF
33392 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
33393 writing.
33394
33395 @item EFAULT
33396 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33397
33398 @item EFBIG
33399 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
33400 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
33401
33402 @item ENOSPC
33403 No space on device to write the data.
33404
33405 @item EINTR
33406 The call was interrupted by the user.
33407 @end table
33408
33409 @end table
33410
33411 @node lseek
33412 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
33413 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
33414
33415 @table @asis
33416 @item Synopsis:
33417 @smallexample
33418 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
33419 @end smallexample
33420
33421 @item Request:
33422 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
33423
33424 @var{flag} is one of:
33425
33426 @table @code
33427 @item SEEK_SET
33428 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
33429
33430 @item SEEK_CUR
33431 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
33432 bytes.
33433
33434 @item SEEK_END
33435 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
33436 bytes.
33437 @end table
33438
33439 @item Return value:
33440 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
33441 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
33442 value of -1 is returned.
33443
33444 @item Errors:
33445
33446 @table @code
33447 @item EBADF
33448 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
33449
33450 @item ESPIPE
33451 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
33452
33453 @item EINVAL
33454 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
33455
33456 @item EINTR
33457 The call was interrupted by the user.
33458 @end table
33459
33460 @end table
33461
33462 @node rename
33463 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
33464 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
33465
33466 @table @asis
33467 @item Synopsis:
33468 @smallexample
33469 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
33470 @end smallexample
33471
33472 @item Request:
33473 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
33474
33475 @item Return value:
33476 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
33477
33478 @item Errors:
33479
33480 @table @code
33481 @item EISDIR
33482 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
33483 directory.
33484
33485 @item EEXIST
33486 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
33487
33488 @item EBUSY
33489 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
33490 process.
33491
33492 @item EINVAL
33493 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
33494 of itself.
33495
33496 @item ENOTDIR
33497 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
33498 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
33499 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
33500
33501 @item EFAULT
33502 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
33503
33504 @item EACCES
33505 No access to the file or the path of the file.
33506
33507 @item ENAMETOOLONG
33508
33509 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
33510
33511 @item ENOENT
33512 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
33513
33514 @item EROFS
33515 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
33516
33517 @item ENOSPC
33518 The device containing the file has no room for the new
33519 directory entry.
33520
33521 @item EINTR
33522 The call was interrupted by the user.
33523 @end table
33524
33525 @end table
33526
33527 @node unlink
33528 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
33529 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
33530
33531 @table @asis
33532 @item Synopsis:
33533 @smallexample
33534 int unlink(const char *pathname);
33535 @end smallexample
33536
33537 @item Request:
33538 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
33539
33540 @item Return value:
33541 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
33542
33543 @item Errors:
33544
33545 @table @code
33546 @item EACCES
33547 No access to the file or the path of the file.
33548
33549 @item EPERM
33550 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
33551
33552 @item EBUSY
33553 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
33554 being used by another process.
33555
33556 @item EFAULT
33557 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33558
33559 @item ENAMETOOLONG
33560 @var{pathname} was too long.
33561
33562 @item ENOENT
33563 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
33564
33565 @item ENOTDIR
33566 A component of the path is not a directory.
33567
33568 @item EROFS
33569 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
33570
33571 @item EINTR
33572 The call was interrupted by the user.
33573 @end table
33574
33575 @end table
33576
33577 @node stat/fstat
33578 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
33579 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
33580 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
33581
33582 @table @asis
33583 @item Synopsis:
33584 @smallexample
33585 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
33586 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
33587 @end smallexample
33588
33589 @item Request:
33590 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
33591 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
33592
33593 @item Return value:
33594 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
33595
33596 @item Errors:
33597
33598 @table @code
33599 @item EBADF
33600 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
33601
33602 @item ENOENT
33603 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
33604 path is an empty string.
33605
33606 @item ENOTDIR
33607 A component of the path is not a directory.
33608
33609 @item EFAULT
33610 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33611
33612 @item EACCES
33613 No access to the file or the path of the file.
33614
33615 @item ENAMETOOLONG
33616 @var{pathname} was too long.
33617
33618 @item EINTR
33619 The call was interrupted by the user.
33620 @end table
33621
33622 @end table
33623
33624 @node gettimeofday
33625 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
33626 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
33627
33628 @table @asis
33629 @item Synopsis:
33630 @smallexample
33631 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
33632 @end smallexample
33633
33634 @item Request:
33635 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
33636
33637 @item Return value:
33638 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
33639
33640 @item Errors:
33641
33642 @table @code
33643 @item EINVAL
33644 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
33645
33646 @item EFAULT
33647 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33648 @end table
33649
33650 @end table
33651
33652 @node isatty
33653 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
33654 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
33655
33656 @table @asis
33657 @item Synopsis:
33658 @smallexample
33659 int isatty(int fd);
33660 @end smallexample
33661
33662 @item Request:
33663 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
33664
33665 @item Return value:
33666 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
33667
33668 @item Errors:
33669
33670 @table @code
33671 @item EINTR
33672 The call was interrupted by the user.
33673 @end table
33674
33675 @end table
33676
33677 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
33678 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
33679 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
33680 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
33681 needed.
33682
33683
33684 @node system
33685 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
33686 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
33687
33688 @table @asis
33689 @item Synopsis:
33690 @smallexample
33691 int system(const char *command);
33692 @end smallexample
33693
33694 @item Request:
33695 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
33696
33697 @item Return value:
33698 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
33699 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
33700 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
33701 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
33702 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
33703 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
33704 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
33705
33706 @item Errors:
33707
33708 @table @code
33709 @item EINTR
33710 The call was interrupted by the user.
33711 @end table
33712
33713 @end table
33714
33715 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
33716 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
33717 the host is simplified before it's returned
33718 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
33719 is discarded, and the return value consists
33720 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
33721
33722 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
33723 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
33724 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
33725
33726 @table @code
33727 @item set remote system-call-allowed
33728 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
33729 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
33730 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
33731
33732 @item show remote system-call-allowed
33733 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
33734 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
33735 protocol.
33736 @end table
33737
33738 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
33739 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
33740 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
33741
33742 @menu
33743 * Integral Datatypes::
33744 * Pointer Values::
33745 * Memory Transfer::
33746 * struct stat::
33747 * struct timeval::
33748 @end menu
33749
33750 @node Integral Datatypes
33751 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
33752 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
33753
33754 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
33755 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
33756 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
33757
33758 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
33759 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
33760
33761 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
33762
33763 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
33764 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
33765
33766 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
33767
33768 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
33769 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
33770 byte order.
33771
33772 @node Pointer Values
33773 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
33774 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
33775
33776 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
33777 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
33778 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
33779 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
33780
33781 @smallexample
33782 @code{1aaf/12}
33783 @end smallexample
33784
33785 @noindent
33786 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
33787 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
33788 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
33789 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
33790
33791 @smallexample
33792 @code{123456/d}
33793 @end smallexample
33794
33795 @node Memory Transfer
33796 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
33797 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
33798
33799 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
33800 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
33801 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
33802 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
33803 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
33804 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
33805 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
33806
33807
33808 @node struct stat
33809 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
33810 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
33811
33812 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
33813 is defined as follows:
33814
33815 @smallexample
33816 struct stat @{
33817 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
33818 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
33819 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
33820 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
33821 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
33822 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
33823 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
33824 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
33825 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
33826 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
33827 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
33828 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
33829 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
33830 @};
33831 @end smallexample
33832
33833 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
33834 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
33835 structure is of size 64 bytes.
33836
33837 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
33838 range of values.
33839
33840 @table @code
33841
33842 @item st_dev
33843 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
33844
33845 @item st_ino
33846 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
33847
33848 @item st_mode
33849 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
33850 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
33851
33852 @item st_uid
33853 @itemx st_gid
33854 @itemx st_rdev
33855 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
33856
33857 @item st_atime
33858 @itemx st_mtime
33859 @itemx st_ctime
33860 These values have a host and file system dependent
33861 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
33862 support exact timing values.
33863 @end table
33864
33865 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
33866 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
33867 continuing.
33868
33869 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
33870 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
33871 get truncated on the target.
33872
33873 @node struct timeval
33874 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
33875 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
33876
33877 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
33878 is defined as follows:
33879
33880 @smallexample
33881 struct timeval @{
33882 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
33883 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
33884 @};
33885 @end smallexample
33886
33887 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
33888 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
33889 structure is of size 8 bytes.
33890
33891 @node Constants
33892 @subsection Constants
33893 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
33894
33895 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
33896 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
33897 values before and after the call as needed.
33898
33899 @menu
33900 * Open Flags::
33901 * mode_t Values::
33902 * Errno Values::
33903 * Lseek Flags::
33904 * Limits::
33905 @end menu
33906
33907 @node Open Flags
33908 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
33909 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
33910
33911 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
33912
33913 @smallexample
33914 O_RDONLY 0x0
33915 O_WRONLY 0x1
33916 O_RDWR 0x2
33917 O_APPEND 0x8
33918 O_CREAT 0x200
33919 O_TRUNC 0x400
33920 O_EXCL 0x800
33921 @end smallexample
33922
33923 @node mode_t Values
33924 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
33925 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
33926
33927 All values are given in octal representation.
33928
33929 @smallexample
33930 S_IFREG 0100000
33931 S_IFDIR 040000
33932 S_IRUSR 0400
33933 S_IWUSR 0200
33934 S_IXUSR 0100
33935 S_IRGRP 040
33936 S_IWGRP 020
33937 S_IXGRP 010
33938 S_IROTH 04
33939 S_IWOTH 02
33940 S_IXOTH 01
33941 @end smallexample
33942
33943 @node Errno Values
33944 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
33945 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
33946
33947 All values are given in decimal representation.
33948
33949 @smallexample
33950 EPERM 1
33951 ENOENT 2
33952 EINTR 4
33953 EBADF 9
33954 EACCES 13
33955 EFAULT 14
33956 EBUSY 16
33957 EEXIST 17
33958 ENODEV 19
33959 ENOTDIR 20
33960 EISDIR 21
33961 EINVAL 22
33962 ENFILE 23
33963 EMFILE 24
33964 EFBIG 27
33965 ENOSPC 28
33966 ESPIPE 29
33967 EROFS 30
33968 ENAMETOOLONG 91
33969 EUNKNOWN 9999
33970 @end smallexample
33971
33972 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
33973 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
33974
33975 @node Lseek Flags
33976 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
33977 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
33978
33979 @smallexample
33980 SEEK_SET 0
33981 SEEK_CUR 1
33982 SEEK_END 2
33983 @end smallexample
33984
33985 @node Limits
33986 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
33987 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
33988
33989 All values are given in decimal representation.
33990
33991 @smallexample
33992 INT_MIN -2147483648
33993 INT_MAX 2147483647
33994 UINT_MAX 4294967295
33995 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
33996 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
33997 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
33998 @end smallexample
33999
34000 @node File-I/O Examples
34001 @subsection File-I/O Examples
34002 @cindex file-i/o examples
34003
34004 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
34005 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
34006
34007 @smallexample
34008 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
34009 @emph{request memory read from target}
34010 -> @code{m1234,6}
34011 <- XXXXXX
34012 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
34013 -> @code{F6}
34014 @end smallexample
34015
34016 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
34017 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
34018
34019 @smallexample
34020 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
34021 @emph{request memory write to target}
34022 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
34023 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
34024 -> @code{F6}
34025 @end smallexample
34026
34027 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
34028 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
34029
34030 @smallexample
34031 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
34032 -> @code{F-1,9}
34033 @end smallexample
34034
34035 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
34036 host is called:
34037
34038 @smallexample
34039 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
34040 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
34041 <- @code{T02}
34042 @end smallexample
34043
34044 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
34045 host is called:
34046
34047 @smallexample
34048 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
34049 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
34050 <- @code{T02}
34051 @end smallexample
34052
34053 @node Library List Format
34054 @section Library List Format
34055 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
34056
34057 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
34058 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
34059 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
34060 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
34061 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
34062 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
34063 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
34064 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
34065 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
34066 are loaded.
34067
34068 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
34069 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
34070 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
34071 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
34072
34073 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
34074 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
34075 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
34076 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
34077 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
34078 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
34079
34080 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
34081 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
34082
34083 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
34084 offset, looks like this:
34085
34086 @smallexample
34087 <library-list>
34088 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
34089 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
34090 </library>
34091 </library-list>
34092 @end smallexample
34093
34094 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
34095 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
34096
34097 @smallexample
34098 <library-list>
34099 <library name="sharedlib.o">
34100 <section address="0x10000000"/>
34101 <section address="0x20000000"/>
34102 <section address="0x30000000"/>
34103 </library>
34104 </library-list>
34105 @end smallexample
34106
34107 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
34108
34109 @smallexample
34110 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
34111 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
34112 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
34113 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
34114 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
34115 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
34116 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
34117 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
34118 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
34119 @end smallexample
34120
34121 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
34122 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
34123 section for each library.
34124
34125 @node Memory Map Format
34126 @section Memory Map Format
34127 @cindex memory map format
34128
34129 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
34130 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
34131 memory map.
34132
34133 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
34134 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
34135 lists memory regions.
34136
34137 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
34138 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
34139
34140 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
34141
34142 @smallexample
34143 <?xml version="1.0"?>
34144 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
34145 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
34146 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
34147 <memory-map>
34148 region...
34149 </memory-map>
34150 @end smallexample
34151
34152 Each region can be either:
34153
34154 @itemize
34155
34156 @item
34157 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
34158 bytes from there:
34159
34160 @smallexample
34161 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
34162 @end smallexample
34163
34164
34165 @item
34166 A region of read-only memory:
34167
34168 @smallexample
34169 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
34170 @end smallexample
34171
34172
34173 @item
34174 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
34175 bytes in length:
34176
34177 @smallexample
34178 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
34179 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
34180 </memory>
34181 @end smallexample
34182
34183 @end itemize
34184
34185 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
34186 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
34187 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
34188
34189 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
34190
34191 @smallexample
34192 <!-- ................................................... -->
34193 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
34194 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
34195 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
34196 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
34197 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
34198 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
34199 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
34200 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
34201 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
34202 and its type, or device. -->
34203 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
34204 start CDATA #REQUIRED
34205 length CDATA #REQUIRED
34206 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
34207 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
34208 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
34209 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
34210 @end smallexample
34211
34212 @node Thread List Format
34213 @section Thread List Format
34214 @cindex thread list format
34215
34216 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
34217 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
34218 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
34219 the following structure:
34220
34221 @smallexample
34222 <?xml version="1.0"?>
34223 <threads>
34224 <thread id="id" core="0">
34225 ... description ...
34226 </thread>
34227 </threads>
34228 @end smallexample
34229
34230 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
34231 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
34232 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
34233 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
34234 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
34235
34236 @include agentexpr.texi
34237
34238 @node Trace File Format
34239 @appendix Trace File Format
34240 @cindex trace file format
34241
34242 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
34243 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
34244
34245 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
34246 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
34247 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
34248 in the future.
34249
34250 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
34251 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
34252 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
34253 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
34254 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
34255 of this section.
34256
34257 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
34258
34259 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
34260 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
34261 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
34262 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
34263 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
34264 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
34265 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
34266 endianness.
34267
34268 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
34269
34270 @table @code
34271 @item R @var{bytes}
34272 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
34273 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
34274 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
34275 hexadecimal encoding.
34276
34277 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
34278 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
34279 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
34280 @var{length} bytes.
34281
34282 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
34283 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
34284 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
34285
34286 @end table
34287
34288 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
34289 of blocks.
34290
34291 @node Target Descriptions
34292 @appendix Target Descriptions
34293 @cindex target descriptions
34294
34295 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
34296 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
34297 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
34298
34299 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
34300 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
34301 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
34302 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
34303 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
34304 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
34305 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
34306
34307 @itemize @bullet
34308 @item
34309 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
34310 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
34311 @item
34312 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
34313 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
34314 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
34315 @item
34316 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
34317 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
34318 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
34319 @end itemize
34320
34321 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
34322 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
34323 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
34324 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
34325 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
34326
34327 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
34328 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
34329
34330 @menu
34331 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
34332 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
34333 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
34334 descriptions.
34335 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
34336 @end menu
34337
34338 @node Retrieving Descriptions
34339 @section Retrieving Descriptions
34340
34341 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
34342 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
34343 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
34344 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
34345 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
34346 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
34347 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
34348 Format}.
34349
34350 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
34351 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
34352 specify a file are:
34353
34354 @table @code
34355 @cindex set tdesc filename
34356 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
34357 Read the target description from @var{path}.
34358
34359 @cindex unset tdesc filename
34360 @item unset tdesc filename
34361 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
34362 will use the description supplied by the current target.
34363
34364 @cindex show tdesc filename
34365 @item show tdesc filename
34366 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
34367 @end table
34368
34369
34370 @node Target Description Format
34371 @section Target Description Format
34372 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
34373
34374 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
34375 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
34376 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
34377 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
34378 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
34379 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
34380 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
34381
34382 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
34383 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
34384 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
34385 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
34386 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
34387
34388 Here is a simple target description:
34389
34390 @smallexample
34391 <target version="1.0">
34392 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
34393 </target>
34394 @end smallexample
34395
34396 @noindent
34397 This minimal description only says that the target uses
34398 the x86-64 architecture.
34399
34400 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
34401 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
34402 are explained further below.
34403
34404 @smallexample
34405 <?xml version="1.0"?>
34406 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
34407 <target version="1.0">
34408 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
34409 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
34410 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
34411 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
34412 </target>
34413 @end smallexample
34414
34415 @noindent
34416 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
34417 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
34418 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
34419 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
34420 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
34421 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
34422 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
34423 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
34424 the version mismatch.
34425
34426 @subsection Inclusion
34427 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
34428 @cindex XInclude
34429 @ifnotinfo
34430 @cindex <xi:include>
34431 @end ifnotinfo
34432
34433 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
34434 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
34435 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
34436 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
34437 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
34438
34439 @smallexample
34440 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
34441 @end smallexample
34442
34443 @noindent
34444 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
34445 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
34446 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
34447 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
34448 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
34449 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
34450 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
34451 original description.
34452
34453 @subsection Architecture
34454 @cindex <architecture>
34455
34456 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
34457
34458 @smallexample
34459 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
34460 @end smallexample
34461
34462 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
34463 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
34464
34465 @subsection OS ABI
34466 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
34467
34468 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
34469 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
34470
34471 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
34472
34473 @smallexample
34474 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
34475 @end smallexample
34476
34477 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
34478 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
34479
34480 @subsection Compatible Architecture
34481 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
34482
34483 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
34484 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
34485
34486 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
34487
34488 @smallexample
34489 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
34490 @end smallexample
34491
34492 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
34493 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
34494
34495 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
34496 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
34497 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
34498 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
34499 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
34500 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
34501 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
34502
34503 @smallexample
34504 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
34505 <compatible>spu</compatible>
34506 @end smallexample
34507
34508 @subsection Features
34509 @cindex <feature>
34510
34511 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
34512 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
34513 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
34514 has this form:
34515
34516 @smallexample
34517 <feature name="@var{name}">
34518 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
34519 @var{reg}@dots{}
34520 </feature>
34521 @end smallexample
34522
34523 @noindent
34524 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
34525 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
34526 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
34527 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
34528
34529 @subsection Types
34530
34531 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
34532 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
34533 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
34534 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
34535 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
34536
34537 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
34538 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
34539 Types must be defined before they are used.
34540
34541 @cindex <vector>
34542 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
34543 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
34544 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
34545 @var{count}:
34546
34547 @smallexample
34548 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
34549 @end smallexample
34550
34551 @cindex <union>
34552 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
34553 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
34554 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
34555 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
34556
34557 @smallexample
34558 <union id="@var{id}">
34559 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
34560 @dots{}
34561 </union>
34562 @end smallexample
34563
34564 @cindex <struct>
34565 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
34566 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
34567 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
34568 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
34569 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
34570 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
34571 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
34572 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
34573
34574 @smallexample
34575 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
34576 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
34577 @dots{}
34578 </struct>
34579 @end smallexample
34580
34581 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
34582 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
34583
34584 @smallexample
34585 <struct id="@var{id}">
34586 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
34587 @dots{}
34588 </struct>
34589 @end smallexample
34590
34591 @cindex <flags>
34592 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
34593 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
34594 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
34595 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
34596 are supported.
34597
34598 @smallexample
34599 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
34600 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
34601 @dots{}
34602 </flags>
34603 @end smallexample
34604
34605 @subsection Registers
34606 @cindex <reg>
34607
34608 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
34609
34610 @smallexample
34611 <reg name="@var{name}"
34612 bitsize="@var{size}"
34613 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
34614 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
34615 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
34616 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
34617 @end smallexample
34618
34619 @noindent
34620 The components are as follows:
34621
34622 @table @var
34623
34624 @item name
34625 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
34626
34627 @item bitsize
34628 The register's size, in bits.
34629
34630 @item regnum
34631 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
34632 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
34633 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
34634 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
34635 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
34636 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
34637 in order of increasing register number.
34638
34639 @item save-restore
34640 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
34641 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
34642 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
34643 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
34644 ABI.
34645
34646 @item type
34647 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
34648 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
34649 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
34650 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
34651 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
34652 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
34653
34654 @item group
34655 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
34656 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
34657 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
34658 in @code{info registers}.
34659
34660 @end table
34661
34662 @node Predefined Target Types
34663 @section Predefined Target Types
34664 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
34665
34666 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
34667 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
34668 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
34669 types. The currently supported types are:
34670
34671 @table @code
34672
34673 @item int8
34674 @itemx int16
34675 @itemx int32
34676 @itemx int64
34677 @itemx int128
34678 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
34679
34680 @item uint8
34681 @itemx uint16
34682 @itemx uint32
34683 @itemx uint64
34684 @itemx uint128
34685 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
34686
34687 @item code_ptr
34688 @itemx data_ptr
34689 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
34690 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
34691 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
34692 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
34693 may be marked as data pointers.
34694
34695 @item ieee_single
34696 Single precision IEEE floating point.
34697
34698 @item ieee_double
34699 Double precision IEEE floating point.
34700
34701 @item arm_fpa_ext
34702 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
34703
34704 @item i387_ext
34705 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
34706
34707 @item i386_eflags
34708 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
34709
34710 @item i386_mxcsr
34711 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
34712
34713 @end table
34714
34715 @node Standard Target Features
34716 @section Standard Target Features
34717 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
34718
34719 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
34720 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
34721 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
34722 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
34723 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
34724 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
34725 can recognize them.
34726
34727 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
34728 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
34729 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
34730 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
34731 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
34732 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
34733 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
34734 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
34735
34736 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
34737 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
34738 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
34739
34740 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
34741 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
34742 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
34743 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
34744
34745 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
34746 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
34747 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
34748
34749 @menu
34750 * ARM Features::
34751 * i386 Features::
34752 * MIPS Features::
34753 * M68K Features::
34754 * PowerPC Features::
34755 @end menu
34756
34757
34758 @node ARM Features
34759 @subsection ARM Features
34760 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
34761
34762 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
34763 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
34764 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
34765
34766 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
34767 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
34768
34769 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
34770 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
34771 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
34772 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
34773
34774 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
34775 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
34776 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
34777 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
34778 halves of the double-precision registers.
34779
34780 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
34781 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
34782 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
34783 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
34784 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
34785 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
34786
34787 @node i386 Features
34788 @subsection i386 Features
34789 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
34790
34791 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
34792 targets. It should describe the following registers:
34793
34794 @itemize @minus
34795 @item
34796 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
34797 @item
34798 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
34799 @item
34800 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
34801 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
34802 @item
34803 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
34804 @item
34805 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
34806 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
34807 @end itemize
34808
34809 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
34810
34811 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
34812 describe registers:
34813
34814 @itemize @minus
34815 @item
34816 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
34817 @item
34818 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
34819 @item
34820 @samp{mxcsr}
34821 @end itemize
34822
34823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
34824 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
34825 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
34826
34827 @itemize @minus
34828 @item
34829 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
34830 @item
34831 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
34832 @item
34833 @end itemize
34834
34835 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
34836 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
34837
34838 @node MIPS Features
34839 @subsection MIPS Features
34840 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
34841
34842 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
34843 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
34844 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
34845 on the target.
34846
34847 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
34848 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
34849 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
34850
34851 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
34852 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
34853 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
34854 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
34855
34856 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
34857 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
34858 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
34859
34860 @node M68K Features
34861 @subsection M68K Features
34862 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
34863
34864 @table @code
34865 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
34866 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
34867 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
34868 One of those features must be always present.
34869 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
34870 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
34871 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
34872 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
34873
34874 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
34875 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
34876 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
34877 @samp{fpiaddr}.
34878 @end table
34879
34880 @node PowerPC Features
34881 @subsection PowerPC Features
34882 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
34883
34884 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
34885 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
34886 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
34887 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
34888
34889 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
34890 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
34891
34892 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
34893 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
34894 and @samp{vrsave}.
34895
34896 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
34897 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
34898 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
34899 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
34900 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
34901 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
34902
34903 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
34904 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
34905 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
34906 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
34907 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
34908 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
34909 user.
34910
34911 @node Operating System Information
34912 @appendix Operating System Information
34913 @cindex operating system information
34914
34915 @menu
34916 * Process list::
34917 @end menu
34918
34919 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
34920 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
34921 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
34922 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
34923 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
34924 on a different aspect of target.
34925
34926 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
34927 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
34928 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
34929 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
34930
34931 @node Process list
34932 @appendixsection Process list
34933 @cindex operating system information, process list
34934
34935 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
34936 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
34937 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
34938 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
34939
34940 An example document is:
34941
34942 @smallexample
34943 <?xml version="1.0"?>
34944 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
34945 <osdata type="processes">
34946 <item>
34947 <column name="pid">1</column>
34948 <column name="user">root</column>
34949 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
34950 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
34951 </item>
34952 </osdata>
34953 @end smallexample
34954
34955 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
34956 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
34957 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
34958 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
34959 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
34960 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
34961 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
34962
34963 @include gpl.texi
34964
34965 @raisesections
34966 @include fdl.texi
34967 @lowersections
34968
34969 @node Index
34970 @unnumbered Index
34971
34972 @printindex cp
34973
34974 @tex
34975 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
34976 % meantime:
34977 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
34978 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
34979 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
34980 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
34981 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
34982 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
34983 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
34984 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
34985 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
34986 \page\colophon
34987 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
34988 @end tex
34989
34990 @bye